Merge branch 'master' into staging
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set KEY-SERVER pool.sks-keyservers.net
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 ng0@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68
69 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
70 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
71 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
72 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
73 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
74 Documentation License''.
75 @end copying
76
77 @dircategory System administration
78 @direntry
79 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
80 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
81 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
82 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
83 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
84 @end direntry
85
86 @dircategory Software development
87 @direntry
88 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
89 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
90 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
91 @end direntry
92
93 @titlepage
94 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
95 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
96 @author The GNU Guix Developers
97
98 @page
99 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
100 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
101 @value{UPDATED} @*
102
103 @insertcopying
104 @end titlepage
105
106 @contents
107
108 @c *********************************************************************
109 @node Top
110 @top GNU Guix
111
112 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
113 package management tool written for the GNU system.
114
115 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
116 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
117 @c translation.
118 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
119 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
120 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
121 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
122 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
123 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
124 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
125 Project}.
126
127 @menu
128 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
129 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
130 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
131 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
132 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
133 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
134 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
135 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
136 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
137 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
138 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
139 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
140 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
141 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
142
143 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
144 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
145 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
146 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
147
148 @detailmenu
149 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
150
151 Introduction
152
153 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
154 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
155
156 Installation
157
158 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
159 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
160 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
161 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
162 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
163 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
164
165 Setting Up the Daemon
166
167 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
168 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
169 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
170
171 System Installation
172
173 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
174 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
175 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
176 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
177 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
178 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
179 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
180 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
181 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
182
183 Manual Installation
184
185 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
186 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
187
188 Package Management
189
190 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
191 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
192 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
193 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
194 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
195 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
196 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
197 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
198 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
199 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
200
201 Substitutes
202
203 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
204 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
205 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
206 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
207 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
208 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
209
210 Development
211
212 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
213 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
214
215 Programming Interface
216
217 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
218 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
219 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
220 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
221 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
222 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
223 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
224 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
225
226 Defining Packages
227
228 * package Reference:: The package data type.
229 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
230
231 Utilities
232
233 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
234 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
235 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
236 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
237 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
238 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
239 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
240 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
241 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
242 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
243 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
244 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
245 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
246 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
247 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
248
249 Invoking @command{guix build}
250
251 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
252 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
253 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
254 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
255
256 System Configuration
257
258 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
259 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
260 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
261 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
262 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
263 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
264 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
265 * Services:: Specifying system services.
266 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
267 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
268 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
269 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
270 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
271 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
272 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
273 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
274
275 Services
276
277 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
278 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
279 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
280 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
281 * X Window:: Graphical display.
282 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
283 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
284 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
285 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
286 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
287 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
288 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
289 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
290 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
291 * Web Services:: Web servers.
292 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
293 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
294 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
295 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
296 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
297 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
298 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
299 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
300 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
301 * Game Services:: Game servers.
302 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
303
304 Defining Services
305
306 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
307 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
308 * Service Reference:: API reference.
309 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
310
311 @end detailmenu
312 @end menu
313
314 @c *********************************************************************
315 @node Introduction
316 @chapter Introduction
317
318 @cindex purpose
319 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
320 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
321 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
322 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
323 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
324 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
325 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
326
327 @cindex Guix System
328 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
329 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
330 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
331 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
332 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
333 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
334 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
335 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
336 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
337 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
338
339 @menu
340 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
341 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
342 @end menu
343
344 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
345 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
346
347 @cindex user interfaces
348 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
349 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
350 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage,
351 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
352 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
353 @cindex build daemon
354 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
355 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
356 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
357
358 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
359 @cindex customization, of packages
360 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
361 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
362 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
363 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
364 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
365 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
366 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
367 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
368
369 @cindex functional package management
370 @cindex isolation
371 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
372 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
373 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
374 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
375 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
376 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
377 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
378 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
379 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
380 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
381 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
382 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
383 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
384 explicit inputs are visible.
385
386 @cindex store
387 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
388 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
389 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
390 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
391 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
392 input yields a different directory name.
393
394 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
395 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
396 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
397
398
399 @node GNU Distribution
400 @section GNU Distribution
401
402 @cindex Guix System
403 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
404 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
405 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
406 users of that software}.}. The
407 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
408 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
409 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
410 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
411 Guix@tie{}System.
412
413 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
414 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
415 list of available packages can be browsed
416 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
417 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
418
419 @example
420 guix package --list-available
421 @end example
422
423 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
424 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
425 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
426 tools that help users exert that freedom.
427
428 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
429
430 @table @code
431
432 @item x86_64-linux
433 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
434
435 @item i686-linux
436 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
437
438 @item armhf-linux
439 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
440 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
441 and Linux-Libre kernel.
442
443 @item aarch64-linux
444 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
445
446 @item mips64el-linux
447 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
448 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
449 supported; in particular, the project's build farms no longer provide
450 substitutes for this architecture.
451
452 @end table
453
454 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
455 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
456 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
457 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
458 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
459 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
460 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
461
462 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
463 @code{mips64el-linux}.
464
465 @noindent
466 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
467 @pxref{Porting}.
468
469 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
470 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
471
472
473 @c *********************************************************************
474 @node Installation
475 @chapter Installation
476
477 @cindex installing Guix
478
479 @quotation Note
480 We recommend the use of this
481 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
482 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
483 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
484 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
485 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
486 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
487 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
488 as the root user.
489 @end quotation
490
491 @cindex foreign distro
492 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
493 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
494 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
495 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
496 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
497
498 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
499 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
500
501 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
502 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
503 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
504 ready to use it.
505
506 @menu
507 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
508 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
509 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
510 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
511 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
512 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
513 @end menu
514
515 @node Binary Installation
516 @section Binary Installation
517
518 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
519 @cindex installer script
520 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
521 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
522 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
523 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
524 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
525
526 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
527 @quotation Note
528 We recommend the use of this
529 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
530 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
531 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
532 user.
533 @end quotation
534
535 Installing goes along these lines:
536
537 @enumerate
538 @item
539 @cindex downloading Guix binary
540 Download the binary tarball from
541 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
542 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
543 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
544
545 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
546 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
547 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
548
549 @example
550 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
551 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
552 @end example
553
554 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
555 then run this command to import it:
556
557 @example
558 $ gpg --keyserver @value{KEY-SERVER} \
559 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
560 @end example
561
562 @noindent
563 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
564 @c end authentication part
565
566 @item
567 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
568 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
569
570 @example
571 # cd /tmp
572 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
573 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
574 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
575 @end example
576
577 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
578 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
579 step.)
580
581 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
582 would overwrite its own essential files.
583
584 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
585 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
586 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
587 versions are fine.)
588 They stem from the fact that all the
589 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
590 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
591 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
592 reproducible.
593
594 @item
595 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
596 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
597
598 @example
599 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
600 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
601 ~root/.config/guix/current
602 @end example
603
604 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @code{PATH} and other relevant
605 environment variables:
606
607 @example
608 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
609 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
610 @end example
611
612 @item
613 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
614 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
615
616 @item
617 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
618
619 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
620 with these commands:
621
622 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
623 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
624 @c files into place.
625 @c
626 @c See this thread for more information:
627 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
628
629 @example
630 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
631 /etc/systemd/system/
632 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
633 @end example
634
635 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
636
637 @example
638 # initctl reload-configuration
639 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
640 /etc/init/
641 # start guix-daemon
642 @end example
643
644 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
645
646 @example
647 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
648 --build-users-group=guixbuild
649 @end example
650
651 @item
652 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
653 for instance with:
654
655 @example
656 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
657 # cd /usr/local/bin
658 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
659 @end example
660
661 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
662 there:
663
664 @example
665 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
666 # cd /usr/local/share/info
667 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
668 do ln -s $i ; done
669 @end example
670
671 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
672 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
673 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
674 Info search path.)
675
676 @item
677 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
678 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
679 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
680
681 @example
682 # guix archive --authorize < \
683 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
684 @end example
685
686 @item
687 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
688 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
689 @end enumerate
690
691 Voilà, the installation is complete!
692
693 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
694 the root profile:
695
696 @example
697 # guix install hello
698 @end example
699
700 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
701 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
702
703 @example
704 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
705 @end example
706
707 @noindent
708 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
709
710 @example
711 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
712 --profile-name=current-guix guix
713 @end example
714
715 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
716
717 @node Requirements
718 @section Requirements
719
720 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
721 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
722 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
723 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
724
725 @cindex official website
726 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
727 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
728
729 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
730
731 @itemize
732 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.2.x;
733 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
734 0.1.0 or later;
735 @item
736 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
737 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
738 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
739 @item
740 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
741 or later;
742 @item
743 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
744 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
745 2017 or later;
746 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON};
747 @item @url{https://zlib.net, zlib};
748 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
749 @end itemize
750
751 The following dependencies are optional:
752
753 @itemize
754 @item
755 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
756 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
757 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
758 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
759 version 0.10.2 or later.
760
761 @item
762 When @url{https://www.nongnu.org/lzip/lzlib.html, lzlib} is available, lzlib
763 substitutes can be used and @command{guix publish} can compress substitutes
764 with lzlib.
765
766 @item
767 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
768 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
769 @end itemize
770
771 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
772 following packages are also needed:
773
774 @itemize
775 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
776 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
777 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
778 C++11 standard.
779 @end itemize
780
781 @cindex state directory
782 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
783 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
784 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
785 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
786 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
787 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
788 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
789
790 @cindex Nix, compatibility
791 When a working installation of @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
792 manager} is available, you
793 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
794 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
795
796 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
797 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
798 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
799 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
800 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
801 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
802 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
803 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
804 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
805
806 @node Running the Test Suite
807 @section Running the Test Suite
808
809 @cindex test suite
810 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
811 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
812 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
813 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
814 suite, type:
815
816 @example
817 make check
818 @end example
819
820 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
821 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
822 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
823 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
824 cache.
825
826 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
827 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
828
829 @example
830 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
831 @end example
832
833 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
834 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
835 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
836
837 @example
838 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
839 @end example
840
841 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
842 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
843 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
844 your message.
845
846 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
847 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
848 Guix is already installed, using:
849
850 @example
851 make check-system
852 @end example
853
854 @noindent
855 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
856
857 @example
858 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
859 @end example
860
861 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
862 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
863 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
864 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
865 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
866 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
867
868 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
869 all the details.
870
871 @node Setting Up the Daemon
872 @section Setting Up the Daemon
873
874 @cindex daemon
875 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
876 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
877 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
878 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
879 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
880 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
881 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
882
883 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
884 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
885 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
886
887 @menu
888 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
889 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
890 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
891 @end menu
892
893 @node Build Environment Setup
894 @subsection Build Environment Setup
895
896 @cindex build environment
897 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
898 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
899 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
900 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
901 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
902 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
903 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
904
905 @cindex build users
906 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
907 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
908 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
909 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
910 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
911 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
912 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
913 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
914 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
915 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
916
917 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
918 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
919
920 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
921 @c for why `-G' is needed.
922 @example
923 # groupadd --system guixbuild
924 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
925 do
926 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
927 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
928 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
929 guixbuilder$i;
930 done
931 @end example
932
933 @noindent
934 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
935 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
936 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
937 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
938 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
939 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
940 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
941
942 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
943 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
944 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
945 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
946 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
947 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
948 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
949 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
950
951 @example
952 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
953 @end example
954
955 @cindex chroot
956 @noindent
957 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
958 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
959 environment contains nothing but:
960
961 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
962 @itemize
963 @item
964 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
965 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
966 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
967 can only be created if the host has them.};
968
969 @item
970 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
971 since a separate PID name space is used;
972
973 @item
974 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
975 user @file{nobody};
976
977 @item
978 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
979
980 @item
981 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
982 @code{127.0.0.1};
983
984 @item
985 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
986 @end itemize
987
988 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
989 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
990 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
991 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
992 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
993 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
994 capture the name of their build tree.
995
996 @vindex http_proxy
997 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
998 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
999 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1000
1001 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1002 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
1003 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1004 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1005 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1006 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1007 @emph{pure} functions.
1008
1009
1010 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1011 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1012
1013 @cindex offloading
1014 @cindex build hook
1015 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1016 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1017 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1018 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1019 present.}. When that
1020 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
1021 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
1022 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
1023 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
1024 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
1025 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
1026 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
1027 build are copied back to the initial machine.
1028
1029 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1030
1031 @example
1032 (list (build-machine
1033 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1034 (system "x86_64-linux")
1035 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1036 (user "bob")
1037 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1038
1039 (build-machine
1040 (name "meeps.example.org")
1041 (system "mips64el-linux")
1042 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1043 (user "alice")
1044 (private-key
1045 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1046 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1047 @end example
1048
1049 @noindent
1050 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1051 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
1052 architecture.
1053
1054 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1055 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1056 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1057 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1058 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1059 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1060 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1061 detailed below.
1062
1063 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1064 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1065 builds. The important fields are:
1066
1067 @table @code
1068
1069 @item name
1070 The host name of the remote machine.
1071
1072 @item system
1073 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
1074
1075 @item user
1076 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1077 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1078 allow non-interactive logins.
1079
1080 @item host-key
1081 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1082 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1083 long string that looks like this:
1084
1085 @example
1086 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1087 @end example
1088
1089 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1090 key can be found in a file such as
1091 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1092
1093 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1094 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1095 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1096 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1097
1098 @example
1099 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1100 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1101 @end example
1102
1103 @end table
1104
1105 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1106
1107 @table @asis
1108
1109 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1110 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1111
1112 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1113 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1114 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1115
1116 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1117 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1118
1119 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1120 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1121 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1122
1123 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1124 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1125
1126 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1127 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1128 to on that machine.
1129
1130 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1131 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1132
1133 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1134 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1135 machines with a higher speed factor.
1136
1137 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1138 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1139 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1140 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1141 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1142
1143 @end table
1144 @end deftp
1145
1146 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1147 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1148
1149 @example
1150 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1151 @end example
1152
1153 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1154 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1155 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1156 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1157 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1158
1159 @example
1160 # guix archive --generate-key
1161 @end example
1162
1163 @noindent
1164 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1165 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1166
1167 @example
1168 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1169 @end example
1170
1171 @noindent
1172 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1173
1174 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1175 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1176 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1177 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1178 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1179
1180 @cindex offload test
1181 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1182 master node:
1183
1184 @example
1185 # guix offload test
1186 @end example
1187
1188 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1189 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1190 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1191 from it, and report any error in the process.
1192
1193 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1194 command line:
1195
1196 @example
1197 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1198 @end example
1199
1200 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1201 regular expression like this:
1202
1203 @example
1204 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1205 @end example
1206
1207 @cindex offload status
1208 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1209 main node:
1210
1211 @example
1212 # guix offload status
1213 @end example
1214
1215
1216 @node SELinux Support
1217 @subsection SELinux Support
1218
1219 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1220 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1221 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1222 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1223 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1224 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1225 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1226 be used on Guix System.
1227
1228 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1229 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1230 To install the policy run this command as root:
1231
1232 @example
1233 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1234 @end example
1235
1236 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1237 mechanism provided by your system.
1238
1239 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1240 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1241 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1242 command:
1243
1244 @example
1245 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1246 @end example
1247
1248 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1249 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1250 operations.
1251
1252 @subsubsection Limitations
1253 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1254
1255 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1256 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1257 the Guix daemon.
1258
1259 @enumerate
1260 @item
1261 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1262 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1263 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1264 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1265
1266 @item
1267 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1268 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1269 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1270 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1271 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1272 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1273 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1274 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1275 reading and following these links.
1276
1277 @item
1278 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1279 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1280 differently from files.
1281
1282 @item
1283 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1284 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1285 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1286 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1287 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1288 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1289 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1290 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1291 allowed for processes in that domain.
1292
1293 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1294 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1295 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1296 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1297 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1298 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1299 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1300 @end enumerate
1301
1302 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1303 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1304
1305 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1306 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1307 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1308 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1309
1310 @example
1311 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1312 @end example
1313
1314 @noindent
1315 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1316
1317 @cindex chroot
1318 @cindex container, build environment
1319 @cindex build environment
1320 @cindex reproducible builds
1321 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1322 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1323 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1324 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1325 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1326 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1327 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1328 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1329 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1330 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1331 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1332
1333 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1334 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1335 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1336 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1337 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1338
1339 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1340 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1341 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1342
1343 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1344 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands.) The
1345 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1346 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1347 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1348
1349 The following command-line options are supported:
1350
1351 @table @code
1352 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1353 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1354 the Daemon, build users}).
1355
1356 @item --no-substitutes
1357 @cindex substitutes
1358 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1359 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1360 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1361
1362 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1363 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1364 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1365
1366 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1367 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1368 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1369 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1370 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1371
1372 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1373 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1374
1375 @cindex build hook
1376 @item --no-build-hook
1377 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1378
1379 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1380 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1381 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1382
1383 @item --cache-failures
1384 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1385
1386 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1387 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1388 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1389 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1390
1391 @item --cores=@var{n}
1392 @itemx -c @var{n}
1393 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1394 as available.
1395
1396 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1397 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1398 guix build}).
1399
1400 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1401 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1402 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1403
1404 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1405 @itemx -M @var{n}
1406 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1407 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1408 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1409 Setup}), or simply fail.
1410
1411 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1412 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1413 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1414
1415 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1416
1417 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1418 Build Options, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
1419
1420 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1421 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1422 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1423
1424 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1425
1426 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1427 Build Options, @code{--timeout}}).
1428
1429 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1430 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1431 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1432 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1433 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1434
1435 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1436 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1437 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1438
1439 @item --debug
1440 Produce debugging output.
1441
1442 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1443 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1444 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1445
1446 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1447 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1448
1449 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1450 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1451 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1452 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1453 needs.
1454
1455 @item --disable-chroot
1456 Disable chroot builds.
1457
1458 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1459 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1460 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1461 account.
1462
1463 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1464 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1465 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1466
1467 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1468 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1469 them with bzip2 by default.
1470
1471 @item --disable-deduplication
1472 @cindex deduplication
1473 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1474
1475 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1476 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1477 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1478 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1479 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1480 this optimization.
1481
1482 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1483 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1484 derivations.
1485
1486 @cindex GC roots
1487 @cindex garbage collector roots
1488 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1489 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1490 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are reachable from a GC
1491 root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC roots.
1492
1493 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1494 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1495 corresponding to live outputs.
1496
1497 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1498 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1499 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1500 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1501
1502 In this way, setting @code{--gc-keep-derivations} to ``yes'' causes liveness
1503 to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting @code{--gc-keep-outputs} to
1504 ``yes'' causes liveness to flow from derivations to outputs. When both are
1505 set to ``yes'', the effect is to keep all the build prerequisites (the
1506 sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time tools) of live objects in
1507 the store, regardless of whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC
1508 root. This is convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1509
1510 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1511 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1512 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1513
1514 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1515 on the kernel version number.
1516
1517 @item --lose-logs
1518 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1519 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1520
1521 @item --system=@var{system}
1522 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1523 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1524 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1525
1526 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1527 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1528 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1529 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1530 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1531
1532 @table @code
1533 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1534 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1535 creating it if needed.
1536
1537 @item --listen=localhost
1538 @cindex daemon, remote access
1539 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1540 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1541 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1542 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1543 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1544
1545 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1546 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1547 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1548 @end table
1549
1550 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1551 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1552 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1553 by setting the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1554 (@pxref{The Store, @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1555
1556 @quotation Note
1557 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1558 @code{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1559 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1560 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1561 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1562 @end quotation
1563
1564 When @code{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1565 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1566 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1567 @end table
1568
1569
1570 @node Application Setup
1571 @section Application Setup
1572
1573 @cindex foreign distro
1574 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1575 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1576 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1577
1578 @subsection Locales
1579
1580 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1581 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1582 @vindex LOCPATH
1583 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1584 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1585 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1586 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1587 variable:
1588
1589 @example
1590 $ guix install glibc-locales
1591 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1592 @end example
1593
1594 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1595 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1596 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1597 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1598
1599 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1600 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1601 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1602
1603 @enumerate
1604 @item
1605 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1606 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1607 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1608 incompatible locale data.
1609
1610 @item
1611 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1612 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1613 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1614 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1615 data in the right format.
1616 @end enumerate
1617
1618 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1619 versions may be incompatible.
1620
1621 @subsection Name Service Switch
1622
1623 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1624 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1625 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1626 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1627 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1628 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1629 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1630 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1631 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1632 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1633
1634 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1635 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1636 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1637 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1638 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1639
1640 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1641 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1642 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1643 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1644 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1645 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1646 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1647 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1648 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1649 Reference Manual}).
1650
1651 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1652 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1653 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1654 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1655 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1656 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1657 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1658 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1659 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1660
1661 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1662 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1663 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1664 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1665
1666 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1667 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1668 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1669 themselves.
1670
1671 @subsection X11 Fonts
1672
1673 @cindex fonts
1674 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1675 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1676 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1677 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1678 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1679 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1680 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1681
1682 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1683 graphical applications, consider installing
1684 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1685 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1686 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1687 for Chinese languages:
1688
1689 @example
1690 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1691 @end example
1692
1693 @cindex @code{xterm}
1694 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1695 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1696 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1697
1698 @example
1699 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1700 @end example
1701
1702 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1703 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1704
1705 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1706 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1707 @example
1708 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1709 @end example
1710
1711 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1712 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1713 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1714
1715 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1716 @cindex font cache
1717 After installing fonts you may have to refresh the font cache to use
1718 them in applications. The same applies when applications installed via
1719 Guix do not seem to find fonts. To force rebuilding of the font cache
1720 run @code{fc-cache -f}. The @code{fc-cache} command is provided by the
1721 @code{fontconfig} package.
1722
1723 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1724
1725 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1726 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1727 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1728
1729 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1730 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1731 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1732 information.
1733
1734 @subsection Emacs Packages
1735
1736 @cindex @code{emacs}
1737 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1738 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1739 sub-directories of
1740 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1741 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1742 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may not be
1743 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1744 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1745 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1746 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1747
1748 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1749 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1750 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1751 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1752 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1753
1754 @subsection The GCC toolchain
1755
1756 @cindex GCC
1757 @cindex ld-wrapper
1758
1759 Guix offers individual compiler packages such as @code{gcc} but if you
1760 are in need of a complete toolchain for compiling and linking source
1761 code what you really want is the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This
1762 package provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development,
1763 including GCC itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus
1764 debugging symbols in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker
1765 wrapper.
1766
1767 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
1768 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
1769 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
1770 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
1771 @code{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
1772
1773 @c TODO What else?
1774
1775 @c *********************************************************************
1776 @node System Installation
1777 @chapter System Installation
1778
1779 @cindex installing Guix System
1780 @cindex Guix System, installation
1781 This section explains how to install Guix System
1782 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1783 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1784 @pxref{Installation}.
1785
1786 @ifinfo
1787 @quotation Note
1788 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1789 @c installation image.
1790 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1791 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1792 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1793 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1794
1795 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1796 available.
1797 @end quotation
1798 @end ifinfo
1799
1800 @menu
1801 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1802 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1803 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1804 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1805 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1806 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1807 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1808 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1809 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1810 @end menu
1811
1812 @node Limitations
1813 @section Limitations
1814
1815 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1816 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1817 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1818
1819 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1820 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1821
1822 @itemize
1823 @item
1824 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
1825
1826 @item
1827 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1828 may be missing.
1829
1830 @item
1831 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1832 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1833 missing.
1834 @end itemize
1835
1836 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1837 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
1838 info.
1839
1840
1841 @node Hardware Considerations
1842 @section Hardware Considerations
1843
1844 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
1845 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
1846 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
1847 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
1848 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
1849 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
1850 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
1851 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
1852 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
1853
1854 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
1855 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
1856 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
1857 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
1858 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
1859 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
1860 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
1861 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
1862 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
1863
1864 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
1865 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
1866 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
1867 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
1868 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
1869 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
1870
1871 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
1872 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
1873 about their support in GNU/Linux.
1874
1875
1876 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
1877 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
1878
1879 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
1880 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
1881 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz},
1882 where @var{system} is one of:
1883
1884 @table @code
1885 @item x86_64-linux
1886 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
1887
1888 @item i686-linux
1889 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
1890 @end table
1891
1892 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
1893 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
1894 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
1895
1896 @example
1897 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1898 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1899 @end example
1900
1901 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
1902 then run this command to import it:
1903
1904 @example
1905 $ gpg --keyserver @value{KEY-SERVER} \
1906 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
1907 @end example
1908
1909 @noindent
1910 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
1911 @c end duplication
1912
1913 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
1914 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
1915
1916 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
1917
1918 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
1919
1920 @enumerate
1921 @item
1922 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1923
1924 @example
1925 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1926 @end example
1927
1928 @item
1929 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
1930 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
1931 copy the image with:
1932
1933 @example
1934 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso of=/dev/sdX
1935 sync
1936 @end example
1937
1938 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
1939 @end enumerate
1940
1941 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
1942
1943 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
1944
1945 @enumerate
1946 @item
1947 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1948
1949 @example
1950 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @item
1954 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
1955 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
1956 copy the image with:
1957
1958 @example
1959 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
1960 @end example
1961
1962 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
1963 @end enumerate
1964
1965 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
1966
1967 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
1968 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
1969 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
1970
1971 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
1972 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
1973
1974
1975 @node Preparing for Installation
1976 @section Preparing for Installation
1977
1978 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
1979 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternately,
1980 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
1981 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
1982 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
1983
1984 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
1985 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
1986 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
1987 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
1988 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
1989 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
1990 with the middle button.
1991
1992 @quotation Note
1993 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
1994 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
1995 ``Networking'' section below.
1996 @end quotation
1997
1998 @node Guided Graphical Installation
1999 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2000
2001 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2002 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2003
2004 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2005 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2006 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2007 the networking dialog.
2008
2009 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2010
2011 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2012 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2013 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2014 things.
2015
2016 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2017
2018 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2019 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2020
2021 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2022
2023 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2024 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2025 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2026 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2027
2028
2029 @node Manual Installation
2030 @section Manual Installation
2031
2032 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2033 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2034 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2035 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2036 Installation}).
2037
2038 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2039 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2040 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2041 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2042 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2043
2044 @menu
2045 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2046 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2047 @end menu
2048
2049 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2050 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2051
2052 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2053 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2054 guide you through this.
2055
2056 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2057
2058 @cindex keyboard layout
2059 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2060 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2061 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2062
2063 @example
2064 loadkeys dvorak
2065 @end example
2066
2067 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2068 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2069 more information.
2070
2071 @subsubsection Networking
2072
2073 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2074
2075 @example
2076 ifconfig -a
2077 @end example
2078
2079 @noindent
2080 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2081
2082 @example
2083 ip a
2084 @end example
2085
2086 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2087 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2088 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2089 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2090 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2091
2092 @table @asis
2093 @item Wired connection
2094 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2095 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2096
2097 @example
2098 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2099 @end example
2100
2101 @item Wireless connection
2102 @cindex wireless
2103 @cindex WiFi
2104 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2105 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2106 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2107 @command{nano}:
2108
2109 @example
2110 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2111 @end example
2112
2113 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2114 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2115 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2116
2117 @example
2118 network=@{
2119 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2120 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2121 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2122 @}
2123 @end example
2124
2125 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2126 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2127 network interface you want to use):
2128
2129 @example
2130 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2131 @end example
2132
2133 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2134 @end table
2135
2136 @cindex DHCP
2137 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2138 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2139
2140 @example
2141 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2142 @end example
2143
2144 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2145
2146 @example
2147 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2148 @end example
2149
2150 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2151 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2152
2153 @cindex installing over SSH
2154 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2155 an SSH server:
2156
2157 @example
2158 herd start ssh-daemon
2159 @end example
2160
2161 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2162 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2163
2164 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2165
2166 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2167 then format the target partition(s).
2168
2169 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2170 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2171 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2172 the partition layout you want:
2173
2174 @example
2175 cfdisk
2176 @end example
2177
2178 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2179 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2180 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2181 manual}).
2182
2183 @cindex EFI, installation
2184 @cindex UEFI, installation
2185 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2186 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2187 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2188 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2189
2190 @example
2191 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2192 @end example
2193
2194 @quotation Note
2195 @vindex grub-bootloader
2196 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2197 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2198 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2199 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2200 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2201 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2202 bootloaders.
2203 @end quotation
2204
2205 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2206 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2207 Guix System only supports ext4 and btrfs file systems. In particular, code
2208 that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
2209 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2210 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2211
2212 @example
2213 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2214 @end example
2215
2216 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2217 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2218 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2219 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2220 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2221 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2222
2223 @example
2224 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2225 @end example
2226
2227 @cindex encrypted disk
2228 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2229 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2230 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2231 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
2232 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2233 be along these lines:
2234
2235 @example
2236 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2237 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2238 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2239 @end example
2240
2241 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2242 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2243 root file system):
2244
2245 @example
2246 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2247 @end example
2248
2249 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2250 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2251 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2252 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2253
2254 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2255 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2256 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2257 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2258
2259 @example
2260 mkswap /dev/sda3
2261 swapon /dev/sda3
2262 @end example
2263
2264 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2265 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2266 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2267 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2268 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2269 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2270
2271 @example
2272 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2273 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2274 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2275 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2276 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2277 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2278 @end example
2279
2280 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2281 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2282 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2283
2284 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2285 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2286
2287 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2288 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2289
2290 @example
2291 herd start cow-store /mnt
2292 @end example
2293
2294 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2295 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2296 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2297 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2298 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2299
2300 Next, you have to edit a file and
2301 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2302 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2303 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2304 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2305 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2306 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2307 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2308 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2309 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2310
2311 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2312 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2313 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2314 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2315 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2316 something along these lines:
2317
2318 @example
2319 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2320 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2321 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2322 @end example
2323
2324 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2325 in particular:
2326
2327 @itemize
2328 @item
2329 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2330 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2331 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2332 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2333 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2334 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2335 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2336 configuration.
2337
2338 @item
2339 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2340 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2341 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2342 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2343
2344 @item
2345 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2346 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2347 @end itemize
2348
2349 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2350 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2351 under @file{/mnt}):
2352
2353 @example
2354 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2355 @end example
2356
2357 @noindent
2358 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2359 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2360 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2361 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2362
2363 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2364 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2365 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2366 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2367 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2368 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2369 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2370
2371
2372 @node After System Installation
2373 @section After System Installation
2374
2375 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2376 system whenever you want by running, say:
2377
2378 @example
2379 guix pull
2380 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2381 @end example
2382
2383 @noindent
2384 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2385 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2386 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2387
2388 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2389 @quotation Note
2390 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2391 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2392 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @code{PATH} unchanged. To
2393 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2394 @end quotation
2395
2396 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2397 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2398
2399
2400 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2401 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2402
2403 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2404 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2405 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2406 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2407 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2408 section is for you.
2409
2410 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2411 disk image, follow these steps:
2412
2413 @enumerate
2414 @item
2415 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2416 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2417
2418 @item
2419 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2420 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2421
2422 @example
2423 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 50G
2424 @end example
2425
2426 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2427 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2428
2429 @item
2430 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2431
2432 @example
2433 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2434 -net user -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
2435 -drive file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso \
2436 -drive file=guixsd.img
2437 @end example
2438
2439 The ordering of the drives matters. @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but
2440 significantly improves performance, @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2441
2442 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
2443 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
2444 selection.
2445
2446 @item
2447 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2448 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2449 @end enumerate
2450
2451 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2452 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2453 that.
2454
2455 @node Building the Installation Image
2456 @section Building the Installation Image
2457
2458 @cindex installation image
2459 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2460 system} command, specifically:
2461
2462 @example
2463 guix system disk-image --file-system-type=iso9660 \
2464 gnu/system/install.scm
2465 @end example
2466
2467 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2468 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2469 about the installation image.
2470
2471 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2472
2473 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2474 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2475
2476 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2477 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2478 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2479
2480 @example
2481 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2482 @end example
2483
2484 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2485 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2486
2487 @c *********************************************************************
2488 @node Package Management
2489 @chapter Package Management
2490
2491 @cindex packages
2492 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2493 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2494 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2495 features.
2496
2497 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2498 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2499 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2500 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2501 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2502 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2503 with it):
2504
2505 @example
2506 guix install emacs-guix
2507 @end example
2508
2509 @menu
2510 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2511 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2512 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2513 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2514 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2515 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2516 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
2517 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2518 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2519 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2520 @end menu
2521
2522 @node Features
2523 @section Features
2524
2525 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2526 own directory---something that resembles
2527 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2528
2529 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2530 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2531 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2532 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2533
2534 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2535 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2536 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2537 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2538 simply continues to point to
2539 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2540 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2541
2542 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2543 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2544 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2545
2546 @cindex transactions
2547 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2548 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2549 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2550 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2551 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2552 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2553
2554 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2555 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2556 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2557 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2558 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2559 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2560 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2561
2562 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2563 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2564 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2565 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2566 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2567 collected.
2568
2569 @cindex reproducibility
2570 @cindex reproducible builds
2571 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2572 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2573 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2574 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2575 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2576 given package installation matches the current state of their
2577 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2578 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2579 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2580 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2581
2582 @cindex substitutes
2583 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2584 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2585 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2586 downloads it and unpacks it;
2587 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2588 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2589 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2590 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2591 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2592
2593 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2594 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2595 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2596 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2597 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2598
2599 @cindex replication, of software environments
2600 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
2601 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
2602 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
2603 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
2604 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
2605 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
2606 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
2607
2608 @node Invoking guix package
2609 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
2610
2611 @cindex installing packages
2612 @cindex removing packages
2613 @cindex package installation
2614 @cindex package removal
2615 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
2616 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
2617 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
2618 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
2619 is:
2620
2621 @example
2622 guix package @var{options}
2623 @end example
2624
2625 @cindex transactions
2626 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
2627 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
2628 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
2629 want to roll back.
2630
2631 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
2632 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
2633
2634 @example
2635 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
2636 @end example
2637
2638 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
2639 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
2640
2641 @itemize
2642 @item
2643 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
2644 @item
2645 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
2646 @item
2647 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
2648 @item
2649 and @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u}.
2650 @end itemize
2651
2652 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
2653 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
2654 package} directly.
2655
2656 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
2657 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
2658 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
2659 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
2660
2661 @cindex profile
2662 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
2663 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
2664 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
2665 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
2666 variable, and so on.
2667 @cindex search paths
2668 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
2669 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
2670 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
2671 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
2672
2673 @example
2674 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
2675 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
2676 @end example
2677
2678 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
2679 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
2680 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
2681 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
2682 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
2683 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
2684 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
2685 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
2686 package}.
2687
2688 The @var{options} can be among the following:
2689
2690 @table @code
2691
2692 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
2693 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
2694 Install the specified @var{package}s.
2695
2696 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
2697 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
2698 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
2699 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
2700
2701 If no version number is specified, the
2702 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
2703 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
2704 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
2705 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
2706 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
2707 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2708
2709 @cindex propagated inputs
2710 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
2711 that automatically get installed along with the required package
2712 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
2713 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
2714 package definitions).
2715
2716 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
2717 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
2718 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
2719 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
2720 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
2721 also been explicitly installed by the user.
2722
2723 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
2724 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
2725 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
2726 environment variable definitions are reported here.
2727
2728 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
2729 @itemx -e @var{exp}
2730 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
2731
2732 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
2733 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
2734 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
2735 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
2736
2737 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
2738 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
2739 multiple-output package.
2740
2741 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
2742 @itemx -f @var{file}
2743 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
2744
2745 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
2746 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
2747
2748 @example
2749 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
2750 @end example
2751
2752 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
2753 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
2754 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
2755 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2756
2757 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
2758 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
2759 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
2760
2761 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
2762 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
2763 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
2764 @code{glibc}.
2765
2766 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2767 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2768 @cindex upgrading packages
2769 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
2770 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
2771 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
2772
2773 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
2774 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
2775 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2776 pull}).
2777
2778 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2779 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
2780 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
2781 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
2782 substring ``emacs'':
2783
2784 @example
2785 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
2786 @end example
2787
2788 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
2789 @itemx -m @var{file}
2790 @cindex profile declaration
2791 @cindex profile manifest
2792 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
2793 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
2794
2795 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
2796 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
2797 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
2798 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
2799 so on.
2800
2801 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
2802 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
2803 of packages:
2804
2805 @findex packages->manifest
2806 @example
2807 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
2808
2809 (packages->manifest
2810 (list emacs
2811 guile-2.0
2812 ;; Use a specific package output.
2813 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
2814 @end example
2815
2816 @findex specifications->manifest
2817 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
2818 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
2819 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
2820 instead provide regular package specifications and let
2821 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
2822 objects, like this:
2823
2824 @example
2825 (specifications->manifest
2826 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
2827 @end example
2828
2829 @item --roll-back
2830 @cindex rolling back
2831 @cindex undoing transactions
2832 @cindex transactions, undoing
2833 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
2834 the last transaction.
2835
2836 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
2837 before any other actions.
2838
2839 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
2840 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
2841 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
2842
2843 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
2844 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
2845 generations in a profile is always linear.
2846
2847 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
2848 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
2849 @cindex generations
2850 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
2851
2852 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
2853 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
2854 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
2855 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
2856 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
2857
2858 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
2859 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
2860 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
2861 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
2862
2863 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
2864 @cindex search paths
2865 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2866 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2867 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2868 of the installed packages.
2869
2870 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
2871 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2872 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2873 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2874 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
2875 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
2876 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2877
2878 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2879 shell:
2880
2881 @example
2882 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2883 @end example
2884
2885 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2886 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2887 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2888 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2889
2890 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2891 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2892
2893 @example
2894 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2895 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2896 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2897 @end example
2898
2899 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2900 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2901 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2902
2903
2904 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2905 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2906 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2907
2908 @cindex collisions, in a profile
2909 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
2910 @cindex profile collisions
2911 @item --allow-collisions
2912 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
2913
2914 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
2915 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
2916 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
2917
2918 @item --bootstrap
2919 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
2920 useful to distribution developers.
2921
2922 @end table
2923
2924 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
2925 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
2926 availability of packages:
2927
2928 @table @option
2929
2930 @item --search=@var{regexp}
2931 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
2932 @cindex searching for packages
2933 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
2934 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
2935 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
2936 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
2937 GNU recutils manual}).
2938
2939 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
2940 command, for instance:
2941
2942 @example
2943 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
2944 name: jemalloc
2945 version: 4.5.0
2946 relevance: 6
2947
2948 name: glibc
2949 version: 2.25
2950 relevance: 1
2951
2952 name: libgc
2953 version: 7.6.0
2954 relevance: 1
2955 @end example
2956
2957 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
2958 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
2959
2960 @example
2961 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
2962 name: elfutils
2963
2964 name: gmp
2965 @dots{}
2966 @end example
2967
2968 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
2969 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
2970 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
2971 the @command{guix search} alias):
2972
2973 @example
2974 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
2975 name: gnubg
2976 @dots{}
2977 @end example
2978
2979 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
2980 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
2981 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
2982 keyboards.
2983
2984 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
2985 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
2986 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
2987
2988 @example
2989 $ guix search crypto library | \
2990 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
2991 @end example
2992
2993 @noindent
2994 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
2995 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
2996
2997 @item --show=@var{package}
2998 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
2999 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3000 recutils manual}).
3001
3002 @example
3003 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3004 name: python
3005 version: 2.7.6
3006
3007 name: python
3008 version: 3.3.5
3009 @end example
3010
3011 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3012 specific version of it:
3013 @example
3014 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3015 name: python
3016 version: 3.4.3
3017 @end example
3018
3019
3020
3021 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3022 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3023 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3024 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3025 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3026
3027 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3028 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3029 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3030 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3031 the store.
3032
3033 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3034 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3035 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3036 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3037 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3038
3039 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3040 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3041 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3042
3043 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3044 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3045 @cindex generations
3046 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3047 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3048 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3049 shown.
3050
3051 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3052 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3053 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3054 location of this package in the store.
3055
3056 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3057 generations. Valid patterns include:
3058
3059 @itemize
3060 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3061 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
3062 the first one.
3063
3064 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3065 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3066
3067 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3068 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3069 a range must be smaller than its end.
3070
3071 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3072 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3073 second one.
3074
3075 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3076 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3077 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3078 that are up to 20 days old.
3079 @end itemize
3080
3081 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3082 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3083 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3084 one.
3085
3086 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3087 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3088 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3089 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3090 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3091
3092 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3093 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3094
3095 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3096 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3097
3098 @end table
3099
3100 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3101 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3102 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3103 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3104 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3105 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3106 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3107 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3108
3109 @node Substitutes
3110 @section Substitutes
3111
3112 @cindex substitutes
3113 @cindex pre-built binaries
3114 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3115 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3116 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3117 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3118 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3119
3120 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3121 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3122 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3123 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3124
3125 @menu
3126 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3127 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3128 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3129 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3130 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3131 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3132 @end menu
3133
3134 @node Official Substitute Server
3135 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3136
3137 @cindex build farm
3138 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3139 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3140 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3141 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3142 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3143 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3144 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3145 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3146 option}).
3147
3148 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3149 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3150 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3151 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3152 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3153
3154 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3155 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3156 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3157 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3158 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3159 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3160 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3161 other substitute server.
3162
3163 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3164 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3165
3166 @cindex security
3167 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3168 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3169 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3170 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3171 mirror thereof, you
3172 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3173 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3174 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3175 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3176
3177 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3178 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3179 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3180 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3181 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3182 Then, you can run something like this:
3183
3184 @example
3185 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3186 @end example
3187
3188 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3189 should change from something like:
3190
3191 @example
3192 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3193 The following derivations would be built:
3194 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3195 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3196 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3197 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3198 @dots{}
3199 @end example
3200
3201 @noindent
3202 to something like:
3203
3204 @example
3205 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3206 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3207 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3208 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3209 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3210 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3211 @dots{}
3212 @end example
3213
3214 @noindent
3215 This indicates that substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and
3216 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
3217
3218 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3219 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3220 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3221 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3222 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
3223 build}, and other command-line tools.
3224
3225 @node Substitute Authentication
3226 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3227
3228 @cindex digital signatures
3229 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3230 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3231 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3232
3233 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3234 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3235 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3236 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3237 with this option:
3238
3239 @example
3240 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3241 @end example
3242
3243 @noindent
3244 @cindex reproducible builds
3245 If the ACL contains only the key for @code{b.example.org}, and if
3246 @code{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3247 then Guix will download substitutes from @code{a.example.org} because it
3248 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3249 @code{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3250 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3251 below).
3252
3253 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3254 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3255 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3256 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3257 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3258 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
3259
3260 @node Proxy Settings
3261 @subsection Proxy Settings
3262
3263 @vindex http_proxy
3264 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
3265 The @code{http_proxy} environment
3266 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
3267 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
3268 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
3269 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
3270 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3271
3272 @node Substitution Failure
3273 @subsection Substitution Failure
3274
3275 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3276 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3277 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3278 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3279 etc.
3280
3281 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3282 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3283 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3284 @code{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3285 option @code{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @code{--fallback} was
3286 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3287 considered to have failed. However, if @code{--fallback} was given,
3288 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3289 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3290 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3291 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3292 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3293 @code{--fallback} was given.
3294
3295 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3296 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3297 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3298 by a server.
3299
3300 @node On Trusting Binaries
3301 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3302
3303 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3304 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3305 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3306 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3307 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3308 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3309 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3310 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3311 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3312 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3313
3314 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3315 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3316 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3317 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3318 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3319 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3320 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3321 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3322 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3323 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3324 @command{guix build --check}}).
3325
3326 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3327 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3328 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3329
3330 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3331 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3332
3333 @cindex multiple-output packages
3334 @cindex package outputs
3335 @cindex outputs
3336
3337 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3338 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3339 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3340 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3341 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3342 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3343 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3344 files.
3345
3346 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3347 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3348 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3349 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3350 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3351 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3352 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3353
3354 @example
3355 guix install glib
3356 @end example
3357
3358 @cindex documentation
3359 The command to install its documentation is:
3360
3361 @example
3362 guix install glib:doc
3363 @end example
3364
3365 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3366 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3367 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3368 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3369 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3370 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3371 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3372 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3373 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3374
3375 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3376 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3377 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3378 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3379 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3380 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3381 guix package}).
3382
3383
3384 @node Invoking guix gc
3385 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3386
3387 @cindex garbage collector
3388 @cindex disk space
3389 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3390 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3391 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3392 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3393 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3394
3395 @cindex GC roots
3396 @cindex garbage collector roots
3397 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3398 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3399 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3400 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3401 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3402 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3403 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3404 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3405
3406 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3407 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3408 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3409 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3410 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3411
3412 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3413 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3414 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3415
3416 @example
3417 guix gc -F 5G
3418 @end example
3419
3420 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
3421 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
3422 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
3423 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
3424 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
3425 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
3426 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
3427
3428 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
3429 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
3430 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
3431 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
3432 options are as follows:
3433
3434 @table @code
3435 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
3436 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
3437 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
3438 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
3439 specified.
3440
3441 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
3442 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
3443 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
3444 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
3445
3446 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
3447
3448 @item --free-space=@var{free}
3449 @itemx -F @var{free}
3450 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
3451 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
3452 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
3453
3454 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
3455 nothing and exit immediately.
3456
3457 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
3458 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
3459 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
3460 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
3461 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
3462
3463 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
3464 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
3465 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
3466
3467 @example
3468 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
3469 @end example
3470
3471 @item --delete
3472 @itemx -D
3473 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
3474 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
3475 they are still live.
3476
3477 @item --list-failures
3478 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
3479
3480 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
3481 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
3482 @option{--cache-failures}}).
3483
3484 @item --list-roots
3485 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
3486 roots.
3487
3488 @item --clear-failures
3489 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
3490
3491 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
3492 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
3493
3494 @item --list-dead
3495 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
3496 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
3497
3498 @item --list-live
3499 Show the list of live store files and directories.
3500
3501 @end table
3502
3503 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
3504
3505 @table @code
3506
3507 @item --references
3508 @itemx --referrers
3509 @cindex package dependencies
3510 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
3511 as arguments.
3512
3513 @item --requisites
3514 @itemx -R
3515 @cindex closure
3516 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
3517 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
3518 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
3519 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
3520
3521 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
3522 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
3523 the graph of references.
3524
3525 @item --derivers
3526 @cindex derivation
3527 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
3528 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3529
3530 For example, this command:
3531
3532 @example
3533 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
3534 @end example
3535
3536 @noindent
3537 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
3538 installed in your profile.
3539
3540 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
3541 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
3542 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
3543 @end table
3544
3545 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
3546 store and to control disk usage.
3547
3548 @table @option
3549
3550 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
3551 @cindex integrity, of the store
3552 @cindex integrity checking
3553 Verify the integrity of the store.
3554
3555 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
3556 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
3557
3558 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
3559 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
3560
3561 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
3562 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
3563 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
3564 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
3565 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
3566
3567 @cindex repairing the store
3568 @cindex corruption, recovering from
3569 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
3570 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
3571 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
3572 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
3573 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
3574 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
3575 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
3576
3577 @item --optimize
3578 @cindex deduplication
3579 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
3580 @dfn{deduplication}.
3581
3582 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
3583 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
3584 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
3585 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
3586 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
3587
3588 @end table
3589
3590 @node Invoking guix pull
3591 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
3592
3593 @cindex upgrading Guix
3594 @cindex updating Guix
3595 @cindex @command{guix pull}
3596 @cindex pull
3597 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
3598 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
3599 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
3600 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
3601 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
3602 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
3603 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized.
3604
3605 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
3606 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
3607 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
3608 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
3609 become available.
3610
3611 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
3612 effect is limited to the user who run @command{guix pull}. For
3613 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
3614 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
3615 versa.
3616
3617 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
3618 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
3619 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
3620 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
3621 (@pxref{Documentation}):
3622
3623 @example
3624 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
3625 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
3626 @end example
3627
3628 The @code{--list-generations} or @code{-l} option lists past generations
3629 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
3630
3631 @example
3632 $ guix pull -l
3633 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
3634 guix 65956ad
3635 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3636 branch: origin/master
3637 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
3638
3639 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
3640 guix e0cc7f6
3641 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3642 branch: origin/master
3643 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
3644 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
3645 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
3646 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
3647 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
3648
3649 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
3650 guix 844cc1c
3651 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3652 branch: origin/master
3653 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
3654 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
3655 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
3656 @end example
3657
3658 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
3659 describe the current status of Guix.
3660
3661 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works like any other profile
3662 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
3663 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
3664 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
3665
3666 @example
3667 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
3668 switched from generation 3 to 2
3669 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
3670 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3671 @end example
3672
3673 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
3674 but it supports the following options:
3675
3676 @table @code
3677 @item --url=@var{url}
3678 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
3679 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
3680 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
3681 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
3682 string), or @var{branch}.
3683
3684 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3685 @cindex configuration file for channels
3686 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
3687 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
3688 @option{--channels} option (see below).
3689
3690 @item --channels=@var{file}
3691 @itemx -C @var{file}
3692 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
3693 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm}. @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
3694 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
3695 information.
3696
3697 @item --news
3698 @itemx -N
3699 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous generation.
3700
3701 This is the same information as displayed upon @command{guix pull} completion,
3702 but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output of @command{guix pull
3703 -l} for the last generation (see below).
3704
3705 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3706 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3707 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
3708 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
3709 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
3710 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3711
3712 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
3713 current generation only.
3714
3715 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3716 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3717 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
3718
3719 @item --dry-run
3720 @itemx -n
3721 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
3722 substituted but do not actually do it.
3723
3724 @item --system=@var{system}
3725 @itemx -s @var{system}
3726 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3727 the system type of the build host.
3728
3729 @item --verbose
3730 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
3731
3732 @item --bootstrap
3733 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
3734 useful to Guix developers.
3735 @end table
3736
3737 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
3738 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
3739 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
3740 information.
3741
3742 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
3743 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
3744
3745 @node Channels
3746 @section Channels
3747
3748 @cindex channels
3749 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3750 @cindex configuration file for channels
3751 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
3752 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
3753 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
3754 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
3755 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
3756 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
3757 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
3758 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
3759 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used to
3760 @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
3761
3762 @subsection Using a Custom Guix Channel
3763
3764 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
3765 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
3766 suppose you want to update from your own copy of the Guix repository at
3767 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
3768 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
3769
3770 @lisp
3771 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use my own repo.
3772 (list (channel
3773 (name 'guix)
3774 (url "https://example.org/my-guix.git")
3775 (branch "super-hacks")))
3776 @end lisp
3777
3778 @noindent
3779 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
3780 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}.
3781
3782 @subsection Specifying Additional Channels
3783
3784 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
3785 @cindex personal packages (channels)
3786 @cindex channels, for personal packages
3787 You can also specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. Let's say you
3788 have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages that you think
3789 would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but would like to
3790 have these packages transparently available to you at the command line. You
3791 would first write modules containing those package definitions (@pxref{Package
3792 Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and then you and anyone else can
3793 use it as an additional channel to get packages from. Neat, no?
3794
3795 @c What follows stems from discussions at
3796 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
3797 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
3798 @quotation Warning
3799 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
3800 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
3801 of caution:
3802
3803 @itemize
3804 @item
3805 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
3806 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
3807 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
3808 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
3809 process.
3810
3811 @item
3812 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
3813 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
3814 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
3815 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
3816 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
3817 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
3818 either.
3819
3820 @item
3821 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
3822 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
3823 @end itemize
3824
3825 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
3826 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
3827 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
3828 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
3829 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
3830 @end quotation
3831
3832 To use a channel, write @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct
3833 @command{guix pull} to pull from it @emph{in addition} to the default Guix
3834 channel(s):
3835
3836 @vindex %default-channels
3837 @lisp
3838 ;; Add my personal packages to those Guix provides.
3839 (cons (channel
3840 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3841 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git"))
3842 %default-channels)
3843 @end lisp
3844
3845 @noindent
3846 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
3847 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
3848 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
3849 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
3850 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
3851 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
3852 modules:
3853
3854 @example
3855 $ guix pull --list-generations
3856 @dots{}
3857 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
3858 guix d894ab8
3859 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3860 branch: master
3861 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
3862 my-personal-packages dd3df5e
3863 repository URL: https://example.org/personal-packages.git
3864 branch: master
3865 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
3866 11 new packages: my-gimp, my-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
3867 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
3868 @end example
3869
3870 @noindent
3871 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
3872 both Guix and packages from the @code{my-personal-packages} channel. Among
3873 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{my-gimp} and
3874 @code{my-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
3875 @code{my-personal-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
3876
3877 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
3878 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
3879 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
3880 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
3881 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
3882 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
3883 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
3884 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
3885 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
3886 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3887
3888 @cindex dependencies, channels
3889 @cindex meta-data, channels
3890 @subsection Declaring Channel Dependencies
3891
3892 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
3893 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
3894 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
3895 the channel repository.
3896
3897 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
3898
3899 @lisp
3900 (channel
3901 (version 0)
3902 (dependencies
3903 (channel
3904 (name some-collection)
3905 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git"))
3906 (channel
3907 (name some-other-collection)
3908 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
3909 (branch "testing"))))
3910 @end lisp
3911
3912 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
3913 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
3914 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
3915 channels are available.
3916
3917 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
3918 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
3919 dependencies to a minimum.
3920
3921 @subsection Replicating Guix
3922
3923 @cindex pinning, channels
3924 @cindex replicating Guix
3925 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
3926 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
3927 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
3928 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
3929 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
3930
3931 @lisp
3932 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
3933 (list (channel
3934 (name 'guix)
3935 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
3936 (commit "d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300"))
3937 (channel
3938 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3939 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git")
3940 (branch "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
3941 @end lisp
3942
3943 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
3944 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
3945
3946 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
3947 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
3948 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
3949 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
3950 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
3951 package it defines.
3952
3953 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
3954 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
3955 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
3956 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
3957
3958 @node Inferiors
3959 @section Inferiors
3960
3961 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
3962 @quotation Note
3963 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
3964 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
3965 @end quotation
3966
3967 @cindex inferiors
3968 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
3969 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
3970 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
3971 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
3972 revisions in arbitrary ways.
3973
3974 @cindex inferior packages
3975 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
3976 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
3977 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
3978 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
3979 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
3980
3981 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
3982 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
3983 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
3984 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
3985 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
3986 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
3987 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
3988 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
3989 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
3990
3991 @lisp
3992 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
3993 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
3994
3995 (define channels
3996 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
3997 ;; extract guile-json.
3998 (list (channel
3999 (name 'guix)
4000 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4001 (commit
4002 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4003
4004 (define inferior
4005 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4006 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4007
4008 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4009 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4010 (packages->manifest
4011 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4012 (specification->package "guile")))
4013 @end lisp
4014
4015 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4016 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4017 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4018
4019 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4020 inferior:
4021
4022 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4023 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4024 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4025 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4026 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4027
4028 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4029 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4030 @end deffn
4031
4032 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4033 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4034 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4035 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4036 the inferior could not be launched.
4037 @end deffn
4038
4039 @cindex inferior packages
4040 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4041 packages.
4042
4043 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4044 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4045 @end deffn
4046
4047 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4048 [@var{version}]
4049 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4050 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4051 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4052 @end deffn
4053
4054 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4055 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4056 @end deffn
4057
4058 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4059 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4060 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4061 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4062 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4063 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4064 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4065 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4066 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4067 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4068 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4069 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4070 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4071 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4072 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4073 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4074 these procedures.
4075 @end deffn
4076
4077 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4078 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4079 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4080 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4081 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4082 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4083 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4084 declaration, and so on.
4085
4086 @node Invoking guix describe
4087 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4088
4089 @cindex reproducibility
4090 @cindex replicating Guix
4091 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4092 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4093 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4094 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4095 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4096 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4097 command answers these questions.
4098
4099 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4100 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4101 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4102
4103 @example
4104 $ guix describe
4105 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4106 guix e0fa68c
4107 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4108 branch: master
4109 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4110 @end example
4111
4112 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4113 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4114 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4115 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4116 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4117 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4118 also to replicate it.
4119
4120 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4121 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4122
4123 @example
4124 $ guix describe -f channels
4125 (list (channel
4126 (name 'guix)
4127 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4128 (commit
4129 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")))
4130 @end example
4131
4132 @noindent
4133 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4134 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4135 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4136 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4137 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4138 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4139
4140 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4141 follows:
4142
4143 @table @code
4144 @item --format=@var{format}
4145 @itemx -f @var{format}
4146 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4147
4148 @table @code
4149 @item human
4150 produce human-readable output;
4151 @item channels
4152 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4153 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4154 guix pull});
4155 @item json
4156 @cindex JSON
4157 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4158 @item recutils
4159 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4160 @end table
4161
4162 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4163 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4164 Display information about @var{profile}.
4165 @end table
4166
4167 @node Invoking guix archive
4168 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4169
4170 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4171 @cindex archive
4172 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4173 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4174 a machine that runs Guix.
4175 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4176 to the store on another machine.
4177
4178 @quotation Note
4179 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4180 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4181 @end quotation
4182
4183 @cindex exporting store items
4184 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4185
4186 @example
4187 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4188 @end example
4189
4190 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4191 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4192 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4193 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4194 output of @code{emacs}:
4195
4196 @example
4197 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4198 @end example
4199
4200 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4201 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4202 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4203
4204 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4205 one would run:
4206
4207 @example
4208 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4209 @end example
4210
4211 @noindent
4212 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4213 to another like this:
4214
4215 @example
4216 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4217 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4218 @end example
4219
4220 @noindent
4221 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4222 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4223 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
4224 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
4225 items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4226 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4227 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4228
4229 @cindex nar, archive format
4230 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4231 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
4232 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4233 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4234 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4235 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4236 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4237 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4238 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4239 deterministic.
4240
4241 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4242 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4243 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4244 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4245 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4246
4247 The main options are:
4248
4249 @table @code
4250 @item --export
4251 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
4252 resulting archive to the standard output.
4253
4254 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4255 @code{--recursive} is passed.
4256
4257 @item -r
4258 @itemx --recursive
4259 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
4260 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
4261 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
4262 of the exported store items.
4263
4264 @item --import
4265 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4266 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4267 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4268 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
4269
4270 @item --missing
4271 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4272 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4273 the store.
4274
4275 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4276 @cindex signing, archives
4277 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4278 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
4279 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
4280 generate the key pair.
4281
4282 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4283 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4284 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4285 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4286 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4287 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4288 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4289 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4290 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4291
4292 @item --authorize
4293 @cindex authorizing, archives
4294 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4295 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4296 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4297
4298 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4299 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4300 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4301 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4302 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4303 (SPKI)}.
4304
4305 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4306 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4307 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4308 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4309 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4310
4311 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4312 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4313
4314 @example
4315 $ wget -O - \
4316 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4317 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4318 @end example
4319
4320 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4321 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4322 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4323 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4324 unsafe.
4325
4326 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4327 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
4328
4329 @end table
4330
4331
4332 @c *********************************************************************
4333 @node Development
4334 @chapter Development
4335
4336 @cindex software development
4337 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
4338 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
4339 this chapter is about.
4340
4341 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
4342 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
4343 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
4344 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
4345 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
4346
4347 @menu
4348 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4349 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
4350 @end menu
4351
4352 @node Invoking guix environment
4353 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4354
4355 @cindex reproducible build environments
4356 @cindex development environments
4357 @cindex @command{guix environment}
4358 @cindex environment, package build environment
4359 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4360 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4361 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4362 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
4363 environment to use them.
4364
4365 The general syntax is:
4366
4367 @example
4368 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4369 @end example
4370
4371 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4372 GNU@tie{}Guile:
4373
4374 @example
4375 guix environment guile
4376 @end example
4377
4378 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4379 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
4380 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4381 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4382 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4383 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
4384 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4385 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4386 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4387 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4388 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4389 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4390 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4391 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
4392 details on Bash start-up files.}.
4393
4394 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4395 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4396 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
4397 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
4398 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4399 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4400
4401 @example
4402 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4403 then
4404 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4405 fi
4406 @end example
4407
4408 @noindent
4409 ...@: or to browse the profile:
4410
4411 @example
4412 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
4413 @end example
4414
4415 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4416 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4417 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4418 and Emacs are available:
4419
4420 @example
4421 guix environment guile emacs
4422 @end example
4423
4424 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4425 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4426 command from the rest of the arguments:
4427
4428 @example
4429 guix environment guile -- make -j4
4430 @end example
4431
4432 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4433 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4434 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4435 NumPy:
4436
4437 @example
4438 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
4439 @end example
4440
4441 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4442 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4443 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4444 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4445 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4446 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4447 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4448 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4449 additionally includes Git and strace:
4450
4451 @example
4452 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
4453 @end example
4454
4455 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4456 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4457 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
4458 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4459 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4460 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4461 working directory are mounted:
4462
4463 @example
4464 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4465 @end example
4466
4467 @quotation Note
4468 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
4469 @end quotation
4470
4471 The available options are summarized below.
4472
4473 @table @code
4474 @item --root=@var{file}
4475 @itemx -r @var{file}
4476 @cindex persistent environment
4477 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
4478 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
4479 register it as a garbage collector root.
4480
4481 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
4482 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
4483
4484 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
4485 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
4486 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
4487 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
4488 gc}, for more on GC roots.
4489
4490 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4491 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4492 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
4493 @var{expr} evaluates to.
4494
4495 For example, running:
4496
4497 @example
4498 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
4499 @end example
4500
4501 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
4502 PETSc package.
4503
4504 Running:
4505
4506 @example
4507 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
4508 @end example
4509
4510 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
4511
4512 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
4513 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
4514
4515 @example
4516 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
4517 @end example
4518
4519 @item --load=@var{file}
4520 @itemx -l @var{file}
4521 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
4522 within @var{file} evaluates to.
4523
4524 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
4525 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4526
4527 @example
4528 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
4529 @end example
4530
4531 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4532 @itemx -m @var{file}
4533 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
4534 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
4535
4536 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
4537 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
4538 manifest files.
4539
4540 @item --ad-hoc
4541 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
4542 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
4543 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
4544 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
4545
4546 For instance, the command:
4547
4548 @example
4549 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
4550 @end example
4551
4552 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
4553 available.
4554
4555 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
4556 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
4557 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
4558 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4559
4560 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
4561 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
4562 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
4563 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
4564 that will be added to the environment directly.
4565
4566 @item --pure
4567 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
4568 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below.) This has the effect of
4569 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
4570
4571 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
4572 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
4573 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
4574 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
4575 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
4576 several times.
4577
4578 @example
4579 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
4580 -- mpirun @dots{}
4581 @end example
4582
4583 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
4584 variables defined are @code{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
4585 with @code{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@code{HOME},
4586 @code{USER}, etc.)
4587
4588 @item --search-paths
4589 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
4590 environment.
4591
4592 @item --system=@var{system}
4593 @itemx -s @var{system}
4594 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
4595
4596 @item --container
4597 @itemx -C
4598 @cindex container
4599 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
4600 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
4601 Additionally, unless overridden with @code{--user}, a dummy home
4602 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
4603 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
4604
4605 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
4606 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
4607 @option{--user} is passed (see below.)
4608
4609 @item --network
4610 @itemx -N
4611 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
4612 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
4613 device.
4614
4615 @item --link-profile
4616 @itemx -P
4617 For containers, link the environment profile to
4618 @file{~/.guix-profile} within the container. This is equivalent to
4619 running the command @command{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile}
4620 within the container. Linking will fail and abort the environment if
4621 the directory already exists, which will certainly be the case if
4622 @command{guix environment} was invoked in the user's home directory.
4623
4624 Certain packages are configured to look in
4625 @code{~/.guix-profile} for configuration files and data;@footnote{For
4626 example, the @code{fontconfig} package inspects
4627 @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts} for additional fonts.}
4628 @code{--link-profile} allows these programs to behave as expected within
4629 the environment.
4630
4631 @item --user=@var{user}
4632 @itemx -u @var{user}
4633 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
4634 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
4635 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
4636 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
4637 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
4638 need not exist on the system.
4639
4640 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @code{--share} and
4641 @code{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
4642 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
4643 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
4644
4645 @example
4646 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
4647 cd $HOME/wd
4648 guix environment --container --user=foo \
4649 --expose=$HOME/test \
4650 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
4651 @end example
4652
4653 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
4654 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
4655 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
4656
4657 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4658 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
4659 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
4660 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4661 point in the container.
4662
4663 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4664 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
4665 directory:
4666
4667 @example
4668 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4669 @end example
4670
4671 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4672 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
4673 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
4674 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4675 point in the container.
4676
4677 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4678 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
4679 @file{/exchange} directory:
4680
4681 @example
4682 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4683 @end example
4684 @end table
4685
4686 @command{guix environment}
4687 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
4688 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
4689 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4690
4691 @node Invoking guix pack
4692 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
4693
4694 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
4695 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
4696 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
4697 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
4698
4699 @quotation Note
4700 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
4701 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
4702 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
4703 @end quotation
4704
4705 @cindex pack
4706 @cindex bundle
4707 @cindex application bundle
4708 @cindex software bundle
4709 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
4710 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
4711 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
4712 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
4713 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
4714 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
4715 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
4716 that you pretend to be shipping.
4717
4718 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
4719 their dependencies, you can run:
4720
4721 @example
4722 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
4723 @dots{}
4724 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
4725 @end example
4726
4727 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
4728 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
4729 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
4730 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
4731 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
4732 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
4733
4734 Users of this pack would have to run
4735 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
4736 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
4737 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
4738
4739 @example
4740 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
4741 @end example
4742
4743 @noindent
4744 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
4745
4746 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
4747 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
4748 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
4749 that case, you will want to use the @code{--relocatable} option (see
4750 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
4751 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
4752 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
4753 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
4754
4755 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
4756 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
4757 the following command:
4758
4759 @example
4760 guix pack -f docker guile emacs geiser
4761 @end example
4762
4763 @noindent
4764 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
4765 command. See the
4766 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
4767 documentation} for more information.
4768
4769 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
4770 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
4771 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
4772 command:
4773
4774 @example
4775 guix pack -f squashfs guile emacs geiser
4776 @end example
4777
4778 @noindent
4779 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
4780 directly be used as a file system container image with the
4781 @uref{https://singularity.lbl.gov, Singularity container execution
4782 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
4783 @command{singularity exec}.
4784
4785 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
4786
4787 @table @code
4788 @item --format=@var{format}
4789 @itemx -f @var{format}
4790 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
4791
4792 The available formats are:
4793
4794 @table @code
4795 @item tarball
4796 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
4797 specified binaries and symlinks.
4798
4799 @item docker
4800 This produces a tarball that follows the
4801 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
4802 Docker Image Specification}.
4803
4804 @item squashfs
4805 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
4806 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
4807 procfs.
4808 @end table
4809
4810 @cindex relocatable binaries
4811 @item --relocatable
4812 @itemx -R
4813 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
4814 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
4815
4816 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
4817 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
4818 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
4819 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
4820 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to PRoot
4821 if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially work anywhere---see below
4822 for the implications.
4823
4824 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
4825
4826 @example
4827 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
4828 @end example
4829
4830 @noindent
4831 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
4832 home directory as a normal user, run:
4833
4834 @example
4835 tar xf pack.tar.gz
4836 ./mybin/sh
4837 @end example
4838
4839 @noindent
4840 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
4841 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
4842 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
4843 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
4844 software on a non-Guix machine.
4845
4846 @quotation Note
4847 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
4848 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
4849 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
4850 turn it off.
4851
4852 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
4853 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
4854 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to PRoot if user
4855 namespaces are not supported.
4856
4857 The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program provides the necessary
4858 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
4859 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
4860 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
4861 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
4862 @end quotation
4863
4864 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
4865 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
4866 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
4867 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
4868 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
4869 pack.
4870
4871 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
4872 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
4873 do:
4874
4875 @example
4876 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
4877 @end example
4878
4879 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
4880 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
4881
4882 @example
4883 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
4884 docker run @var{image-id}
4885 @end example
4886
4887 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4888 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4889 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4890
4891 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
4892 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @code{--expression} in
4893 @command{guix build}}).
4894
4895 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4896 @itemx -m @var{file}
4897 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
4898 code in @var{file}.
4899
4900 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
4901 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
4902 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
4903 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
4904 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
4905 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
4906 but not both.
4907
4908 @item --system=@var{system}
4909 @itemx -s @var{system}
4910 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4911 the system type of the build host.
4912
4913 @item --target=@var{triplet}
4914 @cindex cross-compilation
4915 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4916 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
4917 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
4918
4919 @item --compression=@var{tool}
4920 @itemx -C @var{tool}
4921 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
4922 @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no compression.
4923
4924 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
4925 @itemx -S @var{spec}
4926 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
4927 appear several times.
4928
4929 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
4930 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
4931 symlink target.
4932
4933 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
4934 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
4935
4936 @item --save-provenance
4937 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
4938 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
4939 (@pxref{Channels}).
4940
4941 Provenance information is saved in the
4942 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
4943 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
4944 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
4945 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
4946
4947 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
4948 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
4949 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
4950 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
4951 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
4952
4953 @item --root=@var{file}
4954 @itemx -r @var{file}
4955 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
4956 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
4957 collector root.
4958
4959 @item --localstatedir
4960 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
4961 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
4962 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
4963 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
4964 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
4965
4966 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
4967 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
4968 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
4969 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
4970 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
4971
4972 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
4973 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
4974
4975 @item --bootstrap
4976 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
4977 useful to Guix developers.
4978 @end table
4979
4980 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
4981 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
4982 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4983
4984
4985 @c *********************************************************************
4986 @node Programming Interface
4987 @chapter Programming Interface
4988
4989 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
4990 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
4991 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
4992 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
4993 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
4994 turned into concrete build actions.
4995
4996 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
4997 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
4998 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
4999 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
5000 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
5001
5002 @cindex derivation
5003 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
5004 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
5005 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
5006 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
5007 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
5008 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
5009 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
5010
5011 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
5012 package definitions.
5013
5014 @menu
5015 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
5016 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
5017 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
5018 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
5019 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
5020 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
5021 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
5022 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
5023 @end menu
5024
5025 @node Package Modules
5026 @section Package Modules
5027
5028 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
5029 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
5030 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
5031 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
5032 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
5033 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
5034 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
5035 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
5036 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
5037 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
5038 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5039
5040 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
5041 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
5042 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
5043 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
5044 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
5045 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
5046
5047 @cindex customization, of packages
5048 @cindex package module search path
5049 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
5050 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
5051 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
5052 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
5053 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
5054 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
5055 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
5056 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
5057
5058 @enumerate
5059 @item
5060 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
5061 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
5062 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5063 environment variable described below.
5064
5065 @item
5066 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
5067 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
5068 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
5069 channels.
5070 @end enumerate
5071
5072 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
5073
5074 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5075 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
5076 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
5077 over the own modules of the distribution.
5078 @end defvr
5079
5080 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
5081 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
5082 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
5083 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
5084 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
5085 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
5086
5087 @node Defining Packages
5088 @section Defining Packages
5089
5090 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
5091 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
5092 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
5093 package looks like this:
5094
5095 @example
5096 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
5097 #:use-module (guix packages)
5098 #:use-module (guix download)
5099 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
5100 #:use-module (guix licenses)
5101 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
5102
5103 (define-public hello
5104 (package
5105 (name "hello")
5106 (version "2.10")
5107 (source (origin
5108 (method url-fetch)
5109 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
5110 ".tar.gz"))
5111 (sha256
5112 (base32
5113 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
5114 (build-system gnu-build-system)
5115 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
5116 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
5117 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
5118 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
5119 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
5120 (license gpl3+)))
5121 @end example
5122
5123 @noindent
5124 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
5125 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
5126 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
5127 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5128 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
5129 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
5130 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
5131
5132 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
5133 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
5134 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
5135
5136 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
5137 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
5138 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
5139 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
5140 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5141
5142 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
5143
5144 @itemize
5145 @item
5146 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
5147 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
5148 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
5149 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
5150
5151 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
5152 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
5153
5154 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
5155 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
5156 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
5157 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
5158 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
5159 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
5160
5161 @cindex patches
5162 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
5163 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
5164 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
5165
5166 @item
5167 @cindex GNU Build System
5168 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
5169 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
5170 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
5171 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
5172 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
5173
5174 @item
5175 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
5176 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
5177 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
5178 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
5179
5180 @cindex quote
5181 @cindex quoting
5182 @findex '
5183 @findex quote
5184 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
5185 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
5186 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
5187 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
5188 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
5189 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5190 Manual}).
5191
5192 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
5193 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
5194 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
5195 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
5196 Reference Manual}).
5197
5198 @item
5199 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
5200 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
5201 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
5202 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
5203
5204 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
5205 @findex `
5206 @findex quasiquote
5207 @cindex comma (unquote)
5208 @findex ,
5209 @findex unquote
5210 @findex ,@@
5211 @findex unquote-splicing
5212 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
5213 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
5214 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
5215 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
5216 Reference Manual}).
5217
5218 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
5219 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
5220 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
5221
5222 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
5223 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
5224 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
5225 @end itemize
5226
5227 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
5228
5229 Once a package definition is in place, the
5230 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
5231 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
5232 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
5233 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
5234 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
5235 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
5236 more information on how to test package definitions, and
5237 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
5238 for style conformance.
5239 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5240 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
5241 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
5242 in a ``channel''.
5243
5244 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
5245 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
5246 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
5247
5248 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
5249 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
5250 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
5251 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
5252 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
5253
5254 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
5255 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
5256 (@pxref{Derivations}).
5257
5258 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
5259 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
5260 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
5261 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
5262 (@pxref{The Store}).
5263 @end deffn
5264
5265 @noindent
5266 @cindex cross-compilation
5267 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
5268 package for some other system:
5269
5270 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
5271 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
5272 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
5273 @var{system} to @var{target}.
5274
5275 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
5276 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
5277 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5278 @end deffn
5279
5280 @cindex package transformations
5281 @cindex input rewriting
5282 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
5283 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
5284 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
5285 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
5286
5287 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
5288 [@var{rewrite-name}]
5289 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
5290 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
5291 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
5292 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
5293 is the replacement.
5294
5295 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
5296 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
5297 @end deffn
5298
5299 @noindent
5300 Consider this example:
5301
5302 @example
5303 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5304 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
5305 ;; recursively.
5306 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
5307
5308 (define git-with-libressl
5309 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
5310 @end example
5311
5312 @noindent
5313 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
5314 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
5315 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
5316 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
5317 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
5318
5319 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
5320 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
5321
5322 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements}
5323 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given @var{replacements} to
5324 all the package graph (excluding implicit inputs). @var{replacements} is a list of
5325 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as @code{"gcc"} or
5326 @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching package and returns a
5327 replacement for that package.
5328 @end deffn
5329
5330 The example above could be rewritten this way:
5331
5332 @example
5333 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5334 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
5335 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
5336 @end example
5337
5338 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
5339 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
5340 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
5341
5342 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
5343 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
5344 graph.
5345
5346 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
5347 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
5348 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
5349 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
5350 @end deffn
5351
5352 @menu
5353 * package Reference:: The package data type.
5354 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
5355 @end menu
5356
5357
5358 @node package Reference
5359 @subsection @code{package} Reference
5360
5361 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
5362 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5363
5364 @deftp {Data Type} package
5365 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
5366
5367 @table @asis
5368 @item @code{name}
5369 The name of the package, as a string.
5370
5371 @item @code{version}
5372 The version of the package, as a string.
5373
5374 @item @code{source}
5375 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
5376 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
5377 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
5378 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
5379 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5380 @code{local-file}}).
5381
5382 @item @code{build-system}
5383 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
5384 Systems}).
5385
5386 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5387 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
5388 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
5389
5390 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5391 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5392 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5393 @cindex inputs, of packages
5394 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
5395 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
5396 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
5397 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
5398 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
5399 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
5400 inputs:
5401
5402 @example
5403 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
5404 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
5405 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
5406 @end example
5407
5408 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
5409 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
5410 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
5411 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
5412 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
5413 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
5414
5415 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
5416 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
5417 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
5418 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
5419
5420 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
5421 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
5422 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
5423 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
5424 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
5425 propagated inputs.)
5426
5427 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
5428 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
5429 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
5430
5431 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
5432 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
5433 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
5434 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
5435 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
5436 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
5437
5438 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
5439 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
5440 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
5441
5442 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5443 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5444 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
5445 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
5446
5447 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
5448 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
5449 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
5450 for details.
5451
5452 @item @code{synopsis}
5453 A one-line description of the package.
5454
5455 @item @code{description}
5456 A more elaborate description of the package.
5457
5458 @item @code{license}
5459 @cindex license, of packages
5460 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
5461 or a list of such values.
5462
5463 @item @code{home-page}
5464 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
5465
5466 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
5467 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
5468 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
5469
5470 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
5471 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
5472
5473 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
5474 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
5475 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
5476 automatically corrected.
5477 @end table
5478 @end deftp
5479
5480 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
5481 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
5482 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
5483
5484 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
5485 cross-compiling:
5486
5487 @example
5488 (package
5489 (name "guile")
5490 ;; ...
5491
5492 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
5493 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
5494 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
5495 `(("self" ,this-package))
5496 '())))
5497 @end example
5498
5499 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
5500 @end deffn
5501
5502 @node origin Reference
5503 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
5504
5505 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
5506 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5507
5508 @deftp {Data Type} origin
5509 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
5510
5511 @table @asis
5512 @item @code{uri}
5513 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
5514 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
5515 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
5516 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
5517
5518 @item @code{method}
5519 A procedure that handles the URI.
5520
5521 Examples include:
5522
5523 @table @asis
5524 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
5525 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
5526 @code{uri} field;
5527
5528 @vindex git-fetch
5529 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
5530 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
5531 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
5532 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
5533
5534 @example
5535 (git-reference
5536 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
5537 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
5538 @end example
5539 @end table
5540
5541 @item @code{sha256}
5542 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
5543 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
5544 base-32 string.
5545
5546 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
5547 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
5548 guix hash}).
5549
5550 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
5551 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
5552 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
5553 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
5554 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
5555 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
5556
5557 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
5558 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5559 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
5560
5561 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
5562 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
5563 @code{%current-target-system}.
5564
5565 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
5566 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
5567 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
5568 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
5569
5570 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
5571 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
5572 command.
5573
5574 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
5575 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
5576 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
5577 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
5578
5579 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
5580 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
5581 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
5582
5583 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
5584 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
5585 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
5586 @end table
5587 @end deftp
5588
5589
5590 @node Build Systems
5591 @section Build Systems
5592
5593 @cindex build system
5594 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
5595 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
5596 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
5597 dependencies of that build procedure.
5598
5599 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
5600 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
5601 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
5602
5603 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
5604 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
5605 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
5606 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
5607 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
5608 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
5609 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
5610
5611 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
5612 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
5613 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
5614 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
5615 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
5616 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
5617 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
5618
5619 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
5620 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
5621 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
5622
5623 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
5624 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
5625 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
5626 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
5627
5628 @cindex build phases
5629 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
5630 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
5631 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
5632 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
5633 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
5634 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
5635
5636 @table @code
5637 @item unpack
5638 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
5639 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
5640 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
5641
5642 @item patch-source-shebangs
5643 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
5644 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
5645 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
5646
5647 @item configure
5648 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
5649 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
5650 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
5651
5652 @item build
5653 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
5654 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
5655 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
5656
5657 @item check
5658 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
5659 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
5660 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
5661 check -j}.
5662
5663 @item install
5664 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
5665
5666 @item patch-shebangs
5667 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
5668
5669 @item strip
5670 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
5671 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
5672 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
5673 @end table
5674
5675 @vindex %standard-phases
5676 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
5677 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
5678 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
5679 procedure implements the actual phase.
5680
5681 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
5682 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
5683
5684 @example
5685 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
5686 @end example
5687
5688 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
5689 @code{configure} phase.
5690
5691 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
5692 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
5693 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
5694 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
5695 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
5696 have to mention them.
5697 @end defvr
5698
5699 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
5700 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
5701 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
5702 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
5703 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
5704
5705 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
5706 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
5707 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
5708 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
5709
5710 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
5711 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
5712 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
5713 parameters, respectively.
5714
5715 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
5716 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
5717 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
5718 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
5719 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
5720
5721 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
5722 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
5723 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
5724 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
5725 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
5726 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
5727 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
5728
5729 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
5730 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
5731 ``jar'' task will be run.
5732
5733 @end defvr
5734
5735 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
5736 @cindex Android distribution
5737 @cindex Android NDK build system
5738 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
5739 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
5740 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
5741
5742 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
5743 (header) files to the subdirectory "include" of the "out" output and
5744 their libraries to the subdirectory "lib" of the "out" output.
5745
5746 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
5747 has no conflicting files.
5748
5749 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
5750 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
5751
5752 @end defvr
5753
5754 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
5755 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
5756 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
5757
5758 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
5759 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
5760 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
5761 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
5762
5763 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
5764 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
5765 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
5766 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
5767 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
5768 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
5769
5770 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
5771 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
5772 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
5773
5774 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
5775 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
5776 the @code{cl-} prefix.
5777
5778 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
5779 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
5780 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
5781 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
5782
5783 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
5784 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
5785 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
5786 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
5787 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
5788 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
5789
5790 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
5791 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
5792 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
5793 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
5794 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
5795 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
5796 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
5797 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
5798
5799 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
5800 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
5801 be used to specify the name of the system.
5802
5803 @end defvr
5804
5805 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
5806 @cindex Rust programming language
5807 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
5808 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
5809 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
5810 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
5811
5812 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
5813 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
5814
5815 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
5816 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
5817 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
5818 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
5819 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
5820 should be added to the package definition via the
5821 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
5822
5823 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
5824 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
5825 parameters available to cargo. The @code{install} phase installs any crate
5826 the binaries if they are defined by the crate.
5827 @end defvr
5828
5829 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
5830 @cindex simple Clojure build system
5831 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
5832 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
5833 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
5834 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
5835 yet.
5836
5837 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
5838 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
5839 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
5840
5841 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
5842 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
5843 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
5844 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
5845 Other parameters are documented below.
5846
5847 This build system is an extension of @var{ant-build-system}, but with the
5848 following phases changed:
5849
5850 @table @code
5851
5852 @item build
5853 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
5854 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
5855 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
5856 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
5857 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
5858 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
5859 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
5860 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
5861
5862 @item check
5863 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
5864 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
5865 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
5866 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
5867 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
5868 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
5869
5870 @item install
5871 This phase installs all jars built previously.
5872 @end table
5873
5874 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
5875
5876 @table @code
5877
5878 @item install-doc
5879 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
5880 @var{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
5881 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
5882 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
5883 @end table
5884 @end defvr
5885
5886 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
5887 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
5888 implements the build procedure for packages using the
5889 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
5890
5891 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
5892 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
5893 parameter.
5894
5895 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
5896 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
5897 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
5898 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
5899 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
5900 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
5901 @end defvr
5902
5903 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
5904 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
5905 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
5906 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
5907 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
5908 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
5909 system.
5910
5911 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
5912 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
5913 parameter.
5914
5915 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
5916 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
5917 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
5918
5919 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
5920 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
5921 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
5922
5923 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
5924 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
5925 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
5926 @code{dune}.
5927 @end defvr
5928
5929 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
5930 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
5931 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
5932 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
5933 Go build mechanisms}.
5934
5935 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
5936 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
5937 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
5938 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
5939 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
5940 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
5941 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
5942 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
5943 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
5944 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
5945
5946 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
5947 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
5948 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
5949 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
5950 @end defvr
5951
5952 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
5953 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
5954 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
5955
5956 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
5957 @var{gnu-build-system}:
5958
5959 @table @code
5960 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
5961 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
5962 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
5963 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
5964 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
5965 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
5966 environment variables.
5967
5968 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
5969 process by listing their names in the
5970 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
5971 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
5972 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
5973 GLib and GTK+.
5974
5975 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
5976 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
5977 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
5978 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
5979 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
5980 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
5981 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
5982 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
5983 @end table
5984
5985 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
5986 @end defvr
5987
5988 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
5989 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
5990 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
5991 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
5992 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
5993 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
5994 installs documentation.
5995
5996 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the @code{--target}
5997 option of @command{guild compile}.
5998
5999 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
6000 their @code{native-inputs} field.
6001 @end defvr
6002
6003 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
6004 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
6005 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
6006
6007 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
6008 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
6009 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
6010 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
6011 output.
6012
6013 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
6014 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
6015 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
6016 @end defvr
6017
6018 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
6019 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
6020 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
6021 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
6022 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
6023 try some of them.
6024
6025 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
6026 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
6027 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
6028 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
6029 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
6030 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
6031 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
6032 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
6033 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
6034
6035 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
6036 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
6037 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
6038 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
6039
6040 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
6041 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
6042 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
6043
6044 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
6045 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
6046 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
6047 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
6048 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
6049 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
6050 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
6051
6052 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
6053 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
6054 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
6055 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
6056 libraries cannot be found and we use @code{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
6057 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
6058 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
6059 @end defvr
6060
6061 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
6062 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
6063 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
6064 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
6065 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
6066
6067 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
6068 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
6069 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
6070
6071 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
6072 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
6073 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
6074 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
6075 interpreter version.
6076
6077 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
6078 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
6079 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
6080 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools} parameter to @code{#f}.
6081 @end defvr
6082
6083 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
6084 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
6085 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
6086 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
6087 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
6088 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
6089 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
6090 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
6091 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
6092 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
6093 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
6094 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
6095
6096 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
6097 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
6098 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
6099
6100 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
6101 @end defvr
6102
6103 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
6104 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
6105 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
6106 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
6107 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
6108 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
6109 are run after installation using the R function
6110 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
6111 @end defvr
6112
6113 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
6114 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
6115 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
6116 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
6117 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
6118 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
6119 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
6120 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
6121
6122 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
6123 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
6124 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6125 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
6126 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
6127 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6128 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
6129 @end defvr
6130
6131 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
6132 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
6133 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
6134 build system sets the @code{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
6135 files in the inputs.
6136
6137 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
6138 different engine and format can be specified with the
6139 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
6140 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
6141 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
6142 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
6143 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
6144 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
6145
6146 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
6147 install the built files under the texmf tree.
6148 @end defvr
6149
6150 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
6151 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
6152 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
6153 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
6154
6155 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
6156 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
6157 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
6158 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
6159 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
6160 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
6161 a traditional source release tarball.
6162
6163 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6164 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
6165 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
6166 @end defvr
6167
6168 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
6169 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
6170 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
6171 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
6172 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
6173 script.
6174
6175 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
6176 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
6177 @code{#:python} parameter.
6178 @end defvr
6179
6180 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
6181 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
6182 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
6183 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
6184 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
6185 the package.
6186
6187 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
6188 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The version of Python used to run SCons
6189 can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package with the
6190 @code{#:scons} parameter.
6191 @end defvr
6192
6193 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
6194 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
6195 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
6196 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
6197 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
6198 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
6199 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
6200 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
6201 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
6202 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
6203 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
6204 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
6205 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
6206 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
6207
6208 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
6209 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
6210 @end defvr
6211
6212 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
6213 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
6214 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
6215 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
6216 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
6217
6218 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
6219 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
6220 @end defvr
6221
6222 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
6223 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
6224 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
6225 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6226
6227 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
6228 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
6229 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
6230 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
6231 package is installed in its own directory under
6232 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
6233 @end defvr
6234
6235 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
6236 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
6237 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
6238 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
6239 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
6240 locations in the output directory.
6241 @end defvr
6242
6243 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
6244 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
6245 implements the build procedure for packages that use
6246 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
6247
6248 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
6249 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
6250 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
6251 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
6252 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
6253
6254 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6255 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
6256
6257 @table @code
6258
6259 @item configure
6260 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
6261 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @code{--build-type} is always set to
6262 @code{plain} unless something else is specified in @code{#:build-type}.
6263
6264 @item build
6265 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
6266 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
6267
6268 @item check
6269 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
6270 which is @code{"test"} by default.
6271
6272 @item install
6273 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
6274 @end table
6275
6276 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
6277
6278 @table @code
6279
6280 @item fix-runpath
6281 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
6282 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
6283 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
6284 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
6285 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
6286 required for the program to run.
6287
6288 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6289 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6290 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6291
6292 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6293 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6294 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6295 @end table
6296 @end defvr
6297
6298 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
6299 @var{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
6300
6301 @cindex build phases
6302 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6303 following phases changed:
6304
6305 @table @code
6306
6307 @item configure
6308 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
6309 can be used to build the external kernel module.
6310
6311 @item build
6312 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
6313 kernel module.
6314
6315 @item install
6316 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
6317 kernel module.
6318 @end table
6319
6320 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
6321 the module (in the "arguments" form of a package using the
6322 linux-module-build-system, use the key #:linux to specify it).
6323 @end defvr
6324
6325 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
6326 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
6327 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
6328 and does not have a notion of build phases.
6329
6330 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
6331 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
6332
6333 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
6334 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
6335 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
6336 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
6337 @end defvr
6338
6339 @node The Store
6340 @section The Store
6341
6342 @cindex store
6343 @cindex store items
6344 @cindex store paths
6345
6346 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
6347 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
6348 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
6349 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
6350 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
6351 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
6352 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
6353 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
6354 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
6355
6356 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
6357 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
6358 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
6359 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
6360
6361 @quotation Note
6362 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
6363 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
6364 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
6365
6366 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
6367 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
6368 accidental modifications.
6369 @end quotation
6370
6371 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
6372 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
6373 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
6374 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
6375 @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
6376
6377 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
6378 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
6379 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
6380 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
6381 supported URI schemes are:
6382
6383 @table @code
6384 @item file
6385 @itemx unix
6386 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
6387 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
6388 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
6389
6390 @item guix
6391 @cindex daemon, remote access
6392 @cindex remote access to the daemon
6393 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
6394 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
6395 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
6396 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
6397 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
6398
6399 @example
6400 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
6401 @end example
6402
6403 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
6404 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
6405 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
6406
6407 The @code{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
6408 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
6409 @code{--listen}}).
6410
6411 @item ssh
6412 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
6413 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over
6414 SSH@footnote{This feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}).}.
6415 A typical URL might look like this:
6416
6417 @example
6418 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
6419 @end example
6420
6421 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
6422 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
6423 @end table
6424
6425 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
6426
6427 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
6428 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
6429 @quotation Note
6430 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
6431 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
6432 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
6433 @end quotation
6434 @end defvr
6435
6436 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
6437 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
6438 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
6439 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
6440 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
6441
6442 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
6443 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
6444 @end deffn
6445
6446 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
6447 Close the connection to @var{server}.
6448 @end deffn
6449
6450 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
6451 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
6452 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
6453 @end defvr
6454
6455 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
6456 argument.
6457
6458 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
6459 @cindex invalid store items
6460 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
6461 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
6462 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
6463 build.)
6464
6465 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
6466 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
6467 @end deffn
6468
6469 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6470 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
6471 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
6472 resulting store path.
6473 @end deffn
6474
6475 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
6476 [@var{mode}]
6477 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
6478 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
6479 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
6480 @end deffn
6481
6482 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
6483 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
6484 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
6485 Store Monad}).
6486
6487 @c FIXME
6488 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
6489
6490 @node Derivations
6491 @section Derivations
6492
6493 @cindex derivations
6494 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
6495 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
6496 following pieces of information:
6497
6498 @itemize
6499 @item
6500 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
6501 directory in the store, but may produce more.
6502
6503 @item
6504 @cindex build-time dependencies
6505 @cindex dependencies, build-time
6506 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
6507 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
6508 etc.)
6509
6510 @item
6511 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
6512
6513 @item
6514 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
6515 to be passed.
6516
6517 @item
6518 A list of environment variables to be defined.
6519
6520 @end itemize
6521
6522 @cindex derivation path
6523 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
6524 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
6525 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
6526 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
6527 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
6528 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
6529 Store}).
6530
6531 @cindex fixed-output derivations
6532 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
6533 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
6534 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
6535 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
6536 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
6537 method and tools being used.
6538
6539 @cindex references
6540 @cindex run-time dependencies
6541 @cindex dependencies, run-time
6542 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
6543 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
6544 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
6545 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
6546 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
6547 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
6548
6549 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
6550 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
6551 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
6552 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
6553
6554 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
6555 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6556 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
6557 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
6558 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6559 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
6560 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
6561 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
6562 @code{<derivation>} object.
6563
6564 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
6565 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
6566 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
6567 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
6568 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
6569 containing this output.
6570
6571 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
6572 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
6573 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
6574 a simple text format.
6575
6576 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
6577 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
6578 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
6579 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
6580
6581 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
6582 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
6583 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
6584 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
6585 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
6586 derivations that download files.
6587
6588 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
6589 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
6590 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
6591 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
6592
6593 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
6594 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
6595 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
6596 host CPU instruction set.
6597
6598 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
6599 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
6600 @end deffn
6601
6602 @noindent
6603 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
6604 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
6605 to a Bash executable in the store:
6606
6607 @lisp
6608 (use-modules (guix utils)
6609 (guix store)
6610 (guix derivations))
6611
6612 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
6613 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
6614 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
6615 (derivation store "foo"
6616 bash `("-e" ,builder)
6617 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
6618 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
6619 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
6620 @end lisp
6621
6622 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
6623 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
6624 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
6625 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6626 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
6627
6628 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
6629 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
6630 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
6631 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
6632
6633 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
6634 @var{name} @var{exp} @
6635 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
6636 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6637 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
6638 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
6639 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6640 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
6641 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
6642 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
6643 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
6644 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
6645 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
6646 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
6647 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
6648 gnu-build-system))}.
6649
6650 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
6651 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
6652 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
6653 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
6654 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
6655 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
6656 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
6657
6658 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
6659 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
6660 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
6661
6662 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
6663 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
6664 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
6665 @var{substitutable?}.
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @noindent
6669 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
6670 containing one file:
6671
6672 @lisp
6673 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
6674 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
6675 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
6676 (lambda (p)
6677 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
6678 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
6679
6680 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
6681 @end lisp
6682
6683
6684 @node The Store Monad
6685 @section The Store Monad
6686
6687 @cindex monad
6688
6689 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
6690 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
6691 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
6692 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
6693
6694 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
6695 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
6696 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
6697 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
6698 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
6699
6700 @cindex monadic values
6701 @cindex monadic functions
6702 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
6703 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
6704 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
6705 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
6706 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
6707 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
6708 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
6709 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
6710 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
6711
6712 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
6713
6714 @example
6715 (define (sh-symlink store)
6716 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
6717 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
6718 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
6719 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
6720 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
6721 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
6722 @end example
6723
6724 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
6725 as a monadic function:
6726
6727 @example
6728 (define (sh-symlink)
6729 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
6730 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
6731 (gexp->derivation "sh"
6732 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
6733 #$output))))
6734 @end example
6735
6736 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
6737 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
6738 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
6739 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
6740 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
6741
6742 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
6743 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
6744 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
6745
6746 @example
6747 (define (sh-symlink)
6748 (gexp->derivation "sh"
6749 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
6750 #$output)))
6751 @end example
6752
6753 @c See
6754 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
6755 @c for the funny quote.
6756 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
6757 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
6758 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
6759 @code{run-with-store}:
6760
6761 @example
6762 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
6763 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
6764 @end example
6765
6766 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
6767 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
6768 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
6769 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
6770
6771 @example
6772 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
6773 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
6774 @end example
6775
6776 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
6777 automatically run through the store:
6778
6779 @example
6780 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
6781 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
6782 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
6783 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
6784 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
6785 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
6786 scheme@@(guile-user)>
6787 @end example
6788
6789 @noindent
6790 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
6791 @code{store-monad} REPL.
6792
6793 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
6794 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
6795
6796 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
6797 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
6798 in @var{monad}.
6799 @end deffn
6800
6801 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
6802 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
6803 @end deffn
6804
6805 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
6806 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
6807 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
6808 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
6809 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
6810 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
6811 in this example:
6812
6813 @example
6814 (run-with-state
6815 (with-monad %state-monad
6816 (>>= (return 1)
6817 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
6818 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
6819 'some-state)
6820
6821 @result{} 4
6822 @result{} some-state
6823 @end example
6824 @end deffn
6825
6826 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
6827 @var{body} ...
6828 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
6829 @var{body} ...
6830 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
6831 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
6832 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
6833 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
6834 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
6835 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
6836 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
6837 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
6838 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
6839 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
6840
6841 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
6842 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6843 @end deffn
6844
6845 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
6846 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
6847 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
6848 sequence must be a monadic expression.
6849
6850 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
6851 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
6852 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
6853 @end deffn
6854
6855 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
6856 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
6857 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
6858 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
6859 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
6860 @end deffn
6861
6862 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
6863 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
6864 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
6865 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
6866 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
6867 @end deffn
6868
6869 @cindex state monad
6870 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
6871 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
6872 monadic procedure calls.
6873
6874 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
6875 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
6876 the state that is threaded.
6877
6878 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
6879 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
6880 increments the current state value:
6881
6882 @example
6883 (define (square x)
6884 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
6885 (mbegin %state-monad
6886 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
6887 (return (* x x)))))
6888
6889 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
6890 @result{} (0 1 4)
6891 @result{} 3
6892 @end example
6893
6894 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
6895 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
6896 @end defvr
6897
6898 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
6899 Return the current state as a monadic value.
6900 @end deffn
6901
6902 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
6903 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
6904 monadic value.
6905 @end deffn
6906
6907 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
6908 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
6909 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
6913 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
6914 The state is assumed to be a list.
6915 @end deffn
6916
6917 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
6918 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
6919 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
6920 @end deffn
6921
6922 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
6923 store)} module, is as follows.
6924
6925 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
6926 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
6927
6928 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
6929 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
6930 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
6931 @end defvr
6932
6933 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
6934 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
6935 open store connection.
6936 @end deffn
6937
6938 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6939 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
6940 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
6941 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
6942 @end deffn
6943
6944 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
6945 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
6946 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
6947 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
6951 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
6952 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
6953 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
6954 @var{name} is omitted.
6955
6956 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
6957 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
6958 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
6959
6960 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
6961 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
6962 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
6963 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
6964
6965 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
6966
6967 @example
6968 (run-with-store (open-connection)
6969 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
6970 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
6971 (return (list a b))))
6972
6973 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
6974 @end example
6975
6976 @end deffn
6977
6978 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
6979 monadic procedures:
6980
6981 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
6982 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
6983 [#:output "out"]
6984 Return as a monadic
6985 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
6986 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
6987 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
6988 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
6989 @end deffn
6990
6991 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
6992 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
6993 @var{target} [@var{system}]
6994 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
6995 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
6996 @end deffn
6997
6998
6999 @node G-Expressions
7000 @section G-Expressions
7001
7002 @cindex G-expression
7003 @cindex build code quoting
7004 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
7005 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
7006 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
7007 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
7008 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
7009
7010 @cindex strata of code
7011 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
7012 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
7013 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
7014 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
7015 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
7016 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
7017 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
7018 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
7019 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
7020 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
7021 @command{make}, etc.
7022
7023 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
7024 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
7025 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
7026 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
7027 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
7028 expressions.
7029
7030 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
7031 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
7032 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
7033 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
7034 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
7035 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
7036 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
7037 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
7038
7039 @itemize
7040 @item
7041 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
7042 processes.
7043
7044 @item
7045 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
7046 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
7047 introduced.
7048
7049 @item
7050 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
7051 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
7052 processes that use them.
7053 @end itemize
7054
7055 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7056 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
7057 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
7058 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
7059 such that these objects can also be inserted
7060 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
7061 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
7062 add files to the store and to refer to them in
7063 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
7064 below.)
7065
7066 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
7067
7068 @example
7069 (define build-exp
7070 #~(begin
7071 (mkdir #$output)
7072 (chdir #$output)
7073 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
7074 "list-files")))
7075 @end example
7076
7077 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
7078 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
7079 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
7080
7081 @example
7082 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
7083 @end example
7084
7085 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
7086 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
7087 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
7088 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
7089 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
7090 output of the derivation.
7091
7092 @cindex cross compilation
7093 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
7094 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
7095 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
7096 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
7097 native package build:
7098
7099 @example
7100 (gexp->derivation "vi"
7101 #~(begin
7102 (mkdir #$output)
7103 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
7104 "-s"
7105 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
7106 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
7107 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
7108 @end example
7109
7110 @noindent
7111 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
7112 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
7113 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
7114
7115 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
7116 @findex with-imported-modules
7117 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
7118 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
7119 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
7120 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
7121
7122 @example
7123 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
7124 #~(begin
7125 (use-modules (guix build utils))
7126 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
7127 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
7128 #~(begin
7129 #$build
7130 (display "success!\n")
7131 #t)))
7132 @end example
7133
7134 @noindent
7135 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
7136 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
7137 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
7138
7139 @cindex module closure
7140 @findex source-module-closure
7141 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
7142 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
7143 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
7144 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
7145 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
7146 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
7147
7148 @example
7149 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
7150
7151 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
7152 '((guix build utils)
7153 (gnu build vm)))
7154 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
7155 #~(begin
7156 (use-modules (guix build utils)
7157 (gnu build vm))
7158 @dots{})))
7159 @end example
7160
7161 @cindex extensions, for gexps
7162 @findex with-extensions
7163 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
7164 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
7165 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
7166 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
7167
7168 @example
7169 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
7170
7171 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
7172 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
7173 #~(begin
7174 (use-modules (json))
7175 @dots{})))
7176 @end example
7177
7178 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
7179
7180 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
7181 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
7182 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
7183 or more of the following forms:
7184
7185 @table @code
7186 @item #$@var{obj}
7187 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
7188 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
7189 supported types, for example a package or a
7190 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
7191 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
7192
7193 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
7194 objects are substituted similarly.
7195
7196 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
7197 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
7198
7199 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
7200
7201 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
7202 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
7203 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
7204 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
7205 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
7206
7207 @item #+@var{obj}
7208 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
7209 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
7210 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
7211 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
7212 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
7213
7214 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
7215 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
7216 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
7217 output when @var{output} is omitted.
7218
7219 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7220
7221 @item #$@@@var{lst}
7222 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
7223 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
7224 containing list.
7225
7226 @item #+@@@var{lst}
7227 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
7228 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
7229 @var{lst}.
7230
7231 @end table
7232
7233 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
7234 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
7235 @end deffn
7236
7237 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
7238 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
7239 in their execution environment.
7240
7241 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
7242 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
7243 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
7244
7245 @example
7246 `((guix build utils)
7247 (guix gcrypt)
7248 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
7249 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
7250 @end example
7251
7252 @noindent
7253 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
7254 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
7255
7256 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
7257 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
7258 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
7259 @end deffn
7260
7261 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
7262 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
7263 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
7264 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
7265 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
7266
7267 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
7268 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
7269 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
7270 @var{body}@dots{}.
7271 @end deffn
7272
7273 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
7274 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
7275 @end deffn
7276
7277 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
7278 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
7279 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
7280 information about monads.)
7281
7282 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
7283 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
7284 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7285 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7286 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
7287 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
7288 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7289 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7290 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
7291 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
7292 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
7293 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
7294 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7295 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
7296 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
7297 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
7298 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
7299 to by @var{exp}.
7300
7301 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
7302 Its meaning is to
7303 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
7304 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
7305 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
7306 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
7307 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
7308
7309 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
7310 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
7311
7312 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
7313 applicable.
7314
7315 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
7316 following forms:
7317
7318 @example
7319 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
7320 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
7321 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
7322 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
7323 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
7324 @end example
7325
7326 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
7327 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
7328 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
7329 text format.
7330
7331 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
7332 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
7333 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
7334 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
7335 referenced by the outputs.
7336
7337 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
7338 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
7339
7340 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
7341 @end deffn
7342
7343 @cindex file-like objects
7344 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
7345 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
7346 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
7347 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
7348
7349 @example
7350 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
7351 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
7352 @end example
7353
7354 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
7355 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
7356 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
7357 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
7358 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
7359 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
7360 content is directly passed as a string.
7361
7362 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7363 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
7364 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
7365 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
7366 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
7367 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
7368
7369 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
7370 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
7371 permission bits are kept.
7372
7373 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7374 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7375 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7376 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7377
7378 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
7379 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
7380 @end deffn
7381
7382 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
7383 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
7384 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
7385
7386 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
7390 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
7391 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
7392 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
7393 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7394
7395 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
7396 @end deffn
7397
7398 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
7399 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path]
7400 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
7401 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
7402 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
7403
7404 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
7405 command:
7406
7407 @example
7408 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
7409
7410 (gexp->script "list-files"
7411 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
7412 "ls"))
7413 @end example
7414
7415 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
7416 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
7417 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
7418
7419 @example
7420 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
7421 !#
7422 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
7423 @end example
7424 @end deffn
7425
7426 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7427 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
7428 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
7429 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
7430 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
7431
7432 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
7433 @end deffn
7434
7435 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7436 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7437 [#:splice? #f] @
7438 [#:guile (default-guile)]
7439 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
7440 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
7441 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
7442
7443 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
7444 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
7445 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
7446 @var{module-path}.
7447
7448 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
7449 or a subset thereof.
7450 @end deffn
7451
7452 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} [#:splice? #f]
7453 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
7454 @var{exp}.
7455
7456 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
7457 @end deffn
7458
7459 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7460 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
7461 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
7462 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
7463 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
7464 references to all these.
7465
7466 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
7467 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
7468 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
7469 like this:
7470
7471 @example
7472 (define (profile.sh)
7473 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
7474 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
7475 (text-file* "profile.sh"
7476 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
7477 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
7478 @end example
7479
7480 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
7481 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
7482 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7486 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
7487 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
7488 as in:
7489
7490 @example
7491 (mixed-text-file "profile"
7492 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
7493 @end example
7494
7495 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
7496 @end deffn
7497
7498 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
7499 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
7500 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
7501 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
7502 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
7503
7504 @example
7505 (file-union "etc"
7506 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
7507 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
7508 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
7509 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
7510 @end example
7511
7512 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
7513 @end deffn
7514
7515 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
7516 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
7517 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
7518
7519 @example
7520 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
7521 @end example
7522
7523 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
7524 @end deffn
7525
7526 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
7527 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
7528 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
7529 @var{suffix} is a string.
7530
7531 As an example, consider this gexp:
7532
7533 @example
7534 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7535 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
7536 "/bin/uname")))
7537 @end example
7538
7539 The same effect could be achieved with:
7540
7541 @example
7542 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7543 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
7544 "/bin/uname")))
7545 @end example
7546
7547 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
7548 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
7549 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
7550 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
7551 @end deffn
7552
7553
7554 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
7555 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
7556 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
7557 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
7558
7559 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7560 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
7561 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
7562 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
7563 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
7564
7565 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
7566 [#:target #f]
7567 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
7568 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
7569 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
7570 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
7571 @end deffn
7572
7573 @node Invoking guix repl
7574 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
7575
7576 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop
7577 The @command{guix repl} command spawns a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop}
7578 (REPL) for interactive programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
7579 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
7580 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
7581 dependencies are available in the search path. You can use it this way:
7582
7583 @example
7584 $ guix repl
7585 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
7586 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
7587 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
7588 @end example
7589
7590 @cindex inferiors
7591 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
7592 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
7593 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
7594 of Guix.
7595
7596 The available options are as follows:
7597
7598 @table @code
7599 @item --type=@var{type}
7600 @itemx -t @var{type}
7601 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
7602
7603 @table @code
7604 @item guile
7605 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
7606 @item machine
7607 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
7608 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
7609 @end table
7610
7611 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
7612 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
7613 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
7614 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
7615
7616 @table @code
7617 @item --listen=tcp:37146
7618 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
7619
7620 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
7621 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
7622 @end table
7623 @end table
7624
7625 @c *********************************************************************
7626 @node Utilities
7627 @chapter Utilities
7628
7629 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
7630 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
7631 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
7632 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
7633
7634 @menu
7635 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
7636 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
7637 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
7638 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
7639 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
7640 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
7641 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
7642 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
7643 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
7644 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
7645 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
7646 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
7647 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
7648 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
7649 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
7650 @end menu
7651
7652 @node Invoking guix build
7653 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
7654
7655 @cindex package building
7656 @cindex @command{guix build}
7657 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
7658 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
7659 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
7660 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
7661 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
7662
7663 The general syntax is:
7664
7665 @example
7666 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
7667 @end example
7668
7669 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
7670 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
7671 resulting directories:
7672
7673 @example
7674 guix build emacs guile
7675 @end example
7676
7677 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
7678
7679 @example
7680 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
7681 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
7682 @end example
7683
7684 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
7685 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
7686 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
7687 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
7688 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
7689 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7690
7691 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
7692 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
7693 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
7694 needed.
7695
7696 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
7697 described in the subsections below.
7698
7699 @menu
7700 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
7701 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
7702 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
7703 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
7704 @end menu
7705
7706 @node Common Build Options
7707 @subsection Common Build Options
7708
7709 A number of options that control the build process are common to
7710 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
7711 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
7712 following:
7713
7714 @table @code
7715
7716 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
7717 @itemx -L @var{directory}
7718 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
7719 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7720
7721 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
7722 the command-line tools.
7723
7724 @item --keep-failed
7725 @itemx -K
7726 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
7727 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
7728 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
7729 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
7730 build issues.
7731
7732 This option has no effect when connecting to a remote daemon with a
7733 @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The Store, the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}
7734 variable}).
7735
7736 @item --keep-going
7737 @itemx -k
7738 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
7739 all the builds have either completed or failed.
7740
7741 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
7742 derivations has failed.
7743
7744 @item --dry-run
7745 @itemx -n
7746 Do not build the derivations.
7747
7748 @anchor{fallback-option}
7749 @item --fallback
7750 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
7751 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
7752
7753 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
7754 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
7755 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
7756 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
7757 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
7758
7759 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
7760 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
7761 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7762
7763 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
7764 disabled.
7765
7766 @item --no-substitutes
7767 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
7768 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
7769 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7770
7771 @item --no-grafts
7772 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
7773 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
7774 information on grafts.
7775
7776 @item --rounds=@var{n}
7777 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
7778 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
7779
7780 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
7781 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
7782 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
7783 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
7784
7785 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
7786 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
7787 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
7788 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
7789 the two results.
7790
7791 @item --no-build-hook
7792 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
7793 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
7794 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
7795
7796 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
7797 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
7798 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
7799
7800 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
7801 guix-daemon, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
7802
7803 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
7804 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
7805 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
7806
7807 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
7808 guix-daemon, @code{--timeout}}).
7809
7810 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
7811 @c most programs honor it.
7812 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
7813 @cindex build logs, verbosity
7814 @item -v @var{level}
7815 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
7816 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
7817 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
7818 output on standard error.
7819
7820 @item --cores=@var{n}
7821 @itemx -c @var{n}
7822 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
7823 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
7824
7825 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
7826 @itemx -M @var{n}
7827 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
7828 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
7829 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
7830
7831 @item --debug=@var{level}
7832 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
7833 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
7834 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
7835
7836 @end table
7837
7838 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
7839 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
7840 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
7841 derivations)} module.
7842
7843 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
7844 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
7845 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
7846
7847 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
7848 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
7849 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
7850 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
7851 below:
7852
7853 @example
7854 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
7855 @end example
7856
7857 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
7858 the parsed command-line options.
7859 @end defvr
7860
7861
7862 @node Package Transformation Options
7863 @subsection Package Transformation Options
7864
7865 @cindex package variants
7866 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
7867 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
7868 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
7869 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
7870 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
7871 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
7872 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7873
7874 @table @code
7875
7876 @item --with-source=@var{source}
7877 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
7878 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
7879 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
7880 its version number.
7881 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
7882 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
7883
7884 When @var{package} is omitted,
7885 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
7886 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
7887 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
7888 package is @code{guile}.
7889
7890 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
7891 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
7892
7893 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
7894 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
7895 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
7896 the @code{ed} package:
7897
7898 @example
7899 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
7900 @end example
7901
7902 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
7903 candidates:
7904
7905 @example
7906 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
7907 @end example
7908
7909 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
7910
7911 @example
7912 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
7913 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
7914 @end example
7915
7916 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
7917 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
7918 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
7919 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
7920 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
7921
7922 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
7923 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
7924 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
7925
7926 @example
7927 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
7928 @end example
7929
7930 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
7931 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
7932 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
7933
7934 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
7935 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
7936
7937 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
7938 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
7939 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
7940 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
7941 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
7942 information on grafts.
7943
7944 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
7945 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
7946 they currently refer to:
7947
7948 @example
7949 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
7950 @end example
7951
7952 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
7953 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
7954 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
7955 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
7956 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
7957 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
7958 care!
7959
7960 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
7961 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
7962 @cindex latest commit, building
7963 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
7964 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
7965 recursively.
7966
7967 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
7968 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
7969
7970 @example
7971 guix build python-numpy \
7972 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
7973 @end example
7974
7975 This option can also be combined with @code{--with-branch} or
7976 @code{--with-commit} (see below).
7977
7978 @cindex continuous integration
7979 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
7980 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
7981 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
7982 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
7983 integration (CI).
7984
7985 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
7986 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
7987 in a while to save disk space.
7988
7989 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
7990 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
7991 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
7992 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
7993 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
7994 @code{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
7995
7996 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
7997 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
7998 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
7999 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
8000
8001 @example
8002 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
8003 @end example
8004
8005 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
8006 This is similar to @code{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
8007 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
8008 Git commit SHA1 identifier.
8009 @end table
8010
8011 @node Additional Build Options
8012 @subsection Additional Build Options
8013
8014 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
8015 build}.
8016
8017 @table @code
8018
8019 @item --quiet
8020 @itemx -q
8021 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
8022 @code{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
8023 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
8024
8025 @item --file=@var{file}
8026 @itemx -f @var{file}
8027 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
8028 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
8029
8030 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
8031 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
8032
8033 @example
8034 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
8035 @end example
8036
8037 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8038 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8039 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
8040
8041 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
8042 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
8043 version 1.8 of Guile.
8044
8045 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
8046 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
8047 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8048
8049 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
8050 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
8051 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
8052
8053 @item --source
8054 @itemx -S
8055 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
8056 themselves.
8057
8058 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
8059 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
8060 source tarball.
8061
8062 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
8063 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
8064 Packages}).
8065
8066 @item --sources
8067 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
8068 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
8069 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
8070 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
8071 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
8072 optional argument values:
8073
8074 @table @code
8075 @item package
8076 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
8077 as the @code{--source} option.
8078
8079 @item all
8080 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
8081 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
8082
8083 @example
8084 $ guix build --sources tzdata
8085 The following derivations will be built:
8086 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
8087 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8088 @end example
8089
8090 @item transitive
8091 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
8092 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
8093 prefetch package source for later offline building.
8094
8095 @example
8096 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
8097 The following derivations will be built:
8098 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8099 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
8100 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
8101 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
8102 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
8103 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
8104 @dots{}
8105 @end example
8106
8107 @end table
8108
8109 @item --system=@var{system}
8110 @itemx -s @var{system}
8111 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
8112 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
8113 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
8114 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
8115
8116 @quotation Note
8117 The @code{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
8118 be confused with cross-compilation. See @code{--target} below for
8119 information on cross-compilation.
8120 @end quotation
8121
8122 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
8123 different personalities. For instance, passing
8124 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
8125 @code{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows you
8126 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
8127
8128 @quotation Note
8129 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
8130 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
8131 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
8132 @end quotation
8133
8134 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
8135 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
8136 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
8137 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
8138
8139 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
8140 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
8141 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
8142
8143 @item --target=@var{triplet}
8144 @cindex cross-compilation
8145 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
8146 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
8147 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
8148
8149 @anchor{build-check}
8150 @item --check
8151 @cindex determinism, checking
8152 @cindex reproducibility, checking
8153 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
8154 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
8155 identical.
8156
8157 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
8158 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
8159 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
8160 background information and tools.
8161
8162 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
8163 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
8164 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
8165
8166 @item --repair
8167 @cindex repairing store items
8168 @cindex corruption, recovering from
8169 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
8170 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
8171
8172 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
8173
8174 @item --derivations
8175 @itemx -d
8176 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
8177 packages.
8178
8179 @item --root=@var{file}
8180 @itemx -r @var{file}
8181 @cindex GC roots, adding
8182 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
8183 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
8184 collector root.
8185
8186 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
8187 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
8188 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
8189 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
8190 more on GC roots.
8191
8192 @item --log-file
8193 @cindex build logs, access
8194 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
8195 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
8196 missing.
8197
8198 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
8199 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
8200
8201 @example
8202 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
8203 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
8204 guix build --log-file guile
8205 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
8206 @end example
8207
8208 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
8209 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
8210 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
8211
8212 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
8213 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
8214
8215 @example
8216 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
8217 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
8218 @end example
8219
8220 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
8221 @end table
8222
8223 @node Debugging Build Failures
8224 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
8225
8226 @cindex build failures, debugging
8227 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
8228 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
8229 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
8230 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
8231 build daemon uses.
8232
8233 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
8234 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
8235 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
8236 @code{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--keep-failed}}).
8237
8238 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
8239 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
8240 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
8241 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
8242 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
8243
8244 @example
8245 $ guix build foo -K
8246 @dots{} @i{build fails}
8247 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8248 $ source ./environment-variables
8249 $ cd foo-1.2
8250 @end example
8251
8252 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
8253 troubleshoot your build process.
8254
8255 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
8256 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
8257 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
8258 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
8259 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
8260
8261 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
8262 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
8263
8264 @example
8265 $ guix build -K foo
8266 @dots{}
8267 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8268 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
8269 [env]# source ./environment-variables
8270 [env]# cd foo-1.2
8271 @end example
8272
8273 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
8274 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
8275 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
8276 the container, which would may find handy while debugging. The
8277 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
8278 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
8279 info on grafts).
8280
8281 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
8282 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
8283
8284 @example
8285 [env]# rm /bin/sh
8286 @end example
8287
8288 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
8289 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
8290
8291 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
8292 can run:
8293
8294 @example
8295 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
8296 @end example
8297
8298 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
8299 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
8300 similar to the one the daemon uses.
8301
8302
8303 @node Invoking guix edit
8304 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
8305
8306 @cindex @command{guix edit}
8307 @cindex package definition, editing
8308 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
8309 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
8310 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
8311 For instance:
8312
8313 @example
8314 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
8315 @end example
8316
8317 @noindent
8318 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
8319 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
8320 and that of Vim.
8321
8322 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
8323 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
8324 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
8325 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
8326 for packages currently in the store.
8327
8328
8329 @node Invoking guix download
8330 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
8331
8332 @cindex @command{guix download}
8333 @cindex downloading package sources
8334 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
8335 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
8336 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
8337 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
8338 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
8339 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
8340
8341 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
8342 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
8343 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
8344 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
8345 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
8346 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
8347
8348 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
8349 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
8350 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
8351 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
8352 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
8353 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
8354 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
8355
8356 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
8357 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
8358 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
8359 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
8360
8361 The following options are available:
8362
8363 @table @code
8364 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8365 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8366 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
8367 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
8368
8369 @item --no-check-certificate
8370 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
8371
8372 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
8373 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
8374 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
8375
8376 @item --output=@var{file}
8377 @itemx -o @var{file}
8378 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
8379 store.
8380 @end table
8381
8382 @node Invoking guix hash
8383 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
8384
8385 @cindex @command{guix hash}
8386 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
8387 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
8388 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
8389 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8390
8391 The general syntax is:
8392
8393 @example
8394 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
8395 @end example
8396
8397 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
8398 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
8399 following options:
8400
8401 @table @code
8402
8403 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8404 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8405 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
8406
8407 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
8408 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
8409
8410 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
8411 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
8412 in the definitions of packages.
8413
8414 @item --recursive
8415 @itemx -r
8416 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
8417
8418 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
8419 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
8420 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
8421 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
8422 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
8423 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
8424 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
8425 @c it exists.
8426
8427 @item --exclude-vcs
8428 @itemx -x
8429 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
8430 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
8431
8432 @vindex git-fetch
8433 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
8434 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
8435 Reference}):
8436
8437 @example
8438 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
8439 $ cd foo
8440 $ guix hash -rx .
8441 @end example
8442 @end table
8443
8444 @node Invoking guix import
8445 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
8446
8447 @cindex importing packages
8448 @cindex package import
8449 @cindex package conversion
8450 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
8451 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
8452 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
8453 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
8454 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
8455 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
8456 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8457
8458 The general syntax is:
8459
8460 @example
8461 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
8462 @end example
8463
8464 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
8465 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
8466 options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
8467 ``importers'' are:
8468
8469 @table @code
8470 @item gnu
8471 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
8472 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
8473 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
8474
8475 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
8476 license needs to be figured out manually.
8477
8478 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
8479 GNU@tie{}Hello:
8480
8481 @example
8482 guix import gnu hello
8483 @end example
8484
8485 Specific command-line options are:
8486
8487 @table @code
8488 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
8489 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
8490 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
8491 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
8492 @end table
8493
8494 @item pypi
8495 @cindex pypi
8496 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
8497 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
8498 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
8499 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
8500 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
8501 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
8502
8503 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
8504 package:
8505
8506 @example
8507 guix import pypi itsdangerous
8508 @end example
8509
8510 @table @code
8511 @item --recursive
8512 @itemx -r
8513 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8514 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8515 in Guix.
8516 @end table
8517
8518 @item gem
8519 @cindex gem
8520 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
8521 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
8522 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
8523 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
8524 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
8525 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
8526 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
8527 as an exercise to the packager.
8528
8529 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
8530
8531 @example
8532 guix import gem rails
8533 @end example
8534
8535 @table @code
8536 @item --recursive
8537 @itemx -r
8538 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8539 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8540 in Guix.
8541 @end table
8542
8543 @item cpan
8544 @cindex CPAN
8545 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
8546 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
8547 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
8548 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
8549 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
8550 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
8551 list of dependencies.
8552
8553 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
8554 Perl module:
8555
8556 @example
8557 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
8558 @end example
8559
8560 @item cran
8561 @cindex CRAN
8562 @cindex Bioconductor
8563 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
8564 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
8565 statistical and graphical environment}.
8566
8567 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
8568
8569 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
8570 R package:
8571
8572 @example
8573 guix import cran Cairo
8574 @end example
8575
8576 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
8577 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
8578 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
8579
8580 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
8581 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
8582 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
8583 genomic data in bioinformatics.
8584
8585 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
8586 published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
8587
8588 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
8589 R package:
8590
8591 @example
8592 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
8593 @end example
8594
8595 @item texlive
8596 @cindex TeX Live
8597 @cindex CTAN
8598 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
8599 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
8600 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
8601
8602 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
8603 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
8604 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
8605 versioned archives.
8606
8607 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
8608 TeX package:
8609
8610 @example
8611 guix import texlive fontspec
8612 @end example
8613
8614 When @code{--archive=DIRECTORY} is added, the source code is downloaded
8615 not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the @file{texmf-dist/source}
8616 tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from the specified sibling
8617 directory under the same root.
8618
8619 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
8620 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
8621 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
8622
8623 @example
8624 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
8625 @end example
8626
8627 @item json
8628 @cindex JSON, import
8629 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
8630 example package definition in JSON format:
8631
8632 @example
8633 @{
8634 "name": "hello",
8635 "version": "2.10",
8636 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
8637 "build-system": "gnu",
8638 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
8639 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
8640 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
8641 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
8642 "native-inputs": ["gcc@@6"]
8643 @}
8644 @end example
8645
8646 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
8647 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
8648 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
8649 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
8650
8651 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
8652 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
8653
8654 @example
8655 @{
8656 @dots{}
8657 "source": @{
8658 "method": "url-fetch",
8659 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
8660 "sha256": @{
8661 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
8662 @}
8663 @}
8664 @dots{}
8665 @}
8666 @end example
8667
8668 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
8669 and outputs a package expression:
8670
8671 @example
8672 guix import json hello.json
8673 @end example
8674
8675 @item nix
8676 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
8677 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
8678 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
8679 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
8680 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
8681 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
8682 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
8683 package definition.
8684
8685 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
8686 by their canonical upstream variant.
8687
8688 Usually, you will first need to do:
8689
8690 @example
8691 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
8692 @end example
8693
8694 @noindent
8695 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
8696
8697 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
8698 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
8699 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
8700
8701 @example
8702 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
8703 @end example
8704
8705 @item hackage
8706 @cindex hackage
8707 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
8708 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
8709 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
8710 dependencies.
8711
8712 Specific command-line options are:
8713
8714 @table @code
8715 @item --stdin
8716 @itemx -s
8717 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
8718 @item --no-test-dependencies
8719 @itemx -t
8720 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
8721 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
8722 @itemx -e @var{alist}
8723 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
8724 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
8725 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
8726 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
8727 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
8728 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
8729 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
8730 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
8731 @item --recursive
8732 @itemx -r
8733 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8734 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8735 in Guix.
8736 @end table
8737
8738 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
8739 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
8740 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
8741
8742 @example
8743 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
8744 @end example
8745
8746 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
8747 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
8748
8749 @example
8750 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
8751 @end example
8752
8753 @item stackage
8754 @cindex stackage
8755 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
8756 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
8757 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
8758 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
8759 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
8760 GHC compiler used by Guix.
8761
8762 Specific command-line options are:
8763
8764 @table @code
8765 @item --no-test-dependencies
8766 @itemx -t
8767 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
8768 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
8769 @itemx -l @var{version}
8770 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
8771 release is used.
8772 @item --recursive
8773 @itemx -r
8774 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8775 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8776 in Guix.
8777 @end table
8778
8779 The command below imports metadata for the @code{HTTP} Haskell package
8780 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
8781
8782 @example
8783 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
8784 @end example
8785
8786 @item elpa
8787 @cindex elpa
8788 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
8789 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8790
8791 Specific command-line options are:
8792
8793 @table @code
8794 @item --archive=@var{repo}
8795 @itemx -a @var{repo}
8796 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
8797 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
8798 are:
8799 @itemize -
8800 @item
8801 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
8802 identifier. This is the default.
8803
8804 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
8805 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
8806 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
8807 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
8808 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8809
8810 @item
8811 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
8812 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
8813
8814 @item
8815 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
8816 identifier.
8817 @end itemize
8818
8819 @item --recursive
8820 @itemx -r
8821 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8822 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8823 in Guix.
8824 @end table
8825
8826 @item crate
8827 @cindex crate
8828 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
8829 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}.
8830
8831 @item opam
8832 @cindex OPAM
8833 @cindex OCaml
8834 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
8835 repository used by the OCaml community.
8836 @end table
8837
8838 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
8839 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
8840 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
8841
8842 @node Invoking guix refresh
8843 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
8844
8845 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
8846 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
8847 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
8848 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
8849 upstream version, like this:
8850
8851 @example
8852 $ guix refresh
8853 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
8854 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
8855 @end example
8856
8857 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
8858 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
8859
8860 @example
8861 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
8862 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
8863 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
8864 @end example
8865
8866 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
8867 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
8868 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
8869 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
8870 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
8871 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
8872 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
8873
8874 @table @code
8875
8876 @item --recursive
8877 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
8878
8879 @example
8880 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
8881 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
8882 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
8883 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
8884 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
8885 @dots{}
8886 @end example
8887
8888 @end table
8889
8890 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
8891 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
8892 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
8893 to that effect:
8894
8895 @example
8896 (define-public network-manager
8897 (package
8898 (name "network-manager")
8899 ;; @dots{}
8900 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
8901 @end example
8902
8903 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
8904 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
8905 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
8906 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
8907 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
8908 using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
8909 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
8910 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
8911 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
8912 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
8913
8914 The following options are supported:
8915
8916 @table @code
8917
8918 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8919 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8920 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
8921
8922 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
8923
8924 @example
8925 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
8926 @end example
8927
8928 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
8929 the packages.)
8930
8931 @item --update
8932 @itemx -u
8933 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
8934 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
8935 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
8936
8937 @example
8938 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
8939 @end example
8940
8941 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
8942
8943 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
8944 @itemx -s @var{subset}
8945 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
8946 @code{non-core}.
8947
8948 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
8949 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
8950 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
8951 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
8952 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
8953 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
8954
8955 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
8956 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
8957 inconvenient.
8958
8959 @item --manifest=@var{file}
8960 @itemx -m @var{file}
8961 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
8962 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
8963
8964 @item --type=@var{updater}
8965 @itemx -t @var{updater}
8966 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
8967 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
8968
8969 @table @code
8970 @item gnu
8971 the updater for GNU packages;
8972 @item gnome
8973 the updater for GNOME packages;
8974 @item kde
8975 the updater for KDE packages;
8976 @item xorg
8977 the updater for X.org packages;
8978 @item kernel.org
8979 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
8980 @item elpa
8981 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
8982 @item cran
8983 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
8984 @item bioconductor
8985 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
8986 @item cpan
8987 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
8988 @item pypi
8989 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
8990 @item gem
8991 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
8992 @item github
8993 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
8994 @item hackage
8995 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
8996 @item stackage
8997 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
8998 @item crate
8999 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
9000 @item launchpad
9001 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
9002 @end table
9003
9004 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
9005 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
9006
9007 @example
9008 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
9009 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
9010 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
9011 @end example
9012
9013 @end table
9014
9015 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
9016 names, as in this example:
9017
9018 @example
9019 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
9020 @end example
9021
9022 @noindent
9023 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
9024 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
9025 effect in this case.
9026
9027 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
9028 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
9029 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
9030 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
9031
9032 @table @code
9033
9034 @item --list-updaters
9035 @itemx -L
9036 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
9037
9038 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
9039 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
9040
9041 @item --list-dependent
9042 @itemx -l
9043 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
9044 result of upgrading one or more packages.
9045
9046 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
9047 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
9048 dependents of a package.
9049
9050 @end table
9051
9052 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
9053 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
9054 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
9055
9056 @example
9057 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
9058 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
9059 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
9060 @end example
9061
9062 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
9063 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
9064
9065 @table @code
9066
9067 @item --list-transitive
9068 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
9069
9070 @example
9071 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
9072 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
9073 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
9074 @end example
9075
9076 @end table
9077
9078 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
9079 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
9080
9081 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
9082
9083 @table @code
9084
9085 @item --gpg=@var{command}
9086 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
9087 for in @code{$PATH}.
9088
9089 @item --keyring=@var{file}
9090 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
9091 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
9092 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
9093 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
9094 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
9095
9096 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
9097 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
9098 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
9099 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
9100 @option{--key-download} below.)
9101
9102 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
9103 commands like this one:
9104
9105 @example
9106 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
9107 @end example
9108
9109 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
9110
9111 @example
9112 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
9113 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
9114 @end example
9115
9116 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
9117 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
9118
9119 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9120 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
9121 of:
9122
9123 @table @code
9124 @item always
9125 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
9126 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
9127
9128 @item never
9129 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
9130
9131 @item interactive
9132 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
9133 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
9134 @end table
9135
9136 @item --key-server=@var{host}
9137 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
9138
9139 @end table
9140
9141 The @code{github} updater uses the
9142 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
9143 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
9144 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
9145 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
9146 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
9147 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
9148 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
9149 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
9150 otherwise.
9151
9152
9153 @node Invoking guix lint
9154 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
9155
9156 @cindex @command{guix lint}
9157 @cindex package, checking for errors
9158 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
9159 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
9160 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
9161 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
9162 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
9163
9164 @table @code
9165 @item synopsis
9166 @itemx description
9167 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
9168 descriptions and synopses.
9169
9170 @item inputs-should-be-native
9171 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
9172
9173 @item source
9174 @itemx home-page
9175 @itemx mirror-url
9176 @itemx github-url
9177 @itemx source-file-name
9178 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
9179 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
9180 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
9181 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
9182 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
9183 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
9184
9185 @item source-unstable-tarball
9186 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
9187 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
9188 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
9189
9190 @item cve
9191 @cindex security vulnerabilities
9192 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
9193 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
9194 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
9195 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
9196 NIST}.
9197
9198 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
9199
9200 @itemize
9201 @item
9202 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9203 @item
9204 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9205 @end itemize
9206
9207 @noindent
9208 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
9209 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
9210
9211 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
9212 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
9213 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
9214 that Guix uses, as in this example:
9215
9216 @example
9217 (package
9218 (name "grub")
9219 ;; @dots{}
9220 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
9221 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
9222 (cpe-version . "2.3")))
9223 @end example
9224
9225 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
9226 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
9227 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
9228 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
9229 declare them as in this example:
9230
9231 @example
9232 (package
9233 (name "t1lib")
9234 ;; @dots{}
9235 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
9236 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
9237 "CVE-2011-1553"
9238 "CVE-2011-1554"
9239 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
9240 @end example
9241
9242 @item formatting
9243 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
9244 use of tabulations, etc.
9245 @end table
9246
9247 The general syntax is:
9248
9249 @example
9250 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9251 @end example
9252
9253 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
9254 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
9255
9256 @table @code
9257 @item --list-checkers
9258 @itemx -l
9259 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
9260 and exit.
9261
9262 @item --checkers
9263 @itemx -c
9264 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
9265 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
9266
9267 @end table
9268
9269 @node Invoking guix size
9270 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
9271
9272 @cindex size
9273 @cindex package size
9274 @cindex closure
9275 @cindex @command{guix size}
9276 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
9277 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
9278 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
9279 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
9280 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
9281 @command{guix size} can highlight.
9282
9283 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
9284 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
9285 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
9286 example:
9287
9288 @example
9289 $ guix size coreutils
9290 store item total self
9291 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
9292 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
9293 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
9294 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
9295 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
9296 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
9297 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
9298 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
9299 total: 78.9 MiB
9300 @end example
9301
9302 @cindex closure
9303 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
9304 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
9305 would be returned by:
9306
9307 @example
9308 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
9309 @end example
9310
9311 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
9312 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
9313 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
9314 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
9315 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
9316 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
9317
9318 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
9319 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
9320 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
9321 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
9322 on the system anyway.)
9323
9324 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
9325 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
9326 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
9327 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
9328 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
9329 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
9330 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
9331 Coreutils}).
9332
9333 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
9334 reports information based on the available substitutes
9335 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
9336 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
9337
9338 You can also specify several package names:
9339
9340 @example
9341 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
9342 store item total self
9343 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
9344 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
9345 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
9346 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
9347 @dots{}
9348 total: 102.3 MiB
9349 @end example
9350
9351 @noindent
9352 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
9353 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
9354 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
9355
9356 The available options are:
9357
9358 @table @option
9359
9360 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9361 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
9362 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
9363
9364 @item --sort=@var{key}
9365 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
9366
9367 @table @code
9368 @item self
9369 the size of each item (the default);
9370 @item closure
9371 the total size of the item's closure.
9372 @end table
9373
9374 @item --map-file=@var{file}
9375 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
9376
9377 For the example above, the map looks like this:
9378
9379 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
9380 produced by @command{guix size}}
9381
9382 This option requires that
9383 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
9384 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
9385 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
9386
9387 @item --system=@var{system}
9388 @itemx -s @var{system}
9389 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
9390
9391 @end table
9392
9393 @node Invoking guix graph
9394 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
9395
9396 @cindex DAG
9397 @cindex @command{guix graph}
9398 @cindex package dependencies
9399 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
9400 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
9401 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
9402 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
9403 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
9404 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
9405 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
9406 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
9407 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
9408 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
9409 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language.
9410 The general syntax is:
9411
9412 @example
9413 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9414 @end example
9415
9416 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
9417 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
9418 dependencies:
9419
9420 @example
9421 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9422 @end example
9423
9424 The output looks like this:
9425
9426 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9427
9428 Nice little graph, no?
9429
9430 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
9431 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
9432 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
9433 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
9434 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
9435
9436 @table @code
9437 @item package
9438 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
9439 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
9440 filters out many details.
9441
9442 @item reverse-package
9443 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
9444
9445 @example
9446 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
9447 @end example
9448
9449 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
9450 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
9451 @code{reverse-bag} below.)
9452
9453 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
9454 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
9455 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
9456 @option{--list-dependent}}).
9457
9458 @item bag-emerged
9459 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
9460
9461 For instance, the following command:
9462
9463 @example
9464 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9465 @end example
9466
9467 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
9468
9469 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9470
9471 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
9472 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
9473
9474 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
9475 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
9476 here, for conciseness.
9477
9478 @item bag
9479 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
9480 dependencies.
9481
9482 @item bag-with-origins
9483 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
9484
9485 @item reverse-bag
9486 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
9487 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
9488
9489 @example
9490 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
9491 @end example
9492
9493 @noindent
9494 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
9495 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
9496 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
9497 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
9498
9499 @item derivation
9500 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
9501 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
9502 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
9503 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
9504
9505 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
9506 name instead of a package name, as in:
9507
9508 @example
9509 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
9510 @end example
9511
9512 @item module
9513 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9514 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
9515 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
9516
9517 @example
9518 guix graph -t module guile | dot -Tpdf > module-graph.pdf
9519 @end example
9520 @end table
9521
9522 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
9523 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
9524
9525 @table @code
9526 @item references
9527 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
9528 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9529
9530 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
9531 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
9532
9533 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
9534 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
9535 (which can be big!):
9536
9537 @example
9538 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
9539 @end example
9540
9541 @item referrers
9542 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
9543 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9544
9545 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
9546 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
9547 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
9548 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
9549 to it.
9550
9551 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
9552 collected.
9553
9554 @end table
9555
9556 The available options are the following:
9557
9558 @table @option
9559 @item --type=@var{type}
9560 @itemx -t @var{type}
9561 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
9562 the values listed above.
9563
9564 @item --list-types
9565 List the supported graph types.
9566
9567 @item --backend=@var{backend}
9568 @itemx -b @var{backend}
9569 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
9570
9571 @item --list-backends
9572 List the supported graph backends.
9573
9574 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
9575
9576 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9577 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9578 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9579
9580 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9581
9582 @example
9583 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
9584 @end example
9585
9586 @item --system=@var{system}
9587 @itemx -s @var{system}
9588 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
9589
9590 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
9591 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
9592 @end table
9593
9594
9595
9596 @node Invoking guix publish
9597 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
9598
9599 @cindex @command{guix publish}
9600 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
9601 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
9602 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
9603
9604 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
9605 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
9606 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
9607 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
9608 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
9609
9610 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
9611 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
9612 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
9613 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
9614 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
9615
9616 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
9617 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
9618 guix archive}).
9619
9620 The general syntax is:
9621
9622 @example
9623 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
9624 @end example
9625
9626 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
9627 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
9628
9629 @example
9630 guix publish
9631 @end example
9632
9633 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
9634 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
9635
9636 @example
9637 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
9638 @end example
9639
9640 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
9641 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
9642 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
9643 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
9644 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
9645 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
9646 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
9647
9648 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
9649 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
9650 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
9651 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
9652 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
9653 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
9654
9655 @example
9656 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
9657 @end example
9658
9659 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
9660 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
9661
9662 @cindex build logs, publication
9663 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
9664
9665 @example
9666 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
9667 @end example
9668
9669 @noindent
9670 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
9671 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
9672 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
9673 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
9674 running @command{guix-daemon} with @code{--log-compression=gzip} since
9675 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
9676 bzip2 compression.
9677
9678 The following options are available:
9679
9680 @table @code
9681 @item --port=@var{port}
9682 @itemx -p @var{port}
9683 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
9684
9685 @item --listen=@var{host}
9686 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
9687 accept connections from any interface.
9688
9689 @item --user=@var{user}
9690 @itemx -u @var{user}
9691 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
9692 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
9693
9694 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
9695 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
9696 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
9697 one of @code{lzip} and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is omitted, @code{gzip}
9698 is used.
9699
9700 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
9701 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
9702 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
9703
9704 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a small
9705 increase in CPU usage; see
9706 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip Web
9707 page}.
9708
9709 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
9710 the compressed streams are not
9711 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
9712 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
9713 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
9714 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
9715 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
9716 to its responses.
9717
9718 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
9719 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
9720 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
9721 the one they support.
9722
9723 @item --cache=@var{directory}
9724 @itemx -c @var{directory}
9725 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
9726 and only serve archives that are in cache.
9727
9728 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
9729 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
9730 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
9731 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
9732 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
9733 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
9734 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
9735
9736 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
9737 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
9738 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
9739 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
9740 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
9741 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
9742 the best possible bandwidth.
9743
9744 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
9745 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
9746 @option{--workers} below.
9747
9748 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
9749 when they have expired.
9750
9751 @item --workers=@var{N}
9752 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
9753 threads to ``bake'' archives.
9754
9755 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
9756 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
9757 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
9758 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
9759
9760 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
9761 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
9762 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
9763 for as long as @var{ttl}.
9764
9765 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
9766 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
9767 item in the store, may be deleted.
9768
9769 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
9770 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
9771 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
9772
9773 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
9774 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
9775 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
9776
9777 @item --public-key=@var{file}
9778 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
9779 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
9780 the store items being published.
9781
9782 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
9783 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
9784 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
9785 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
9786 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
9787 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
9788
9789 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
9790 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
9791 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
9792 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
9793 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
9794 @end table
9795
9796 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
9797 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
9798 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
9799 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
9800
9801 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
9802 instructions:”
9803
9804 @itemize
9805 @item
9806 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
9807
9808 @example
9809 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
9810 /etc/systemd/system/
9811 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
9812 @end example
9813
9814 @item
9815 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
9816
9817 @example
9818 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
9819 # start guix-publish
9820 @end example
9821
9822 @item
9823 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
9824 @end itemize
9825
9826 @node Invoking guix challenge
9827 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
9828
9829 @cindex reproducible builds
9830 @cindex verifiable builds
9831 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
9832 @cindex challenge
9833 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
9834 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
9835 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
9836 answer.
9837
9838 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
9839 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
9840 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
9841 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
9842 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
9843 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
9844 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
9845
9846 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
9847 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
9848 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
9849 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
9850 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
9851 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
9852 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
9853 any given store item.
9854
9855 The command output looks like this:
9856
9857 @smallexample
9858 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
9859 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
9860 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
9861 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
9862 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
9863 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
9864 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
9865 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
9866 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
9867 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
9868 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
9869 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
9870 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
9871 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
9872 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
9873
9874 @dots{}
9875
9876 6,406 store items were analyzed:
9877 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
9878 - 525 (8.2%) differed
9879 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
9880 @end smallexample
9881
9882 @noindent
9883 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
9884 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
9885 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
9886 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
9887 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
9888
9889 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
9890 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
9891 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
9892 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
9893 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
9894 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
9895 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
9896 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
9897 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
9898 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
9899 more information.
9900
9901 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
9902 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
9903
9904 @example
9905 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
9906 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
9907 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
9908 @end example
9909
9910 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
9911 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
9912 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
9913 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
9914 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
9915 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
9916 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
9917
9918 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
9919 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
9920 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
9921 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
9922 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
9923 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
9924 the problem.
9925
9926 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
9927 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
9928 same build result as you did with:
9929
9930 @example
9931 $ guix challenge @var{package}
9932 @end example
9933
9934 @noindent
9935 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
9936 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
9937
9938 The general syntax is:
9939
9940 @example
9941 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
9942 @end example
9943
9944 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
9945 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
9946 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
9947 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
9948 errors.)
9949
9950 The one option that matters is:
9951
9952 @table @code
9953
9954 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9955 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
9956 URLs to compare to.
9957
9958 @item --verbose
9959 @itemx -v
9960 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
9961 information about mismatches.
9962
9963 @end table
9964
9965 @node Invoking guix copy
9966 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
9967
9968 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
9969 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
9970 @cindex sharing store items across machines
9971 @cindex transferring store items across machines
9972 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
9973 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
9974 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
9975 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
9976 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
9977 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
9978
9979 @example
9980 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
9981 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
9982 @end example
9983
9984 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
9985 they are not actually sent.
9986
9987 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
9988 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
9989
9990 @example
9991 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
9992 @end example
9993
9994 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
9995 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
9996 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
9997
9998 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
9999 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
10000 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
10001 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
10002 store item authentication.
10003
10004 The general syntax is:
10005
10006 @example
10007 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
10008 @end example
10009
10010 You must always specify one of the following options:
10011
10012 @table @code
10013 @item --to=@var{spec}
10014 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
10015 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
10016 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
10017 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
10018 @end table
10019
10020 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
10021 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
10022
10023 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
10024 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
10025 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
10026
10027
10028 @node Invoking guix container
10029 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
10030 @cindex container
10031 @cindex @command{guix container}
10032 @quotation Note
10033 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
10034 is subject to radical change in the future.
10035 @end quotation
10036
10037 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
10038 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
10039 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
10040 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
10041 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
10042
10043 The general syntax is:
10044
10045 @example
10046 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
10047 @end example
10048
10049 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
10050 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
10051
10052 The following actions are available:
10053
10054 @table @code
10055 @item exec
10056 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
10057
10058 The syntax is:
10059
10060 @example
10061 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
10062 @end example
10063
10064 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
10065 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
10066 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
10067 will be passed to @var{program}.
10068
10069 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
10070 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
10071 process ID is 9001:
10072
10073 @example
10074 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
10075 @end example
10076
10077 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
10078 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
10079
10080 @end table
10081
10082 @node Invoking guix weather
10083 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
10084
10085 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
10086 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
10087 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
10088 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
10089 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
10090 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
10091 publish}).
10092
10093 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
10094 @cindex availability of substitutes
10095 @cindex substitute availability
10096 @cindex weather, substitute availability
10097 Here's a sample run:
10098
10099 @example
10100 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
10101 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10102 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
10103 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10104 https://guix.example.org
10105 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
10106 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
10107 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
10108 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
10109 33.5 requests per second
10110
10111 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
10112 867 queued builds
10113 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
10114 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
10115 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
10116 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
10117 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
10118 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
10119 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
10120 @end example
10121
10122 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
10123 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
10124 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
10125 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
10126 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
10127 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
10128 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
10129 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
10130 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
10131 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
10132 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
10133
10134 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
10135 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
10136 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
10137 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
10138 those substitutes.
10139
10140 The general syntax is:
10141
10142 @example
10143 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10144 @end example
10145
10146 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
10147 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
10148 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
10149 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}. The
10150 available options are listed below.
10151
10152 @table @code
10153 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10154 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
10155 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
10156 servers is queried.
10157
10158 @item --system=@var{system}
10159 @itemx -s @var{system}
10160 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
10161 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
10162 substitutes for several system types.
10163
10164 @item --manifest=@var{file}
10165 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
10166 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
10167 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
10168 guix package}).
10169
10170 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
10171 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
10172 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
10173 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
10174 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
10175 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
10176 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
10177
10178 @example
10179 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
10180 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10181 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
10182 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
10183 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
10184 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
10185 @dots{}
10186 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
10187 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
10188 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
10189 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
10190 @dots{}
10191 @end example
10192
10193 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
10194 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
10195 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
10196
10197 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
10198 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
10199 fail to build.
10200 @end table
10201
10202 @node Invoking guix processes
10203 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
10204
10205 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
10206 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
10207 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
10208 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
10209 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
10210 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
10211
10212 @example
10213 $ sudo guix processes
10214 SessionPID: 19002
10215 ClientPID: 19090
10216 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
10217
10218 SessionPID: 19402
10219 ClientPID: 19367
10220 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
10221
10222 SessionPID: 19444
10223 ClientPID: 19419
10224 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10225 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
10226 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
10227 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
10228 ChildProcess: 20495: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10229 ChildProcess: 27733: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10230 ChildProcess: 27793: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10231 @end example
10232
10233 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
10234 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
10235 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
10236 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
10237 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
10238
10239 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked by this
10240 session, which corresponds to store items being built or substituted (the
10241 @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when @command{guix processes} is not
10242 running as root.) Last, by looking at the @code{ChildProcess} field, we
10243 understand that these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10244 Setup}).
10245
10246 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
10247 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
10248 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
10249 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
10250
10251 @example
10252 $ sudo guix processes | \
10253 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
10254 ClientPID: 19419
10255 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10256 @end example
10257
10258
10259 @node System Configuration
10260 @chapter System Configuration
10261
10262 @cindex system configuration
10263 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
10264 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
10265 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
10266 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
10267 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
10268
10269 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
10270 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
10271 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
10272 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
10273 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
10274 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
10275 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
10276 the own tools of the system.
10277 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
10278
10279 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
10280 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
10281 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
10282 instance to support new system services.
10283
10284 @menu
10285 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
10286 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
10287 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
10288 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
10289 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
10290 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
10291 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
10292 * Services:: Specifying system services.
10293 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
10294 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
10295 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
10296 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
10297 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
10298 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
10299 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
10300 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
10301 @end menu
10302
10303 @node Using the Configuration System
10304 @section Using the Configuration System
10305
10306 The operating system is configured by providing an
10307 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
10308 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
10309 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
10310 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
10311
10312 @findex operating-system
10313 @lisp
10314 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
10315 @end lisp
10316
10317 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
10318 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
10319 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
10320 which case they get a default value.
10321
10322 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
10323 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
10324 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
10325 @command{guix system}.
10326
10327 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
10328
10329 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
10330 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
10331 @cindex UEFI boot
10332 @cindex EFI boot
10333 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
10334 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
10335 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
10336 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
10337 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
10338
10339 @example
10340 (bootloader-configuration
10341 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
10342 (target "/boot/efi"))
10343 @end example
10344
10345 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
10346 configuration options.
10347
10348 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
10349
10350 @vindex %base-packages
10351 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
10352 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
10353 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
10354 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
10355 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
10356 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
10357 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
10358 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
10359 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
10360 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
10361 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
10362 of a package:
10363
10364 @lisp
10365 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10366 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
10367
10368 (operating-system
10369 ;; ...
10370 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
10371 %base-packages)))
10372 @end lisp
10373
10374 @findex specification->package
10375 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
10376 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
10377 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
10378 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
10379 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
10380 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
10381 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
10382 version:
10383
10384 @lisp
10385 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10386
10387 (operating-system
10388 ;; ...
10389 (packages (append (map specification->package
10390 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
10391 %base-packages)))
10392 @end lisp
10393
10394 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
10395
10396 @cindex services
10397 @vindex %base-services
10398 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
10399 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
10400 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
10401 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
10402 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
10403 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
10404 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
10405 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
10406 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
10407
10408 @cindex customization, of services
10409 @findex modify-services
10410 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
10411 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
10412 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
10413
10414 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
10415 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
10416 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
10417 following in your operating system declaration:
10418
10419 @lisp
10420 (define %my-services
10421 ;; My very own list of services.
10422 (modify-services %base-services
10423 (guix-service-type config =>
10424 (guix-configuration
10425 (inherit config)
10426 (use-substitutes? #f)
10427 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
10428 (mingetty-service-type config =>
10429 (mingetty-configuration
10430 (inherit config)))))
10431
10432 (operating-system
10433 ;; @dots{}
10434 (services %my-services))
10435 @end lisp
10436
10437 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
10438 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
10439 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
10440 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
10441 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
10442 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
10443 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
10444 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
10445 configuration, but with a few modifications.
10446
10447 @cindex encrypted disk
10448 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
10449 root partition, the X11 display
10450 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
10451 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
10452 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
10453
10454 @lisp
10455 @include os-config-desktop.texi
10456 @end lisp
10457
10458 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
10459 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
10460
10461 @lisp
10462 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
10463 @end lisp
10464
10465 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
10466 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
10467 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
10468
10469 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
10470 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
10471 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
10472
10473 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
10474 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
10475 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
10476 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
10477 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
10478 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
10479
10480 @example
10481 (remove (lambda (service)
10482 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
10483 %desktop-services)
10484 @end example
10485
10486 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
10487
10488 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
10489 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
10490 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
10491 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
10492 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
10493
10494 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
10495 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
10496 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
10497 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
10498 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
10499 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
10500 system, should you ever need to.
10501
10502 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
10503 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
10504 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
10505 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
10506 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
10507 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
10508 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
10509 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
10510 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
10511 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
10512
10513 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
10514 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
10515 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
10516 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
10517 system}).
10518
10519 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
10520
10521 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
10522 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
10523 Monad}):
10524
10525 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
10526 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
10527 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
10528
10529 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
10530 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
10531 instantiate @var{os}.
10532 @end deffn
10533
10534 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
10535 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
10536 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
10537
10538
10539 @node operating-system Reference
10540 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
10541
10542 This section summarizes all the options available in
10543 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
10544 System}).
10545
10546 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
10547 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
10548 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
10549 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
10550
10551 @table @asis
10552 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
10553 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
10554 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
10555 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
10556
10557 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'("quiet")})
10558 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
10559 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
10560
10561 @item @code{bootloader}
10562 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
10563
10564 @item @code{label}
10565 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
10566 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
10567
10568 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
10569 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
10570 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
10571 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
10572
10573 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
10574 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
10575 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
10576 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10577
10578 @quotation Note
10579 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
10580 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
10581 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
10582 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
10583 Window System.
10584 @end quotation
10585
10586 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
10587 @cindex initrd
10588 @cindex initial RAM disk
10589 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
10590 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
10591
10592 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
10593 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
10594 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
10595 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
10596
10597 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
10598 @cindex firmware
10599 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
10600
10601 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
10602 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
10603 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
10604 supported hardware.
10605
10606 @item @code{host-name}
10607 The host name.
10608
10609 @item @code{hosts-file}
10610 @cindex hosts file
10611 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
10612 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10613 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
10614 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
10615
10616 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
10617 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
10618
10619 @item @code{file-systems}
10620 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
10621
10622 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
10623 @cindex swap devices
10624 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
10625 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10626 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
10627 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
10628 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
10629 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
10630
10631 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
10632 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
10633 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
10634
10635 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
10636 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
10637
10638 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
10639 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
10640 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
10641 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
10642
10643 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
10644
10645 @example
10646 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
10647 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
10648 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
10649 (activate-readline)")))
10650 @end example
10651
10652 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
10653 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
10654 displayed when users log in on a text console.
10655
10656 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
10657 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
10658 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
10659
10660 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
10661 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
10662 package}).
10663
10664 @item @code{timezone}
10665 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
10666
10667 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
10668 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
10669 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
10670
10671 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
10672 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
10673 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
10674
10675 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
10676 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
10677 run time. @xref{Locales}.
10678
10679 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
10680 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
10681 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
10682 considerations that justify this option.
10683
10684 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
10685 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
10686 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
10687 details.
10688
10689 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
10690 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
10691
10692 @cindex essential services
10693 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
10694 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
10695 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
10696 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
10697 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
10698
10699 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
10700 @cindex PAM
10701 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
10702 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
10703 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
10704
10705 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
10706 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
10707 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
10708
10709 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
10710 @cindex sudoers file
10711 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
10712 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
10713
10714 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
10715 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
10716 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
10717 @code{sudo}.
10718
10719 @end table
10720
10721 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
10722 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
10723 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
10724
10725 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
10726 the definition of the @code{label} field:
10727
10728 @example
10729 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
10730
10731 (operating-system
10732 ;; ...
10733 (label (package-full-name
10734 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
10735 @end example
10736
10737 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
10738 system definition.
10739 @end deffn
10740
10741 @end deftp
10742
10743 @node File Systems
10744 @section File Systems
10745
10746 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
10747 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
10748 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
10749 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
10750
10751 @example
10752 (file-system
10753 (mount-point "/home")
10754 (device "/dev/sda3")
10755 (type "ext4"))
10756 @end example
10757
10758 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
10759 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
10760
10761 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
10762 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
10763 contain the following members:
10764
10765 @table @asis
10766 @item @code{type}
10767 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
10768 @code{"ext4"}.
10769
10770 @item @code{mount-point}
10771 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
10772
10773 @item @code{device}
10774 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
10775 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
10776 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
10777 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
10778 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
10779 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
10780 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
10781 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
10782 mounted.}.
10783
10784 @findex file-system-label
10785 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
10786 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
10787 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
10788 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
10789
10790 @example
10791 (file-system
10792 (mount-point "/home")
10793 (type "ext4")
10794 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
10795 @end example
10796
10797 @findex uuid
10798 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
10799 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
10800 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
10801 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
10802 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
10803 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
10804 like this:
10805
10806 @example
10807 (file-system
10808 (mount-point "/home")
10809 (type "ext4")
10810 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
10811 @end example
10812
10813 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
10814 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
10815 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
10816 This is required so that
10817 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
10818 corresponding device mapping established.
10819
10820 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
10821 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
10822 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
10823 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
10824 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times), and @code{no-exec}
10825 (disallow program execution). @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
10826 Library Reference Manual}, for more information on these flags.
10827
10828 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
10829 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to the
10830 file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10831 Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for options for
10832 various file systems.
10833
10834 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
10835 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
10836 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
10837 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
10838 is not automatically mounted.
10839
10840 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
10841 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
10842 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
10843 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
10844 instance, for the root file system.
10845
10846 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
10847 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
10848 errors before being mounted.
10849
10850 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
10851 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
10852
10853 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
10854 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
10855 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
10856 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
10857
10858 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
10859 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
10860 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
10861
10862 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
10863 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10864 @end table
10865 @end deftp
10866
10867 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
10868 variables.
10869
10870 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
10871 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
10872 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
10873 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
10874 these.
10875 @end defvr
10876
10877 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
10878 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
10879 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
10880 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10881 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
10882 @command{xterm}.
10883 @end defvr
10884
10885 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
10886 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
10887 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
10888 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
10889 @end defvr
10890
10891 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
10892 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
10893 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
10894 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
10895 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
10896
10897 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
10898 read-write in its own ``name space.''
10899 @end defvr
10900
10901 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
10902 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
10903 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
10904 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
10905 @end defvr
10906
10907 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
10908 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
10909 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
10910 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
10911 @end defvr
10912
10913 @node Mapped Devices
10914 @section Mapped Devices
10915
10916 @cindex device mapping
10917 @cindex mapped devices
10918 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
10919 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
10920 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
10921 with additional processing over the data that flows through
10922 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
10923 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
10924 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
10925 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
10926 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
10927 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
10928 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
10929 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
10930 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
10931 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
10932 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
10933 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
10934 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
10935
10936 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
10937 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
10938
10939 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
10940 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
10941 the system boots up.
10942
10943 @table @code
10944 @item source
10945 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
10946 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
10947 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
10948
10949 @item target
10950 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
10951 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
10952 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
10953 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
10954 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
10955 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
10956
10957 @item type
10958 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
10959 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
10960 @end table
10961 @end deftp
10962
10963 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
10964 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
10965 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
10966 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
10967 @end defvr
10968
10969 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
10970 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
10971 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
10972 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
10973 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
10974 @end defvr
10975
10976 @cindex disk encryption
10977 @cindex LUKS
10978 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
10979 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
10980 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
10981 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
10982 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
10983 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
10984 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
10985
10986 @example
10987 (mapped-device
10988 (source "/dev/sda3")
10989 (target "home")
10990 (type luks-device-mapping))
10991 @end example
10992
10993 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
10994 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
10995 command like:
10996
10997 @example
10998 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
10999 @end example
11000
11001 and use it as follows:
11002
11003 @example
11004 (mapped-device
11005 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
11006 (target "home")
11007 (type luks-device-mapping))
11008 @end example
11009
11010 @cindex swap encryption
11011 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
11012 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
11013 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
11014 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
11015 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
11016
11017 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
11018 may be declared as follows:
11019
11020 @example
11021 (mapped-device
11022 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
11023 (target "/dev/md0")
11024 (type raid-device-mapping))
11025 @end example
11026
11027 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
11028 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11029 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
11030 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
11031 automatically later.
11032
11033
11034 @node User Accounts
11035 @section User Accounts
11036
11037 @cindex users
11038 @cindex accounts
11039 @cindex user accounts
11040 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
11041 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
11042 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
11043
11044 @example
11045 (user-account
11046 (name "alice")
11047 (group "users")
11048 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
11049 "audio" ;sound card
11050 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
11051 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
11052 (comment "Bob's sister")
11053 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
11054 @end example
11055
11056 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
11057 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
11058 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
11059 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
11060 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
11061 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
11062 as declared.
11063
11064 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
11065 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
11066 be specified:
11067
11068 @table @asis
11069 @item @code{name}
11070 The name of the user account.
11071
11072 @item @code{group}
11073 @cindex groups
11074 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
11075 this account belongs to.
11076
11077 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
11078 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
11079 account belongs to.
11080
11081 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
11082 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
11083 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
11084 account is created.
11085
11086 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
11087 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
11088
11089 @item @code{home-directory}
11090 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
11091
11092 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
11093 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
11094 if it does not exist yet.
11095
11096 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
11097 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
11098 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11099
11100 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11101 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
11102 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
11103 graphical login managers do not list them.
11104
11105 @anchor{user-account-password}
11106 @cindex password, for user accounts
11107 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11108 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
11109 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
11110 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
11111 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
11112 reconfiguration.
11113
11114 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
11115 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
11116 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
11117
11118 @example
11119 (user-account
11120 (name "charlie")
11121 (group "users")
11122
11123 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
11124 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
11125 @end example
11126
11127 @quotation Note
11128 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
11129 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
11130 care.
11131 @end quotation
11132
11133 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
11134 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
11135 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
11136
11137 @end table
11138 @end deftp
11139
11140 @cindex groups
11141 User group declarations are even simpler:
11142
11143 @example
11144 (user-group (name "students"))
11145 @end example
11146
11147 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
11148 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
11149
11150 @table @asis
11151 @item @code{name}
11152 The name of the group.
11153
11154 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
11155 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
11156 automatically allocated when the group is created.
11157
11158 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11159 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
11160 System groups have low numerical IDs.
11161
11162 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11163 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
11164 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
11165
11166 @end table
11167 @end deftp
11168
11169 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
11170 expect:
11171
11172 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
11173 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
11174 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
11175 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
11176 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
11177 @end defvr
11178
11179 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
11180 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
11181 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
11182
11183 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
11184 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
11185 @end defvr
11186
11187 @node Keyboard Layout
11188 @section Keyboard Layout
11189
11190 @cindex keyboard layout
11191 @cindex keymap
11192 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
11193 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
11194 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
11195 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
11196 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
11197 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
11198 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
11199
11200 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
11201 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
11202
11203 @itemize
11204 @item
11205 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
11206 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
11207 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
11208 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
11209
11210 @item
11211 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
11212 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
11213 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11214
11215 @item
11216 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
11217 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11218 @end itemize
11219
11220 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
11221 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
11222
11223 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
11224 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
11225 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
11226 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
11227 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
11228 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
11229 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
11230 about. Here are a few example:
11231
11232 @example
11233 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
11234 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
11235 (keyboard-layout "de")
11236
11237 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
11238 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
11239
11240 ;; The Catalan layout.
11241 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
11242
11243 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
11244 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
11245 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
11246 ;; accented letters.
11247 (keyboard-layout "latam"
11248 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
11249
11250 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
11251 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
11252
11253 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
11254 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
11255 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
11256 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
11257 @end example
11258
11259 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
11260 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
11261
11262 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
11263 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
11264 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
11265 configuration would look like:
11266
11267 @findex set-xorg-configuration
11268 @lisp
11269 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
11270 ;; and for Xorg.
11271
11272 (operating-system
11273 ;; ...
11274 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
11275 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
11276 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11277 (target "/boot/efi")
11278 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
11279 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
11280 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
11281 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
11282 %desktop-services)))
11283 @end lisp
11284
11285 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
11286 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
11287 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
11288 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
11289 GDM.
11290
11291 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
11292 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
11293
11294 @itemize
11295 @item
11296 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
11297 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
11298
11299 @item
11300 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
11301 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
11302 change the layout to US Dvorak:
11303
11304 @example
11305 setxkbmap us dvorak
11306 @end example
11307
11308 @item
11309 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
11310 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
11311 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
11312 French bépo layout:
11313
11314 @example
11315 loadkeys fr-bepo
11316 @end example
11317 @end itemize
11318
11319 @node Locales
11320 @section Locales
11321
11322 @cindex locale
11323 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
11324 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11325 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
11326 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
11327 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
11328 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
11329
11330 @cindex locale definition
11331 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
11332 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
11333 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
11334
11335 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
11336 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
11337 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
11338 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
11339 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
11340 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
11341 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
11342 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
11343
11344 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
11345 that field may be:
11346
11347 @example
11348 (cons (locale-definition
11349 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
11350 %default-locale-definitions)
11351 @end example
11352
11353 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
11354 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
11355
11356 @example
11357 (list (locale-definition
11358 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
11359 (charset "EUC-JP")))
11360 @end example
11361
11362 @vindex LOCPATH
11363 The compiled locale definitions are available at
11364 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
11365 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
11366 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
11367 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11368 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11369
11370 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
11371 locale)} module. Details are given below.
11372
11373 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
11374 This is the data type of a locale definition.
11375
11376 @table @asis
11377
11378 @item @code{name}
11379 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11380 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
11381
11382 @item @code{source}
11383 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
11384 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
11385
11386 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
11387 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
11388 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
11389 IANA}.
11390
11391 @end table
11392 @end deftp
11393
11394 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
11395 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
11396 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
11397 declarations.
11398
11399 @cindex locale name
11400 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
11401 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
11402 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
11403 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
11404 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
11405 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
11406 @end defvr
11407
11408 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
11409
11410 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
11411 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
11412 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
11413 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
11414 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
11415 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
11416 another.
11417
11418 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
11419 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
11420 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
11421 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
11422 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
11423 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
11424 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
11425 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
11426 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
11427 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
11428 programs will not abort.
11429
11430 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
11431 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
11432 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
11433 used to build the system-wide locale data.
11434
11435 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
11436 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11437 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11438
11439 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
11440 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
11441 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
11442 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
11443 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
11444 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
11445
11446 @example
11447 (use-package-modules base)
11448
11449 (operating-system
11450 ;; @dots{}
11451 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
11452 @end example
11453
11454 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
11455 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
11456 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
11457
11458
11459 @node Services
11460 @section Services
11461
11462 @cindex system services
11463 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
11464 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
11465 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
11466 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
11467 configuring network access.
11468
11469 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
11470 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
11471 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
11472 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
11473 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
11474 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
11475
11476 @example
11477 # herd status
11478 @end example
11479
11480 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
11481 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
11482 service and its associated actions:
11483
11484 @example
11485 # herd doc nscd
11486 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
11487
11488 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
11489 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
11490 @end example
11491
11492 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
11493 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
11494 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
11495
11496 @example
11497 # herd stop nscd
11498 Service nscd has been stopped.
11499 # herd restart xorg-server
11500 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
11501 Service xorg-server has been started.
11502 @end example
11503
11504 The following sections document the available services, starting with
11505 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
11506 declaration.
11507
11508 @menu
11509 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
11510 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
11511 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
11512 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
11513 * X Window:: Graphical display.
11514 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
11515 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
11516 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
11517 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
11518 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
11519 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
11520 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
11521 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
11522 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
11523 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
11524 * Web Services:: Web servers.
11525 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
11526 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
11527 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
11528 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
11529 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
11530 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
11531 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
11532 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
11533 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
11534 * Game Services:: Game servers.
11535 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
11536 @end menu
11537
11538 @node Base Services
11539 @subsection Base Services
11540
11541 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
11542 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
11543 this module are listed below.
11544
11545 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
11546 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
11547 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
11548 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
11549 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
11550 more.
11551
11552 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
11553 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
11554 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
11555 this:
11556
11557 @example
11558 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
11559 (service openssh-service-type))
11560 %base-services)
11561 @end example
11562 @end defvr
11563
11564 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
11565 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
11566 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
11567
11568 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
11569 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
11570 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
11571
11572 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
11573 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
11574 @example
11575 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append @var{bash} "/bin/sh")))
11576 @end example
11577
11578 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
11579 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
11580 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
11581 change it to:
11582
11583 @example
11584 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append @var{bash} "/bin/sh"))
11585 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append @var{coreutils} "/bin/env")))
11586 @end example
11587
11588 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
11589 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
11590 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
11591 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
11592 (see below.)
11593 @end defvr
11594
11595 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
11596 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
11597
11598 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
11599 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
11600 symlink:
11601
11602 @example
11603 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
11604 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
11605 @end example
11606 @end deffn
11607
11608 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
11609 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
11610 @end deffn
11611
11612 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
11613 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
11614 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
11615 among other things.
11616 @end deffn
11617
11618 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
11619 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
11620
11621 @table @asis
11622
11623 @item @code{motd}
11624 @cindex message of the day
11625 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
11626
11627 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
11628 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
11629 the 'root' account has just been created.
11630
11631 @end table
11632 @end deftp
11633
11634 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
11635 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
11636 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
11637 other things.
11638 @end deffn
11639
11640 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
11641 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
11642 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
11643
11644 @table @asis
11645
11646 @item @code{tty}
11647 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
11648
11649 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11650 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
11651 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
11652 user name and password must be entered to log in.
11653
11654 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
11655 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
11656 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
11657 the name of the log-in program.
11658
11659 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
11660 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
11661 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
11662
11663 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
11664 The Mingetty package to use.
11665
11666 @end table
11667 @end deftp
11668
11669 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
11670 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
11671 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
11672 among other things.
11673 @end deffn
11674
11675 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
11676 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
11677 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
11678 man page for more information.
11679
11680 @table @asis
11681
11682 @item @code{tty}
11683 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
11684 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
11685 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
11686
11687 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
11688 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
11689 from it and use that.
11690
11691 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
11692 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
11693 serial port from it and use that.
11694
11695 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
11696 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
11697 correct values.
11698
11699 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
11700 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
11701 descending order.
11702
11703 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
11704 A string containing the value used for the @code{TERM} environment
11705 variable.
11706
11707 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
11708 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
11709 disabled.
11710
11711 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11712 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
11713 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
11714
11715 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
11716 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
11717
11718 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
11719 This accepts a string containing the "login_host", which will be written
11720 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
11721
11722 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
11723 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
11724 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
11725 specified in @var{login-program}.
11726
11727 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
11728 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
11729
11730 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
11731 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
11732 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
11733
11734 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
11735 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
11736 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
11737
11738 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
11739 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
11740 the login prompt.
11741
11742 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
11743 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
11744 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
11745 Shadow tool suite.
11746
11747 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
11748 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
11749 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
11750 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
11751
11752 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
11753 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
11754 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
11755
11756 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
11757 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
11758 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
11759 systems.
11760
11761 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
11762 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
11763 @file{/etc/issue} file.
11764
11765 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
11766 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
11767 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
11768 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
11769 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
11770 options that could be parsed by the login program.
11771
11772 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
11773 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
11774 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
11775 lazily spawning shells.
11776
11777 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
11778 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
11779 path as a string.
11780
11781 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
11782 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
11783 specified terminal.
11784
11785 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
11786 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
11787 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
11788 character.
11789
11790 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
11791 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
11792 within @var{timeout} seconds.
11793
11794 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
11795 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
11796 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
11797 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
11798 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
11799 Unicode characters.
11800
11801 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
11802 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
11803 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
11804 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
11805 @var{init-string} option.
11806
11807 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
11808 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
11809 locks.
11810
11811 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
11812 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
11813 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
11814
11815 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
11816 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
11817 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
11818 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
11819
11820 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
11821 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
11822 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
11823
11824 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
11825 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean "ignore
11826 all previous characters" (also called a "kill" character) when the user
11827 types their login name.
11828
11829 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
11830 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
11831 to before login.
11832
11833 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
11834 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
11835 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
11836
11837 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
11838 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
11839 @command{login} program.
11840
11841 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
11842 This option provides an "escape hatch" for the user to provide arbitrary
11843 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
11844
11845 @end table
11846 @end deftp
11847
11848 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
11849 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
11850 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
11851 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
11852 @end deffn
11853
11854 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
11855 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
11856 implements virtual console log-in.
11857
11858 @table @asis
11859
11860 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
11861 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
11862
11863 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
11864 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
11865 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
11866
11867 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
11868 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
11869
11870 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11871 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
11872 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
11873
11874 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
11875 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
11876
11877 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
11878 The Kmscon package to use.
11879
11880 @end table
11881 @end deftp
11882
11883 @cindex name service cache daemon
11884 @cindex nscd
11885 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
11886 [#:name-services '()]
11887 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
11888 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
11889 Service Switch}, for an example.
11890
11891 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
11892
11893 @table @code
11894 @item invalidate
11895 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
11896 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
11897 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
11898
11899 @example
11900 herd invalidate nscd hosts
11901 @end example
11902
11903 @noindent
11904 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
11905
11906 @item statistics
11907 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
11908 and caches.
11909 @end table
11910
11911 @end deffn
11912
11913 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
11914 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
11915 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
11916 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
11917 @end defvr
11918
11919 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
11920 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
11921 configuration.
11922
11923 @table @asis
11924
11925 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
11926 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
11927 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
11928
11929 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
11930 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
11931 command.
11932
11933 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
11934 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
11935 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
11936
11937 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
11938 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
11939 debugging output is logged.
11940
11941 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
11942 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
11943 below.
11944
11945 @end table
11946 @end deftp
11947
11948 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
11949 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
11950
11951 @table @asis
11952
11953 @item @code{database}
11954 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
11955 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
11956 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
11957 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
11958
11959 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
11960 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
11961 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
11962 negative lookup result remains in cache.
11963
11964 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
11965 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
11966 @var{database}.
11967
11968 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
11969 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
11970 them into account.
11971
11972 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
11973 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
11974
11975 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
11976 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
11977
11978 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
11979 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
11980
11981 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
11982 @c settings, so leave them out.
11983
11984 @end table
11985 @end deftp
11986
11987 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
11988 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
11989 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
11990
11991 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
11992 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
11993 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
11994 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
11995 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
11996 @end defvr
11997
11998 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
11999 @cindex syslog
12000 @cindex logging
12001 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
12002 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
12003
12004 @table @asis
12005 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
12006 The syslog daemon to use.
12007
12008 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
12009 The syslog configuration file to use.
12010
12011 @end table
12012 @end deftp
12013
12014 @anchor{syslog-service}
12015 @cindex syslog
12016 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
12017 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
12018
12019 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
12020 information on the configuration file syntax.
12021 @end deffn
12022
12023 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
12024 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
12025 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
12026 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
12027 @end defvr
12028
12029 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
12030 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
12031 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
12032 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
12033
12034 @table @asis
12035 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
12036 The Guix package to use.
12037
12038 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
12039 Name of the group for build user accounts.
12040
12041 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
12042 Number of build user accounts to create.
12043
12044 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
12045 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
12046 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
12047 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
12048 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12049
12050 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
12051 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
12052 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
12053 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
12054 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12055
12056 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
12057 Whether to use substitutes.
12058
12059 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
12060 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
12061
12062 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
12063 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
12064 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
12065 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
12066 disables the timeout.
12067
12068 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
12069 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
12070 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
12071
12072 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12073 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
12074
12075 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
12076 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
12077 are written.
12078
12079 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
12080 The HTTP proxy used for downloading fixed-output derivations and
12081 substitutes.
12082
12083 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
12084 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
12085
12086 @end table
12087 @end deftp
12088
12089 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
12090 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
12091 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
12092 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule} and @code{file->udev-rule} from
12093 @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the creation of such rule files.
12094 @end deffn
12095
12096 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
12097 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
12098 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
12099
12100 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
12101 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
12102 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
12103
12104 @example
12105 (define %example-udev-rule
12106 (udev-rule
12107 "90-usb-thing.rules"
12108 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
12109 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
12110 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
12111 @end example
12112
12113 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
12114 directory containing all the active udev rules.
12115 @end deffn
12116
12117 Here we show how the default @var{udev-service} can be extended with it.
12118
12119 @example
12120 (operating-system
12121 ;; @dots{}
12122 (services
12123 (modify-services %desktop-services
12124 (udev-service-type config =>
12125 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12126 (rules (append (udev-configuration-rules config)
12127 (list %example-udev-rule))))))))
12128 @end example
12129
12130 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
12131 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
12132 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
12133
12134 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
12135
12136 @example
12137 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
12138 (guix packages) ;for origin
12139 ;; @dots{})
12140
12141 (define %android-udev-rules
12142 (file->udev-rule
12143 "51-android-udev.rules"
12144 (let ((version "20170910"))
12145 (origin
12146 (method url-fetch)
12147 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
12148 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
12149 (sha256
12150 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
12151 @end example
12152 @end deffn
12153
12154 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
12155 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
12156 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
12157 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
12158 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
12159 packages android)} module.
12160
12161 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
12162 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
12163 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
12164 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
12165 the rules defined within the @var{android-udev-rules} package. To
12166 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
12167 @var{supplementary-groups} of our @var{user-account} declaration, as
12168 well as in the @var{groups} field of the @var{operating-system} record.
12169
12170 @example
12171 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
12172 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
12173 ;; @dots{})
12174
12175 (operating-system
12176 ;; @dots{}
12177 (users (cons (user-acount
12178 ;; @dots{}
12179 (supplementary-groups
12180 '("adbusers" ;for adb
12181 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video"))
12182 ;; @dots{})))
12183
12184 (groups (cons (user-group (system? #t) (name "adbusers"))
12185 %base-groups))
12186
12187 ;; @dots{}
12188
12189 (services
12190 (modify-services %desktop-services
12191 (udev-service-type
12192 config =>
12193 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12194 (rules (cons android-udev-rules
12195 (udev-configuration-rules config))))))))
12196 @end example
12197
12198 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
12199 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
12200 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
12201 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
12202 readable.
12203 @end defvr
12204
12205 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
12206 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
12207 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
12208 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
12209 @end defvr
12210
12211 @cindex mouse
12212 @cindex gpm
12213 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
12214 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
12215 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
12216 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
12217 and paste text.
12218
12219 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
12220 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
12221 @end defvr
12222
12223 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
12224 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
12225
12226 @table @asis
12227 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
12228 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
12229 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
12230 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
12231 more information.
12232
12233 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
12234 The GPM package to use.
12235
12236 @end table
12237 @end deftp
12238
12239 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
12240 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
12241 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
12242 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
12243 object, as described below.
12244
12245 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
12246 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12247 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
12248 @end deffn
12249
12250 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
12251 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
12252 service.
12253
12254 @table @asis
12255 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
12256 The Guix package to use.
12257
12258 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
12259 The TCP port to listen for connections.
12260
12261 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
12262 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
12263 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
12264
12265 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
12266 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
12267 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
12268 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
12269
12270 @example
12271 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
12272 @end example
12273
12274 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
12275 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression.
12276
12277 An empty list disables compression altogether.
12278
12279 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
12280 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
12281 publish, @code{--nar-path}}, for details.
12282
12283 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
12284 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
12285 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
12286 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
12287 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
12288 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
12289
12290 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
12291 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
12292 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
12293 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
12294
12295 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
12296 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
12297 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
12298 for more information.
12299 @end table
12300 @end deftp
12301
12302 @anchor{rngd-service}
12303 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
12304 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
12305 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
12306 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
12307 @var{device} does not exist.
12308 @end deffn
12309
12310 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
12311 @cindex session limits
12312 @cindex ulimit
12313 @cindex priority
12314 @cindex realtime
12315 @cindex jackd
12316 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
12317
12318 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
12319 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
12320 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
12321 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
12322 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
12323
12324 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
12325 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
12326
12327 @example
12328 (pam-limits-service
12329 (list
12330 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
12331 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
12332 @end example
12333
12334 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
12335 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
12336 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
12337 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
12338 @end deffn
12339
12340 @node Scheduled Job Execution
12341 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
12342
12343 @cindex cron
12344 @cindex mcron
12345 @cindex scheduling jobs
12346 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
12347 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
12348 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
12349 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
12350 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
12351 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
12352
12353 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
12354 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
12355 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
12356 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
12357 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
12358 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
12359 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12360
12361 @lisp
12362 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
12363 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12364
12365 (define updatedb-job
12366 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
12367 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
12368 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
12369 (lambda ()
12370 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
12371 "updatedb"
12372 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
12373
12374 (define garbage-collector-job
12375 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
12376 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
12377 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
12378 "guix gc -F 1G"))
12379
12380 (define idutils-job
12381 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
12382 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
12383 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
12384 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
12385 #:user "charlie"))
12386
12387 (operating-system
12388 ;; @dots{}
12389 (services (cons (service mcron-service-type
12390 (mcron-configuration
12391 (jobs (list garbage-collector-job
12392 updatedb-job
12393 idutils-job))))
12394 %base-services)))
12395 @end lisp
12396
12397 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
12398 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
12399 reference of the mcron service.
12400
12401 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
12402 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
12403
12404 @example
12405 # herd schedule mcron
12406 @end example
12407
12408 @noindent
12409 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
12410 also specify the number of tasks to display:
12411
12412 @example
12413 # herd schedule mcron 10
12414 @end example
12415
12416 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
12417 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
12418 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
12419
12420 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
12421 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
12422 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
12423 mcron jobs to run.
12424 @end defvr
12425
12426 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
12427 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
12428
12429 @table @asis
12430 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
12431 The mcron package to use.
12432
12433 @item @code{jobs}
12434 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
12435 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
12436 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
12437 @end table
12438 @end deftp
12439
12440
12441 @node Log Rotation
12442 @subsection Log Rotation
12443
12444 @cindex rottlog
12445 @cindex log rotation
12446 @cindex logging
12447 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
12448 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
12449 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
12450 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
12451 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12452
12453 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
12454 with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
12455
12456 @lisp
12457 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
12458 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
12459 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12460
12461 (operating-system
12462 ;; @dots{}
12463 (services (cons (service rottlog-service-type)
12464 %base-services)))
12465 @end lisp
12466
12467 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
12468 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
12469 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
12470
12471 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
12472 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
12473
12474 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
12475 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
12476 @end defvr
12477
12478 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
12479 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
12480
12481 @table @asis
12482 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
12483 The Rottlog package to use.
12484
12485 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
12486 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
12487 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12488
12489 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
12490 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
12491
12492 @item @code{jobs}
12493 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
12494 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
12495 @end table
12496 @end deftp
12497
12498 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
12499 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
12500
12501 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
12502 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
12503 defined like this:
12504
12505 @example
12506 (log-rotation
12507 (frequency 'daily)
12508 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
12509 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
12510 "rotate 6"
12511 "notifempty"
12512 "nocompress")))
12513 @end example
12514
12515 The list of fields is as follows:
12516
12517 @table @asis
12518 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
12519 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
12520
12521 @item @code{files}
12522 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
12523
12524 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
12525 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
12526 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
12527
12528 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
12529 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
12530 @end table
12531 @end deftp
12532
12533 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
12534 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and
12535 a couple of other files.
12536 @end defvr
12537
12538 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
12539 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
12540 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure")}.
12541 @end defvr
12542
12543 @node Networking Services
12544 @subsection Networking Services
12545
12546 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
12547 the network interface.
12548
12549 @cindex DHCP, networking service
12550 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
12551 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
12552 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
12553 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
12554 @end defvr
12555
12556 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
12557 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
12558 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
12559 For example:
12560
12561 @example
12562 (service dhcpd-service-type
12563 (dhcpd-configuration
12564 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
12565 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
12566 @end example
12567 @end deffn
12568
12569 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
12570 @table @asis
12571 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
12572 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
12573 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
12574 directory. The default package is the
12575 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
12576 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
12577 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
12578 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
12579 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
12580 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
12581 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
12582 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
12583 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
12584 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
12585 details.
12586 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
12587 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
12588 will be created if it does not exist.
12589 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
12590 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
12591 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
12592 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
12593 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
12594 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
12595 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
12596 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
12597 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
12598 @end table
12599 @end deftp
12600
12601 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
12602 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
12603 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
12604 @end defvr
12605
12606 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
12607 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
12608 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
12609 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
12610 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
12611 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
12612 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
12613 interface.
12614
12615 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
12616 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
12617 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
12618 to handle.
12619
12620 For example:
12621
12622 @example
12623 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
12624 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
12625 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
12626 @end example
12627 @end deffn
12628
12629 @cindex wicd
12630 @cindex wireless
12631 @cindex WiFi
12632 @cindex network management
12633 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
12634 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
12635 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
12636
12637 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
12638 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
12639 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
12640 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
12641 @end deffn
12642
12643 @cindex ModemManager
12644
12645 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
12646 This is the service type for the
12647 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
12648 service. The value for this service type is a
12649 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
12650
12651 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12652 Services}).
12653 @end defvr
12654
12655 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
12656 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
12657
12658 @table @asis
12659 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
12660 The ModemManager package to use.
12661
12662 @end table
12663 @end deftp
12664
12665 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
12666 @cindex Modeswitching
12667
12668 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
12669 This is the service type for the
12670 @uref{http://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch} service. The
12671 value for this service type is a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
12672
12673 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
12674 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
12675 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
12676 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
12677 plugged in.
12678
12679 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12680 Services}).
12681 @end defvr
12682
12683 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
12684 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
12685
12686 @table @asis
12687 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
12688 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
12689
12690 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
12691 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
12692 USB_ModeSwitch.
12693
12694 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
12695 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
12696 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
12697 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
12698 file is used.
12699
12700 @end table
12701 @end deftp
12702
12703 @cindex NetworkManager
12704
12705 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
12706 This is the service type for the
12707 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
12708 service. The value for this service type is a
12709 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
12710
12711 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12712 Services}).
12713 @end defvr
12714
12715 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
12716 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
12717
12718 @table @asis
12719 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
12720 The NetworkManager package to use.
12721
12722 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
12723 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
12724 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
12725
12726 @table @samp
12727 @item default
12728 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
12729 provided by currently active connections.
12730
12731 @item dnsmasq
12732 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
12733 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
12734 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
12735
12736 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
12737 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
12738 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
12739 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
12740 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
12741
12742 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
12743 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
12744 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
12745 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
12746 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
12747 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
12748
12749 @example
12750 nmcli connection add type tun \
12751 connection.interface-name tap0 \
12752 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
12753 ipv4.method shared \
12754 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
12755 @end example
12756
12757 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
12758 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
12759 @command{qemu-system-...}.
12760
12761 @item none
12762 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
12763 @end table
12764
12765 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
12766 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
12767 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
12768 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
12769
12770 @end table
12771 @end deftp
12772
12773 @cindex Connman
12774 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
12775 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
12776 a network connection manager.
12777
12778 Its value must be an
12779 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
12780
12781 @example
12782 (service connman-service-type
12783 (connman-configuration
12784 (disable-vpn? #t)))
12785 @end example
12786
12787 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
12788 @end deffn
12789
12790 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
12791 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
12792
12793 @table @asis
12794 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
12795 The connman package to use.
12796
12797 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
12798 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
12799 @end table
12800 @end deftp
12801
12802 @cindex WPA Supplicant
12803 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
12804 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
12805 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
12806 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
12807 @end defvr
12808
12809 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
12810 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
12811
12812 It takes the following parameters:
12813
12814 @table @asis
12815 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
12816 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
12817
12818 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
12819 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
12820
12821 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
12822 Where to store the PID file.
12823
12824 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
12825 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
12826 WPA supplicant will control.
12827
12828 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
12829 Optional configuration file to use.
12830
12831 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12832 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
12833 @end table
12834 @end deftp
12835
12836 @cindex iptables
12837 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
12838 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
12839 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
12840 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
12841 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
12842 22 is shown below.
12843
12844 @lisp
12845 (service iptables-service-type
12846 (iptables-configuration
12847 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
12848 :INPUT ACCEPT
12849 :FORWARD ACCEPT
12850 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
12851 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
12852 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
12853 COMMIT
12854 "))
12855 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
12856 :INPUT ACCEPT
12857 :FORWARD ACCEPT
12858 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
12859 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
12860 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
12861 COMMIT
12862 "))))
12863 @end lisp
12864 @end defvr
12865
12866 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
12867 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
12868
12869 @table @asis
12870 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
12871 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
12872 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
12873 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
12874 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
12875 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
12876 objects}).
12877 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
12878 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
12879 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
12880 objects}).
12881 @end table
12882 @end deftp
12883
12884 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
12885 @cindex real time clock
12886 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
12887 This is the type of the service running the @uref{http://www.ntp.org,
12888 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
12889 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
12890
12891 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
12892 below.
12893 @end defvr
12894
12895 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
12896 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
12897
12898 @table @asis
12899 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
12900 This is the list of servers (host names) with which @command{ntpd} will be
12901 synchronized.
12902
12903 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
12904 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
12905 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
12906
12907 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
12908 The NTP package to use.
12909 @end table
12910 @end deftp
12911
12912 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
12913 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
12914 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
12915 @end defvr
12916
12917 @cindex OpenNTPD
12918 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
12919 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
12920 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
12921 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
12922
12923 @example
12924 (service
12925 openntpd-service-type
12926 (openntpd-configuration
12927 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
12928 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
12929 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
12930 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
12931 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
12932
12933 @end example
12934 @end deffn
12935
12936 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
12937 @table @asis
12938 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
12939 The openntpd executable to use.
12940 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
12941 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
12942 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
12943 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
12944 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
12945 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
12946 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
12947 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
12948 information.
12949 @item @code{server} (default: @var{%ntp-servers})
12950 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
12951 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
12952 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
12953 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
12954 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
12955 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
12956 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
12957 man-in-the-middle attacks.
12958 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
12959 a constraint.
12960 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
12961 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
12962 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
12963 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
12964 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
12965 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
12966 than 180 seconds.
12967 @end table
12968 @end deftp
12969
12970 @cindex inetd
12971 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
12972 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
12973 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
12974 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
12975 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
12976
12977 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
12978 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
12979 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
12980 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
12981 gateway @code{hostname}:
12982
12983 @example
12984 (service
12985 inetd-service-type
12986 (inetd-configuration
12987 (entries (list
12988 (inetd-entry
12989 (name "echo")
12990 (socket-type 'stream)
12991 (protocol "tcp")
12992 (wait? #f)
12993 (user "root"))
12994 (inetd-entry
12995 (node "127.0.0.1")
12996 (name "smtp")
12997 (socket-type 'stream)
12998 (protocol "tcp")
12999 (wait? #f)
13000 (user "root")
13001 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
13002 (arguments
13003 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
13004 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))
13005 @end example
13006
13007 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
13008 @end deffn
13009
13010 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
13011 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
13012
13013 @table @asis
13014 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
13015 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
13016
13017 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
13018 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
13019 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
13020 @end table
13021 @end deftp
13022
13023 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
13024 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
13025 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
13026 requests.
13027
13028 @table @asis
13029 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
13030 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
13031 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
13032 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
13033 description of all options.
13034 @item @code{name}
13035 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
13036 @item @code{socket-type}
13037 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
13038 @code{'seqpacket}.
13039 @item @code{protocol}
13040 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
13041 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
13042 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
13043 listening to new service requests.
13044 @item @code{user}
13045 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
13046 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
13047 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
13048 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
13049 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
13050 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
13051 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
13052 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
13053 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
13054 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
13055 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
13056 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
13057 @end table
13058
13059 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
13060 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
13061 @end deftp
13062
13063 @cindex Tor
13064 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
13065 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
13066 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
13067 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
13068 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
13069
13070 @end defvr
13071
13072 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
13073 @table @asis
13074 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
13075 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
13076 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
13077 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
13078 implementation.
13079
13080 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
13081 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
13082 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
13083 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13084 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
13085 syntax.
13086
13087 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
13088 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
13089 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
13090 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
13091 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
13092 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
13093
13094 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
13095 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
13096 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
13097 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
13098 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
13099 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
13100 @code{tor} group.
13101
13102 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
13103 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
13104 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
13105 @code{SocksPort} option.
13106 @end table
13107 @end deftp
13108
13109 @cindex hidden service
13110 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
13111 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
13112 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
13113
13114 @example
13115 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
13116 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
13117 @end example
13118
13119 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
13120 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
13121
13122 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
13123 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
13124 service.
13125
13126 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
13127 project's documentation} for more information.
13128 @end deffn
13129
13130 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
13131
13132 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
13133 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
13134 files.
13135
13136 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
13137 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
13138 The value for this service type is a
13139 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
13140
13141 @example
13142 (service rsync-service-type)
13143 @end example
13144
13145 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
13146 @end deffn
13147
13148 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
13149 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
13150
13151 @table @asis
13152 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
13153 @code{rsync} package to use.
13154
13155 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
13156 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
13157 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
13158 @code{root} user and group.
13159
13160 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
13161 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
13162
13163 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
13164 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
13165
13166 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
13167 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
13168
13169 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
13170 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
13171
13172 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
13173 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13174
13175 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
13176 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13177
13178 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
13179 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
13180
13181 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
13182 I/O timeout in seconds.
13183
13184 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
13185 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
13186
13187 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
13188 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
13189
13190 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13191 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
13192 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
13193
13194 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13195 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
13196
13197 @end table
13198 @end deftp
13199
13200 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
13201 @cindex SSH
13202 @cindex SSH server
13203
13204 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
13205 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
13206 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
13207 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
13208 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
13209 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
13210 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
13211 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
13212 only by root.
13213
13214 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
13215 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
13216 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
13217 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
13218 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
13219
13220 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
13221 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
13222 require interaction.
13223
13224 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
13225 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
13226 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
13227 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
13228
13229 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
13230 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
13231 or addresses.
13232
13233 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
13234 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
13235 root.
13236
13237 The other options should be self-descriptive.
13238 @end deffn
13239
13240 @cindex SSH
13241 @cindex SSH server
13242 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
13243 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
13244 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
13245 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
13246
13247 @example
13248 (service openssh-service-type
13249 (openssh-configuration
13250 (x11-forwarding? #t)
13251 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
13252 (authorized-keys
13253 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
13254 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
13255 @end example
13256
13257 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
13258
13259 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
13260 example:
13261
13262 @example
13263 (service-extension openssh-service-type
13264 (const `(("charlie"
13265 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
13266 @end example
13267 @end deffn
13268
13269 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
13270 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
13271
13272 @table @asis
13273 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
13274 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
13275
13276 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
13277 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
13278
13279 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
13280 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
13281 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
13282 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
13283 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
13284
13285 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13286 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
13287 not.
13288
13289 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13290 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
13291 other authentication methods.
13292
13293 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13294 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
13295 false, users have to use other authentication method.
13296
13297 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13298 This is used only by protocol version 2.
13299
13300 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
13301 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
13302 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
13303 @option{-Y} will work.
13304
13305 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13306 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
13307
13308 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13309 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
13310
13311 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
13312 Whether to allow gateway ports.
13313
13314 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
13315 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
13316 PAM).
13317
13318 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
13319 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
13320 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
13321 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
13322 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
13323 module processing for all authentication types.
13324
13325 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
13326 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
13327 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
13328 @code{password-authentication?}.
13329
13330 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
13331 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
13332 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
13333
13334 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
13335 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
13336
13337 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
13338 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
13339 subsystem request.
13340
13341 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
13342 server. Alternately, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
13343 @example
13344 (service openssh-service-type
13345 (openssh-configuration
13346 (subsystems
13347 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
13348 @end example
13349
13350 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
13351 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
13352
13353 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
13354 @code{man sshd_config}.
13355
13356 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @code{COLORTERM} variable.
13357 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
13358 your shell's ressource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
13359 if this variable is set.
13360
13361 @example
13362 (service openssh-service-type
13363 (openssh-configuration
13364 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
13365 @end example
13366
13367 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
13368 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
13369 @cindex SSH authorized keys
13370 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
13371 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
13372 keys. For example:
13373
13374 @example
13375 (openssh-configuration
13376 (authorized-keys
13377 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
13378 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
13379 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
13380 @end example
13381
13382 @noindent
13383 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
13384 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
13385
13386 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
13387 @code{service-extension}.
13388
13389 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
13390 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13391
13392 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
13393 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
13394 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
13395 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
13396
13397 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
13398 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
13399 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
13400 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
13401 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
13402
13403 @example
13404 (openssh-configuration
13405 (extra-content "\
13406 Match Address 192.168.0.1
13407 PermitRootLogin yes"))
13408 @end example
13409
13410 @end table
13411 @end deftp
13412
13413 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
13414 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
13415 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
13416 object.
13417
13418 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
13419 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
13420
13421 @example
13422 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
13423 (port-number 1234)))
13424 @end example
13425 @end deffn
13426
13427 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
13428 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
13429
13430 @table @asis
13431 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
13432 The Dropbear package to use.
13433
13434 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
13435 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
13436
13437 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
13438 Whether to enable syslog output.
13439
13440 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
13441 File name of the daemon's PID file.
13442
13443 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13444 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
13445
13446 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13447 Whether to allow empty passwords.
13448
13449 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13450 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
13451 @end table
13452 @end deftp
13453
13454 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
13455 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
13456 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
13457 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
13458 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
13459 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
13460
13461 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
13462 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
13463 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
13464
13465 @example
13466 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13467
13468 (operating-system
13469 (host-name "mymachine")
13470 ;; ...
13471 (hosts-file
13472 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
13473 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
13474 (plain-file "hosts"
13475 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
13476 %facebook-host-aliases))))
13477 @end example
13478
13479 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
13480 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
13481 @end defvr
13482
13483 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
13484
13485 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
13486 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
13487 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
13488 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
13489 Its value must be a @code{zero-configuration} record---see below.
13490
13491 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
13492 resolve @code{.local} host names using
13493 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
13494 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
13495
13496 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
13497 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
13498 @end defvr
13499
13500 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
13501 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
13502
13503 @table @asis
13504
13505 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
13506 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
13507 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
13508
13509 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
13510 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
13511 network.
13512
13513 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
13514 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
13515 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
13516 your local network, you can run:
13517
13518 @example
13519 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
13520 @end example
13521
13522 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
13523 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
13524
13525 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
13526 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
13527 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
13528
13529 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
13530 This is a list of domains to browse.
13531 @end table
13532 @end deftp
13533
13534 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
13535 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
13536 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
13537 object.
13538 @end deffn
13539
13540 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
13541 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
13542 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
13543 through programmatic extension.
13544
13545 @table @asis
13546 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
13547 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
13548
13549 @end table
13550 @end deftp
13551
13552 @node X Window
13553 @subsection X Window
13554
13555 @cindex X11
13556 @cindex X Window System
13557 @cindex login manager
13558 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
13559 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
13560 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
13561 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
13562
13563 @cindex GDM
13564 @cindex GNOME, login manager
13565 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
13566 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
13567 features such as automatic screen locking.
13568
13569 @cindex window manager
13570 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
13571 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
13572 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
13573 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
13574
13575 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
13576 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
13577 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
13578 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
13579 (see below.)
13580
13581 @cindex session types (X11)
13582 @cindex X11 session types
13583 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
13584 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
13585 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
13586 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
13587 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
13588
13589 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
13590 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
13591 and/or other X clients.
13592 @end defvr
13593
13594 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
13595 @table @asis
13596 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13597 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
13598 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
13599
13600 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
13601 @code{default-user}.
13602
13603 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
13604 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
13605
13606 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13607 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13608
13609 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
13610 Script to run before starting a X session.
13611
13612 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
13613 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
13614
13615 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
13616 The GDM package to use.
13617 @end table
13618 @end deftp
13619
13620 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
13621 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
13622
13623 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
13624 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
13625 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
13626
13627 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
13628 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
13629 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
13630 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
13631 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
13632 and tty8.
13633
13634 @lisp
13635 (use-modules (gnu services)
13636 (gnu services desktop)
13637 (gnu services xorg)
13638 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
13639
13640 (operating-system
13641 ;; ...
13642 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
13643 (display ":0")
13644 (vt "vt7")))
13645 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
13646 (display ":1")
13647 (vt "vt8")))
13648 (remove (lambda (service)
13649 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
13650 %desktop-services))))
13651 @end lisp
13652
13653 @end defvr
13654
13655 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
13656 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
13657
13658 @table @asis
13659 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
13660 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
13661
13662 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13663 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
13664 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
13665
13666 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
13667 @code{default-user}.
13668
13669 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
13670 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
13671 The graphical theme to use and its name.
13672
13673 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
13674 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
13675 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
13676
13677 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
13678 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
13679 will be used.
13680
13681 @quotation Note
13682 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
13683 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
13684 false, you will be unable to log in.
13685 @end quotation
13686
13687 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13688 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13689
13690 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
13691 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
13692
13693 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
13694 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
13695
13696 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
13697 The XAuth package to use.
13698
13699 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
13700 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
13701 @command{reboot}.
13702
13703 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
13704 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
13705
13706 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
13707 The SLiM package to use.
13708 @end table
13709 @end deftp
13710
13711 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
13712 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
13713 The default SLiM theme and its name.
13714 @end defvr
13715
13716
13717 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
13718 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
13719
13720 @table @asis
13721 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
13722 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
13723 or "wayland".
13724
13725 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
13726 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
13727
13728 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
13729 Command to run when halting.
13730
13731 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
13732 Command to run when rebooting.
13733
13734 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
13735 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
13736
13737 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
13738 Directory to look for themes.
13739
13740 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
13741 Directory to look for faces.
13742
13743 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
13744 Default PATH to use.
13745
13746 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
13747 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
13748
13749 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
13750 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
13751
13752 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
13753 Remember last user.
13754
13755 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
13756 Remember last session.
13757
13758 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
13759 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
13760
13761 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
13762 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
13763
13764 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
13765 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
13766
13767 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
13768 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
13769
13770 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13771 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13772
13773 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
13774 Path to xauth.
13775
13776 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
13777 Path to Xephyr.
13778
13779 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
13780 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
13781
13782 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
13783 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
13784
13785 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
13786 Script to run before starting a X session.
13787
13788 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
13789 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
13790
13791 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
13792 Minimum VT to use.
13793
13794 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
13795 User to use for auto-login.
13796
13797 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
13798 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
13799
13800 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
13801 Relogin after logout.
13802
13803 @end table
13804 @end deftp
13805
13806 @cindex login manager
13807 @cindex X11 login
13808 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sddm-service config
13809 Return a service that spawns the SDDM graphical login manager for config of
13810 type @code{<sddm-configuration>}.
13811
13812 @example
13813 (sddm-service (sddm-configuration
13814 (auto-login-user "Alice")
13815 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
13816 @end example
13817 @end deffn
13818
13819 @cindex Xorg, configuration
13820 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
13821 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
13822 server. Note that there is not Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
13823 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
13824 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
13825
13826 @table @asis
13827 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
13828 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
13829 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
13830
13831 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
13832 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
13833
13834 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
13835 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
13836 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
13837 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
13838
13839 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
13840 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
13841 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
13842 768) (640 480))}.
13843
13844 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
13845 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
13846 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
13847 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
13848 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
13849
13850 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
13851 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
13852 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
13853
13854 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
13855 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
13856 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
13857
13858 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
13859 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
13860
13861 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
13862 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
13863 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
13864 @end table
13865 @end deftp
13866
13867 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
13868 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
13869 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
13870 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
13871
13872 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
13873 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
13874 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
13875 @end deffn
13876
13877 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
13878 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
13879 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
13880 @code{startx}.
13881
13882 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
13883 @end deffn
13884
13885
13886 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
13887 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
13888 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
13889 for it. For example:
13890
13891 @lisp
13892 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
13893 @end lisp
13894
13895 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
13896 @end deffn
13897
13898
13899 @node Printing Services
13900 @subsection Printing Services
13901
13902 @cindex printer support with CUPS
13903 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
13904 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
13905 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
13906
13907 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
13908 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
13909 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
13910 write:
13911 @example
13912 (service cups-service-type)
13913 @end example
13914 @end deffn
13915
13916 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
13917 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
13918 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
13919 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
13920 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
13921 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
13922 secure connections to the print server.
13923
13924 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
13925 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
13926 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package. You can do that directly,
13927 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
13928
13929 @example
13930 (service cups-service-type
13931 (cups-configuration
13932 (web-interface? #t)
13933 (extensions
13934 (list cups-filters escpr hplip-minimal))))
13935 @end example
13936
13937 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
13938 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
13939 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
13940
13941 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
13942 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
13943 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
13944 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
13945 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
13946 from some other system; see the end for more details.
13947
13948 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
13949 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
13950 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
13951 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
13952 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
13953 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
13954 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
13955
13956
13957 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
13958
13959 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
13960 The CUPS package.
13961 @end deftypevr
13962
13963 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
13964 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
13965 @end deftypevr
13966
13967 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
13968 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
13969 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
13970
13971 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
13972
13973 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
13974 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
13975 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
13976 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
13977 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
13978 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
13979 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
13980 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
13981
13982 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
13983 @end deftypevr
13984
13985 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
13986 Where CUPS should cache data.
13987
13988 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
13989 @end deftypevr
13990
13991 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
13992 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
13993 writes.
13994
13995 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
13996 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
13997 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
13998 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
13999 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
14000
14001 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
14002 @end deftypevr
14003
14004 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
14005 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14006 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14007 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14008 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14009 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14010 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14011 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
14012
14013 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
14014 @end deftypevr
14015
14016 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
14017 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
14018 kind strings are:
14019
14020 @table @code
14021 @item none
14022 No errors are fatal.
14023
14024 @item all
14025 All of the errors below are fatal.
14026
14027 @item browse
14028 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
14029 to the DNS-SD daemon.
14030
14031 @item config
14032 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
14033
14034 @item listen
14035 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
14036 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
14037
14038 @item log
14039 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
14040
14041 @item permissions
14042 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
14043 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
14044 @end table
14045
14046 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
14047 @end deftypevr
14048
14049 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
14050 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
14051 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
14052
14053 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14054 @end deftypevr
14055
14056 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
14057 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
14058 programs.
14059
14060 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14061 @end deftypevr
14062
14063 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
14064 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
14065
14066 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
14067 @end deftypevr
14068
14069 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
14070 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14071 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14072 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14073 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14074 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14075 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14076 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
14077
14078 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
14079 @end deftypevr
14080
14081 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
14082 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
14083 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
14084
14085 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
14086 @end deftypevr
14087
14088 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
14089 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
14090 data.
14091
14092 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
14093 @end deftypevr
14094
14095 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
14096 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
14097 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
14098 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
14099 used/supported on macOS.
14100
14101 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
14102 @end deftypevr
14103
14104 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
14105 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
14106 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
14107 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
14108 PEM-encoded private keys.
14109
14110 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
14111 @end deftypevr
14112
14113 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
14114 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
14115
14116 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
14117 @end deftypevr
14118
14119 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
14120 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
14121 configuration or state files.
14122
14123 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14124 @end deftypevr
14125
14126 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
14127 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
14128 @end deftypevr
14129
14130 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
14131 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
14132
14133 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
14134 @end deftypevr
14135
14136 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
14137 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
14138 programs.
14139
14140 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14141 @end deftypevr
14142 @end deftypevr
14143
14144 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
14145 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
14146 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
14147 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
14148 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
14149 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
14150 level logs all requests.
14151
14152 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
14153 @end deftypevr
14154
14155 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
14156 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
14157 longer required for quotas.
14158
14159 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14160 @end deftypevr
14161
14162 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
14163 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
14164
14165 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
14166 @end deftypevr
14167
14168 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
14169 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
14170
14171 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14172 @end deftypevr
14173
14174 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
14175 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
14176
14177 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14178 @end deftypevr
14179
14180 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
14181 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
14182 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
14183 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
14184 secure printing functions.
14185
14186 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14187 @end deftypevr
14188
14189 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
14190 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
14191 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
14192
14193 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14194 @end deftypevr
14195
14196 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
14197 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
14198
14199 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
14200 @end deftypevr
14201
14202 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
14203 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
14204
14205 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
14206 @end deftypevr
14207
14208 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
14209 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
14210
14211 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
14212 @end deftypevr
14213
14214 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
14215 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
14216 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
14217 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
14218 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
14219
14220 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
14221 @end deftypevr
14222
14223 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
14224 Specifies the default access policy to use.
14225
14226 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
14227 @end deftypevr
14228
14229 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
14230 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
14231
14232 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14233 @end deftypevr
14234
14235 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
14236 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
14237 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
14238 typically within a few milliseconds.
14239
14240 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14241 @end deftypevr
14242
14243 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
14244 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
14245 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
14246 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
14247 @code{retry-this-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
14248 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
14249
14250 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
14251 @end deftypevr
14252
14253 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
14254 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
14255 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
14256 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
14257 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
14258 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
14259 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
14260 at any time.
14261
14262 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14263 @end deftypevr
14264
14265 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
14266 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
14267 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
14268 lowest priority.
14269
14270 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14271 @end deftypevr
14272
14273 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
14274 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
14275 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
14276 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
14277 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
14278 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
14279 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
14280
14281 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14282 @end deftypevr
14283
14284 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
14285 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
14286 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
14287
14288 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14289 @end deftypevr
14290
14291 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
14292 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
14293 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14294 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14295 @code{retry-current-job}.
14296
14297 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14298 @end deftypevr
14299
14300 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
14301 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
14302 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14303 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14304 @code{retry-current-job}.
14305
14306 Defaults to @samp{5}.
14307 @end deftypevr
14308
14309 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
14310 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
14311
14312 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14313 @end deftypevr
14314
14315 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
14316 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
14317
14318 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14319 @end deftypevr
14320
14321 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
14322 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
14323 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
14324
14325 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14326 @end deftypevr
14327
14328 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
14329 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
14330 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
14331 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
14332 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
14333 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
14334 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
14335 @end deftypevr
14336
14337 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
14338 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
14339 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
14340 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
14341 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
14342 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
14343 ones.
14344
14345 Defaults to @samp{128}.
14346 @end deftypevr
14347
14348 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
14349 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
14350
14351 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
14352
14353 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
14354 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
14355 @end deftypevr
14356
14357 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
14358 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
14359 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
14360
14361 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14362 @end deftypevr
14363
14364 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
14365 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
14366
14367 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14368
14369 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
14370
14371 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
14372 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
14373 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
14374
14375 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14376 @end deftypevr
14377
14378 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
14379 Methods to which this access control applies.
14380
14381 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14382 @end deftypevr
14383
14384 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
14385 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
14386 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
14387
14388 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14389 @end deftypevr
14390 @end deftypevr
14391 @end deftypevr
14392
14393 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
14394 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
14395 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
14396 of the LogLevel setting.
14397
14398 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14399 @end deftypevr
14400
14401 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
14402 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
14403 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
14404
14405 Defaults to @samp{info}.
14406 @end deftypevr
14407
14408 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
14409 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
14410 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
14411
14412 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
14413 @end deftypevr
14414
14415 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
14416 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
14417 the scheduler.
14418
14419 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14420 @end deftypevr
14421
14422 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
14423 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
14424 from a single address.
14425
14426 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14427 @end deftypevr
14428
14429 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
14430 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
14431 job.
14432
14433 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
14434 @end deftypevr
14435
14436 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
14437 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
14438 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
14439 held jobs.
14440
14441 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14442 @end deftypevr
14443
14444 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
14445 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
14446 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
14447
14448 Defaults to @samp{500}.
14449 @end deftypevr
14450
14451 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
14452 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
14453 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
14454
14455 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14456 @end deftypevr
14457
14458 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
14459 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
14460 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
14461
14462 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14463 @end deftypevr
14464
14465 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
14466 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
14467 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
14468
14469 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
14470 @end deftypevr
14471
14472 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
14473 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
14474 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
14475
14476 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
14477 @end deftypevr
14478
14479 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
14480 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
14481 multiple file print job, in seconds.
14482
14483 Defaults to @samp{300}.
14484 @end deftypevr
14485
14486 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
14487 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
14488 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
14489 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
14490 sequences are recognized:
14491
14492 @table @samp
14493 @item %%
14494 insert a single percent character
14495
14496 @item %@{name@}
14497 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
14498
14499 @item %C
14500 insert the number of copies for the current page
14501
14502 @item %P
14503 insert the current page number
14504
14505 @item %T
14506 insert the current date and time in common log format
14507
14508 @item %j
14509 insert the job ID
14510
14511 @item %p
14512 insert the printer name
14513
14514 @item %u
14515 insert the username
14516 @end table
14517
14518 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
14519 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
14520 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
14521 standard items.
14522
14523 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14524 @end deftypevr
14525
14526 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
14527 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
14528 of strings.
14529
14530 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14531 @end deftypevr
14532
14533 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
14534 Specifies named access control policies.
14535
14536 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
14537
14538 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
14539 Name of the policy.
14540 @end deftypevr
14541
14542 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
14543 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
14544 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
14545 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
14546 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
14547 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
14548 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
14549 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
14550 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
14551 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
14552
14553 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
14554 @end deftypevr
14555
14556 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
14557 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
14558 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
14559
14560 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
14561 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
14562 @end deftypevr
14563
14564 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
14565 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
14566 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
14567 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
14568 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
14569 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
14570 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
14571 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
14572 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
14573 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
14574
14575 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
14576 @end deftypevr
14577
14578 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
14579 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
14580 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
14581
14582 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
14583 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
14584 @end deftypevr
14585
14586 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
14587 Access control by IPP operation.
14588
14589 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14590 @end deftypevr
14591 @end deftypevr
14592
14593 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
14594 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
14595 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
14596 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
14597 value applies indefinitely.
14598
14599 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
14600 @end deftypevr
14601
14602 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
14603 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
14604 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
14605 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
14606 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
14607
14608 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14609 @end deftypevr
14610
14611 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
14612 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
14613 restarting the scheduler.
14614
14615 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14616 @end deftypevr
14617
14618 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
14619 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
14620 into bitmaps for a printer.
14621
14622 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
14623 @end deftypevr
14624
14625 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
14626 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
14627
14628 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
14629 @end deftypevr
14630
14631 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
14632 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
14633 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
14634 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
14635 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
14636 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
14637 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
14638 @code{*}.
14639
14640 Defaults to @samp{*}.
14641 @end deftypevr
14642
14643 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
14644 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
14645
14646 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
14647 @end deftypevr
14648
14649 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
14650 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
14651 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
14652 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
14653 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
14654 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
14655 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
14656 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
14657
14658 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
14659 @end deftypevr
14660
14661 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string set-env
14662 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
14663
14664 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
14665 @end deftypevr
14666
14667 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
14668 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
14669 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
14670 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
14671 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
14672
14673 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14674 @end deftypevr
14675
14676 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
14677 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
14678 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. The
14679 @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher suites, which are
14680 required for some older clients that do not implement newer ones. The
14681 @code{AllowSSL3} option enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some
14682 older clients that do not support TLS v1.0.
14683
14684 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14685 @end deftypevr
14686
14687 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
14688 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
14689 the IPP specifications.
14690
14691 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14692 @end deftypevr
14693
14694 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
14695 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
14696
14697 Defaults to @samp{300}.
14698
14699 @end deftypevr
14700
14701 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
14702 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
14703
14704 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14705 @end deftypevr
14706
14707 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
14708 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
14709 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
14710 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
14711 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
14712 @code{cups-service-type}.
14713
14714 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
14715
14716 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
14717 The CUPS package.
14718 @end deftypevr
14719
14720 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
14721 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
14722 @end deftypevr
14723
14724 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
14725 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
14726 @end deftypevr
14727
14728 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
14729 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
14730 this:
14731
14732 @example
14733 (service cups-service-type
14734 (opaque-cups-configuration
14735 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
14736 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
14737 @end example
14738
14739
14740 @node Desktop Services
14741 @subsection Desktop Services
14742
14743 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
14744 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
14745 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
14746 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
14747 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
14748
14749 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
14750 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
14751 environment and networking:
14752
14753 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
14754 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
14755 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
14756
14757 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
14758 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
14759 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
14760 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
14761 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
14762 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
14763 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
14764 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
14765 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
14766 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
14767 @end defvr
14768
14769 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
14770 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
14771 Reference, @code{services}}).
14772
14773 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
14774 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type} and
14775 @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type} procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE
14776 and/or Enlightenment to a system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level
14777 services like the backlight adjustment helpers and the power management
14778 utilities are added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
14779 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
14780 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
14781 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds the GNOME
14782 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce service
14783 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
14784 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
14785 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
14786 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
14787 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
14788 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
14789 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
14790 adding a service of type @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE
14791 metapackage to the system profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that
14792 @code{dbus} is extended appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries
14793 are set as setuid, allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other
14794 functionality to work as expetected.
14795
14796 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
14797 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
14798 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
14799 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
14800 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
14801 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
14802 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
14803 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
14804
14805 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
14806 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
14807 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
14808 object (see below.)
14809
14810 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
14811 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
14812 @end defvr
14813
14814 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
14815 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
14816
14817 @table @asis
14818 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
14819 The GNOME package to use.
14820 @end table
14821 @end deftp
14822
14823 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
14824 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
14825 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
14826 (see below.)
14827
14828 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
14829 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
14830 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
14831 with the administrator's password.
14832 @end defvr
14833
14834 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
14835 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
14836
14837 @table @asis
14838 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
14839 The Xfce package to use.
14840 @end table
14841 @end deftp
14842
14843 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
14844 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
14845 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
14846 object (see below.)
14847
14848 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
14849 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
14850 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
14851 @end deffn
14852
14853 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
14854 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
14855
14856 @table @asis
14857 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
14858 The MATE package to use.
14859 @end table
14860 @end deftp
14861
14862 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
14863 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
14864 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
14865 @end deffn
14866
14867 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
14868 @table @asis
14869 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
14870 The enlightenment package to use.
14871 @end table
14872 @end deftp
14873
14874 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
14875 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
14876 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
14877 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
14878 @code{operating-system}:
14879
14880 @example
14881 (use-modules (gnu))
14882 (use-service-modules desktop)
14883 (operating-system
14884 ...
14885 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
14886 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
14887 (service xfce-desktop-service)
14888 %desktop-services))
14889 ...)
14890 @end example
14891
14892 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
14893 graphical login window.
14894
14895 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
14896 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
14897 are described below.
14898
14899 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
14900 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
14901 support for @var{services}.
14902
14903 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
14904 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
14905 and to be notified of system-wide events.
14906
14907 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
14908 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
14909 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
14910 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
14911 @end deffn
14912
14913 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
14914 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
14915 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
14916 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
14917 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
14918 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
14919
14920 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
14921 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
14922 when the power button is pressed.
14923
14924 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
14925 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
14926 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
14927 their default values are:
14928
14929 @table @code
14930 @item kill-user-processes?
14931 @code{#f}
14932 @item kill-only-users
14933 @code{()}
14934 @item kill-exclude-users
14935 @code{("root")}
14936 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
14937 @code{5}
14938 @item handle-power-key
14939 @code{poweroff}
14940 @item handle-suspend-key
14941 @code{suspend}
14942 @item handle-hibernate-key
14943 @code{hibernate}
14944 @item handle-lid-switch
14945 @code{suspend}
14946 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
14947 @code{ignore}
14948 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
14949 @code{#f}
14950 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
14951 @code{#f}
14952 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
14953 @code{#f}
14954 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
14955 @code{#t}
14956 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
14957 @code{30}
14958 @item idle-action
14959 @code{ignore}
14960 @item idle-action-seconds
14961 @code{(* 30 60)}
14962 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
14963 @code{10}
14964 @item runtime-directory-size
14965 @code{#f}
14966 @item remove-ipc?
14967 @code{#t}
14968 @item suspend-state
14969 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
14970 @item suspend-mode
14971 @code{()}
14972 @item hibernate-state
14973 @code{("disk")}
14974 @item hibernate-mode
14975 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
14976 @item hybrid-sleep-state
14977 @code{("disk")}
14978 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
14979 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
14980 @end table
14981 @end deffn
14982
14983 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
14984 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
14985 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
14986 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
14987 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
14988 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
14989 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
14990 accountsservice web site} for more information.
14991
14992 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
14993 package to expose as a service.
14994 @end deffn
14995
14996 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
14997 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
14998 Return a service that runs the
14999 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
15000 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
15001 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
15002 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
15003 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
15004 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
15005 @end deffn
15006
15007 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
15008 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
15009 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
15010 configuration settings.
15011
15012 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
15013 notably used by GNOME.
15014 @end defvr
15015
15016 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
15017 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
15018
15019 @table @asis
15020
15021 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
15022 Package to use for @code{upower}.
15023
15024 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
15025 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
15026
15027 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
15028 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
15029
15030 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
15031 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
15032
15033 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
15034 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
15035 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
15036
15037 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
15038 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15039 at which the battery is considered low.
15040
15041 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
15042 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15043 at which the battery is considered critical.
15044
15045 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
15046 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15047 at which action will be taken.
15048
15049 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
15050 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15051 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
15052
15053 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
15054 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15055 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
15056
15057 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
15058 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15059 seconds at which action will be taken.
15060
15061 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
15062 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
15063 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
15064
15065 Possible values are:
15066
15067 @itemize @bullet
15068 @item
15069 @code{'power-off}
15070
15071 @item
15072 @code{'hibernate}
15073
15074 @item
15075 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
15076 @end itemize
15077
15078 @end table
15079 @end deftp
15080
15081 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
15082 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
15083 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
15084 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
15085 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
15086 @end deffn
15087
15088 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
15089 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
15090 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
15091 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
15092 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
15093 site} for more information.
15094 @end deffn
15095
15096 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
15097 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
15098 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
15099 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
15100 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
15101 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
15102 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
15103 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
15104 means that all users are allowed.
15105 @end deffn
15106
15107 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
15108 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
15109 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
15110 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
15111 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
15112 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
15113 know the user's location.
15114 @end defvr
15115
15116 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
15117 [#:whitelist '()] @
15118 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
15119 [#:submit-data? #f]
15120 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
15121 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
15122 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
15123 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
15124 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
15125 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
15126 location databases. See
15127 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
15128 web site} for more information.
15129 @end deffn
15130
15131 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
15132 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
15133 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
15134 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
15135 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
15136 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
15137 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
15138
15139 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
15140 @end deffn
15141
15142 @node Sound Services
15143 @subsection Sound Services
15144
15145 @cindex sound support
15146 @cindex ALSA
15147 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
15148
15149 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
15150 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
15151 preferred ALSA output driver.
15152
15153 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
15154 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
15155 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
15156 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
15157 record as in this example:
15158
15159 @example
15160 (service alsa-service-type)
15161 @end example
15162
15163 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
15164 @end deffn
15165
15166 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
15167 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
15168
15169 @table @asis
15170 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
15171 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
15172
15173 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
15174 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
15175 @uref{http://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
15176
15177 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
15178 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
15179 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
15180
15181 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
15182 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
15183
15184 @end table
15185 @end deftp
15186
15187 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
15188 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
15189
15190 @example
15191 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
15192 pcm_type.jack @{
15193 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
15194 @}
15195
15196 # Routing ALSA to jack:
15197 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
15198 pcm.rawjack @{
15199 type jack
15200 playback_ports @{
15201 0 system:playback_1
15202 1 system:playback_2
15203 @}
15204
15205 capture_ports @{
15206 0 system:capture_1
15207 1 system:capture_2
15208 @}
15209 @}
15210
15211 pcm.!default @{
15212 type plug
15213 slave @{
15214 pcm "rawjack"
15215 @}
15216 @}
15217 @end example
15218
15219 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
15220 details.
15221
15222
15223 @node Database Services
15224 @subsection Database Services
15225
15226 @cindex database
15227 @cindex SQL
15228 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
15229
15230 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
15231 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
15232 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8''] [#:extension-packages '()]
15233 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
15234 server.
15235
15236 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
15237 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
15238 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
15239
15240 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
15241 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
15242 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
15243 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
15244 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
15245
15246 @cindex postgis
15247 @example
15248 (use-package-modules databases geo)
15249
15250 (operating-system
15251 ...
15252 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
15253 ;; proper operation.
15254 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
15255 (services
15256 (cons*
15257 (postgresql-service #:extension-packages (list postgis))
15258 %base-services)))
15259 @end example
15260
15261 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
15262 database in this way:
15263
15264 @example
15265 psql -U postgres
15266 > create database postgistest;
15267 > \connect postgistest;
15268 > create extension postgis;
15269 > create extension postgis_topology;
15270 @end example
15271
15272 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
15273 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
15274 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
15275 @end deffn
15276
15277 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
15278 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
15279 database server.
15280
15281 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
15282 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
15283 @end deffn
15284
15285 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
15286 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
15287
15288 @table @asis
15289 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
15290 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
15291 or @var{mysql}.
15292
15293 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
15294 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
15295
15296 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
15297 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
15298 @end table
15299 @end deftp
15300
15301 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
15302 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
15303 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
15304 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
15305 @end defvr
15306
15307 @example
15308 (service memcached-service-type)
15309 @end example
15310
15311 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
15312 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
15313
15314 @table @asis
15315 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
15316 The Memcached package to use.
15317
15318 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
15319 Network interfaces on which to listen.
15320
15321 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
15322 Port on which to accept connections on,
15323
15324 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
15325 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
15326 listening on a UDP socket.
15327
15328 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
15329 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
15330 @end table
15331 @end deftp
15332
15333 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
15334 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
15335 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
15336 @end defvr
15337
15338 @example
15339 (service mongodb-service-type)
15340 @end example
15341
15342 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
15343 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
15344
15345 @table @asis
15346 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
15347 The MongoDB package to use.
15348
15349 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
15350 The configuration file for MongoDB.
15351
15352 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
15353 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
15354 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
15355 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
15356 @end table
15357 @end deftp
15358
15359 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
15360 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
15361 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
15362 @end defvr
15363
15364 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
15365 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
15366
15367 @table @asis
15368 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
15369 The Redis package to use.
15370
15371 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
15372 Network interface on which to listen.
15373
15374 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
15375 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
15376 listening on a TCP socket.
15377
15378 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
15379 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
15380 @end table
15381 @end deftp
15382
15383 @node Mail Services
15384 @subsection Mail Services
15385
15386 @cindex mail
15387 @cindex email
15388 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
15389 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
15390 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
15391 in the subsections below.
15392
15393 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
15394
15395 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
15396 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
15397 @end deffn
15398
15399 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
15400 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
15401 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
15402 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
15403 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
15404 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
15405 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
15406 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
15407
15408 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
15409 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
15410
15411 @example
15412 (dovecot-service #:config
15413 (dovecot-configuration
15414 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
15415 @end example
15416
15417 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
15418 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
15419 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
15420 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
15421 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
15422 from some other system; see the end for more details.
15423
15424 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
15425 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
15426 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
15427 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
15428 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
15429 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
15430 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
15431
15432 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
15433
15434 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
15435 The dovecot package.
15436 @end deftypevr
15437
15438 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
15439 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
15440 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
15441 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
15442 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
15443 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
15444 @end deftypevr
15445
15446 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
15447 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
15448 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
15449
15450 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
15451
15452 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
15453 The name of the protocol.
15454 @end deftypevr
15455
15456 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
15457 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
15458 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
15459 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
15460 @end deftypevr
15461
15462 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
15463 Space separated list of plugins to load.
15464 @end deftypevr
15465
15466 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
15467 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
15468 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
15469 Defaults to @samp{10}.
15470 @end deftypevr
15471
15472 @end deftypevr
15473
15474 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
15475 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
15476 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
15477 @samp{lmtp}.
15478
15479 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
15480
15481 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
15482 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
15483 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
15484 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
15485 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
15486 @end deftypevr
15487
15488 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
15489 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
15490 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
15491 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
15492 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15493
15494 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
15495
15496 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
15497 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
15498 the section name.
15499 @end deftypevr
15500
15501 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
15502 The access mode for the socket.
15503 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
15504 @end deftypevr
15505
15506 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
15507 The user to own the socket.
15508 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15509 @end deftypevr
15510
15511 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
15512 The group to own the socket.
15513 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15514 @end deftypevr
15515
15516
15517 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
15518
15519 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
15520 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
15521 the section name.
15522 @end deftypevr
15523
15524 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
15525 The access mode for the socket.
15526 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
15527 @end deftypevr
15528
15529 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
15530 The user to own the socket.
15531 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15532 @end deftypevr
15533
15534 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
15535 The group to own the socket.
15536 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15537 @end deftypevr
15538
15539
15540 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
15541
15542 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
15543 The protocol to listen for.
15544 @end deftypevr
15545
15546 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
15547 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
15548 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15549 @end deftypevr
15550
15551 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
15552 The port on which to listen.
15553 @end deftypevr
15554
15555 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
15556 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
15557 @samp{required}.
15558 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15559 @end deftypevr
15560
15561 @end deftypevr
15562
15563 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
15564 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
15565 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
15566 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
15567 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
15568
15569 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15570
15571 @end deftypevr
15572
15573 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
15574 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
15575 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
15576 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
15577 Defaults to @samp{1}.
15578
15579 @end deftypevr
15580
15581 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
15582 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
15583 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
15584
15585 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15586
15587 @end deftypevr
15588
15589 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
15590 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
15591 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15592 @end deftypevr
15593
15594 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
15595 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
15596 this.
15597 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
15598 @end deftypevr
15599
15600 @end deftypevr
15601
15602 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
15603 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
15604 constructor.
15605
15606 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
15607
15608 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
15609 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
15610 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15611 @end deftypevr
15612
15613 @end deftypevr
15614
15615 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
15616 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
15617 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
15618
15619 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
15620
15621 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
15622 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
15623 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
15624 @samp{static}.
15625 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
15626 @end deftypevr
15627
15628 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
15629 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
15630 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15631 @end deftypevr
15632
15633 @end deftypevr
15634
15635 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
15636 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
15637 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
15638
15639 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
15640
15641 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
15642 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
15643 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
15644 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
15645 @end deftypevr
15646
15647 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
15648 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
15649 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15650 @end deftypevr
15651
15652 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
15653 Override fields from passwd.
15654 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15655 @end deftypevr
15656
15657 @end deftypevr
15658
15659 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
15660 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
15661 constructor.
15662 @end deftypevr
15663
15664 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
15665 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
15666 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
15667
15668 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
15669
15670 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
15671 Name for this namespace.
15672 @end deftypevr
15673
15674 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
15675 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
15676 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
15677 @end deftypevr
15678
15679 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
15680 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
15681 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
15682 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
15683 format.
15684 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15685 @end deftypevr
15686
15687 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
15688 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
15689 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
15690 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15691 @end deftypevr
15692
15693 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
15694 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
15695 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
15696 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15697 @end deftypevr
15698
15699 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
15700 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
15701 namespace has it.
15702 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15703 @end deftypevr
15704
15705 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
15706 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
15707 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
15708 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
15709 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
15710 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
15711 and @samp{mail/}.
15712 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15713 @end deftypevr
15714
15715 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
15716 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
15717 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
15718 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
15719 hides the namespace prefix.
15720 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15721 @end deftypevr
15722
15723 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
15724 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
15725 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
15726 as @code{#t}).
15727 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15728 @end deftypevr
15729
15730 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
15731 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
15732 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15733
15734 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
15735
15736 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
15737 Name for this mailbox.
15738 @end deftypevr
15739
15740 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
15741 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
15742 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
15743 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
15744 @end deftypevr
15745
15746 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
15747 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
15748 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
15749 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
15750 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15751 @end deftypevr
15752
15753 @end deftypevr
15754
15755 @end deftypevr
15756
15757 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
15758 Base directory where to store runtime data.
15759 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
15760 @end deftypevr
15761
15762 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
15763 Greeting message for clients.
15764 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
15765 @end deftypevr
15766
15767 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
15768 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
15769 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
15770 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
15771 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
15772 here.
15773 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15774 @end deftypevr
15775
15776 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
15777 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
15778 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15779 @end deftypevr
15780
15781 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
15782 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
15783 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
15784 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
15785 accounts).
15786 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15787 @end deftypevr
15788
15789 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
15790 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
15791 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
15792 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
15793 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
15794 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15795 @end deftypevr
15796
15797 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
15798 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
15799 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
15800 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15801 @end deftypevr
15802
15803 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
15804 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
15805 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
15806 @end deftypevr
15807
15808 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
15809 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
15810 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
15811 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
15812 @end deftypevr
15813
15814 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
15815 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
15816 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
15817 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
15818 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
15819 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
15820 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15821 @end deftypevr
15822
15823 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
15824 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
15825 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
15826 for caching to be used.
15827 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15828 @end deftypevr
15829
15830 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
15831 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
15832 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
15833 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
15834 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
15835 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
15836 authentication.
15837 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
15838 @end deftypevr
15839
15840 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
15841 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
15842 0 disables caching them completely.
15843 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
15844 @end deftypevr
15845
15846 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
15847 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
15848 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
15849 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
15850 realm first.
15851 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15852 @end deftypevr
15853
15854 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
15855 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
15856 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
15857 logins.
15858 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15859 @end deftypevr
15860
15861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
15862 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
15863 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
15864 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
15865 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
15866 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
15867 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
15868 @end deftypevr
15869
15870 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
15871 Username character translations before it's looked up from
15872 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
15873 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
15874 translated to @samp{@@}.
15875 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15876 @end deftypevr
15877
15878 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
15879 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
15880 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
15881 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
15882 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
15883 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
15884 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
15885 @end deftypevr
15886
15887 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
15888 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
15889 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
15890 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
15891 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
15892 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
15893 choice.
15894 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15895 @end deftypevr
15896
15897 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
15898 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
15899 mechanism.
15900 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
15901 @end deftypevr
15902
15903 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
15904 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
15905 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
15906 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
15907 Defaults to @samp{30}.
15908 @end deftypevr
15909
15910 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
15911 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
15912 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
15913 allow all keytab entries.
15914 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15915 @end deftypevr
15916
15917 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
15918 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
15919 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
15920 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
15921 file.
15922 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15923 @end deftypevr
15924
15925 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
15926 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
15927 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
15928 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
15929 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15930 @end deftypevr
15931
15932 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
15933 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
15934 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
15935 @end deftypevr
15936
15937 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
15938 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
15939 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
15940 @end deftypevr
15941
15942 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
15943 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
15944 fails.
15945 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15946 @end deftypevr
15947
15948 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
15949 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
15950 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
15951 CommonName.
15952 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15953 @end deftypevr
15954
15955 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
15956 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
15957 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
15958 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
15959 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
15960 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
15961 @end deftypevr
15962
15963 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
15964 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
15965 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
15966 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
15967 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15968 @end deftypevr
15969
15970 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
15971 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
15972 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
15973 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15974 @end deftypevr
15975
15976 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
15977 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
15978 has any connections.
15979 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
15980 @end deftypevr
15981
15982 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
15983 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
15984 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
15985 are shared within domain.
15986 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
15987 @end deftypevr
15988
15989 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
15990 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
15991 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
15992 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
15993 @end deftypevr
15994
15995 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
15996 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
15997 @samp{log-path}.
15998 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15999 @end deftypevr
16000
16001 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
16002 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
16003 @samp{info-log-path}.
16004 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16005 @end deftypevr
16006
16007 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
16008 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
16009 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
16010 standard facilities are supported.
16011 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
16012 @end deftypevr
16013
16014 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
16015 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
16016 failed.
16017 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16018 @end deftypevr
16019
16020 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
16021 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
16022 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
16023 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
16024 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
16025 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
16026 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16027 @end deftypevr
16028
16029 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
16030 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
16031 SQL queries.
16032 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16033 @end deftypevr
16034
16035 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
16036 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
16037 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
16038 @samp{auth-debug}.
16039 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16040 @end deftypevr
16041
16042 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
16043 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
16044 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
16045 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16046 @end deftypevr
16047
16048 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
16049 Show protocol level SSL errors.
16050 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16051 @end deftypevr
16052
16053 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
16054 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
16055 strftime(3) format.
16056 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
16057 @end deftypevr
16058
16059 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
16060 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
16061 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
16062 string.
16063 @end deftypevr
16064
16065 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
16066 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
16067 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
16068 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
16069 @end deftypevr
16070
16071 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
16072 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
16073 of possible variables you can use.
16074 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
16075 @end deftypevr
16076
16077 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
16078 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
16079 @table @code
16080 @item %$
16081 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
16082 @item %m
16083 Message-ID
16084 @item %s
16085 Subject
16086 @item %f
16087 From address
16088 @item %p
16089 Physical size
16090 @item %w
16091 Virtual size.
16092 @end table
16093 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
16094 @end deftypevr
16095
16096 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
16097 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
16098 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
16099 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
16100 Dovecot the full location.
16101
16102 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
16103 file (e.g.@: /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
16104 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
16105 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
16106 @samp{mail-location} setting.
16107
16108 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
16109
16110 @table @samp
16111 @item %u
16112 username
16113 @item %n
16114 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
16115 @item %d
16116 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
16117 @item %h
16118 home director
16119 @end table
16120
16121 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
16122 @table @samp
16123 @item maildir:~/Maildir
16124 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
16125 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
16126 @end table
16127 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16128 @end deftypevr
16129
16130 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
16131 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
16132 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
16133 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
16134 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16135 @end deftypevr
16136
16137 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
16138
16139 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16140 @end deftypevr
16141
16142 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
16143 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
16144 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
16145 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
16146 /var/mail.
16147 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16148 @end deftypevr
16149
16150 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
16151 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
16152 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
16153 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
16154 symlinks (e.g.@: if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
16155 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
16156 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
16157 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16158 @end deftypevr
16159
16160 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
16161 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
16162 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
16163 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
16164 names with e.g.@: /path/ or ~user/.
16165 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16166 @end deftypevr
16167
16168 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
16169 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
16170 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
16171 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16172 @end deftypevr
16173
16174 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
16175 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
16176 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
16177 nowadays by default.
16178 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16179 @end deftypevr
16180
16181 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
16182 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
16183 @table @code
16184 @item optimized
16185 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
16186 @item always
16187 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when write()s are delayed
16188 @item never
16189 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
16190 @end table
16191 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
16192 @end deftypevr
16193
16194 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
16195 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
16196 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
16197 this isn't needed.
16198 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16199 @end deftypevr
16200
16201 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
16202 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
16203 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
16204 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16205 @end deftypevr
16206
16207 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
16208 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
16209 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
16210 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
16211 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
16212 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
16213 @end deftypevr
16214
16215 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
16216 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
16217 kB.
16218 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
16219 @end deftypevr
16220
16221 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
16222 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
16223 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
16224 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
16225 is set to 0.
16226 Defaults to @samp{500}.
16227 @end deftypevr
16228
16229 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
16230
16231 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16232 @end deftypevr
16233
16234 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
16235 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
16236 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
16237 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
16238 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16239 @end deftypevr
16240
16241 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
16242
16243 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16244 @end deftypevr
16245
16246 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
16247 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
16248 trying to create new keywords.
16249 Defaults to @samp{50}.
16250 @end deftypevr
16251
16252 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
16253 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
16254 processes (i.e.@: /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
16255 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
16256 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
16257 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
16258 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
16259 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
16260 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
16261 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16262 @end deftypevr
16263
16264 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
16265 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
16266 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
16267 directory (e.g.@: /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
16268 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
16269 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
16270 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/."@: to
16271 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
16272 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16273 @end deftypevr
16274
16275 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
16276 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
16277 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
16278 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
16279 @end deftypevr
16280
16281 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
16282 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
16283 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
16284 @end deftypevr
16285
16286 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
16287 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
16288 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
16289 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16290 @end deftypevr
16291
16292 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
16293 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
16294 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
16295 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
16296 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16297 @end deftypevr
16298
16299 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
16300 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
16301 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
16302 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
16303 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
16304 occur.
16305 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
16306 @end deftypevr
16307
16308 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
16309 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
16310 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
16311 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
16312 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
16313 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
16314 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16315 @end deftypevr
16316
16317 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
16318 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
16319 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
16320 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
16321 causes more disk I/O.
16322 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
16323 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
16324 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16325 @end deftypevr
16326
16327 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
16328 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
16329 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
16330 side effects.
16331 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16332 @end deftypevr
16333
16334 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
16335 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
16336 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
16337 the mail otherwise.
16338 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16339 @end deftypevr
16340
16341 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
16342 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
16343 available:
16344
16345 @table @code
16346 @item dotlock
16347 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
16348 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
16349 need write access to that directory.
16350 @item dotlock-try
16351 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
16352 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
16353 @item fcntl
16354 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
16355 @item flock
16356 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
16357 @item lockf
16358 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
16359 @end table
16360
16361 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
16362 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
16363 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
16364 them simultaneously.
16365 @end deftypevr
16366
16367 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
16368
16369 @end deftypevr
16370
16371 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
16372 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
16373 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
16374 @end deftypevr
16375
16376 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
16377 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
16378 override the lock file after this much time.
16379 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
16380 @end deftypevr
16381
16382 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
16383 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
16384 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
16385 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
16386 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
16387 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
16388 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
16389 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
16390 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
16391 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
16392 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16393 @end deftypevr
16394
16395 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
16396 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
16397 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
16398 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
16399 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16400 @end deftypevr
16401
16402 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
16403 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
16404 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
16405 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
16406 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
16407 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16408 @end deftypevr
16409
16410 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
16411 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
16412 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
16413 updated.
16414 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16415 @end deftypevr
16416
16417 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
16418 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
16419 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
16420 @end deftypevr
16421
16422 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
16423 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
16424 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
16425 disabled.
16426 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
16427 @end deftypevr
16428
16429 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
16430 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
16431 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
16432 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
16433 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16434 @end deftypevr
16435
16436 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
16437 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
16438 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
16439 don't support this for now.
16440
16441 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
16442
16443 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
16444 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16445 @end deftypevr
16446
16447 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
16448 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
16449 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
16450 externally.
16451 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
16452 @end deftypevr
16453
16454 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
16455 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
16456 @table @code
16457 @item posix
16458 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
16459 @item sis posix
16460 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
16461 @item sis-queue posix
16462 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
16463 @end table
16464 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
16465 @end deftypevr
16466
16467 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
16468 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
16469 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
16470 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
16471 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
16472 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
16473 @end deftypevr
16474
16475 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
16476
16477 Defaults to @samp{100}.
16478 @end deftypevr
16479
16480 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
16481
16482 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
16483 @end deftypevr
16484
16485 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
16486 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
16487 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
16488 before they eat up everything.
16489 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
16490 @end deftypevr
16491
16492 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
16493 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
16494 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
16495 at all.
16496 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
16497 @end deftypevr
16498
16499 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
16500 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
16501 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
16502 processes.
16503 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
16504 @end deftypevr
16505
16506 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
16507 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
16508 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
16509 @end deftypevr
16510
16511 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
16512 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
16513 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
16514 @end deftypevr
16515
16516 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
16517 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
16518 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
16519 root.
16520 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
16521 @end deftypevr
16522
16523 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
16524 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
16525 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
16526 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
16527 instead to a different.
16528 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16529 @end deftypevr
16530
16531 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
16532 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
16533 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
16534 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
16535 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
16536 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16537 @end deftypevr
16538
16539 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
16540 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
16541 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16542 @end deftypevr
16543
16544 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
16545 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
16546 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
16547 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16548 @end deftypevr
16549
16550 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
16551 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
16552 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
16553 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
16554 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
16555 @end deftypevr
16556
16557 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
16558 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
16559 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
16560 @end deftypevr
16561
16562 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
16563 SSL ciphers to use.
16564 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
16565 @end deftypevr
16566
16567 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
16568 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
16569 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16570 @end deftypevr
16571
16572 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
16573 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
16574 %d expands to recipient domain.
16575 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
16576 @end deftypevr
16577
16578 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
16579 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
16580 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
16581 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16582 @end deftypevr
16583
16584 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
16585 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
16586 bouncing the mail.
16587 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16588 @end deftypevr
16589
16590 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
16591 Binary to use for sending mails.
16592 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
16593 @end deftypevr
16594
16595 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
16596 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
16597 sendmail.
16598 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16599 @end deftypevr
16600
16601 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
16602 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
16603 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
16604 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
16605 @end deftypevr
16606
16607 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
16608 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
16609 variables:
16610
16611 @table @code
16612 @item %n
16613 CRLF
16614 @item %r
16615 reason
16616 @item %s
16617 original subject
16618 @item %t
16619 recipient
16620 @end table
16621 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
16622 @end deftypevr
16623
16624 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
16625 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
16626 address.
16627 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
16628 @end deftypevr
16629
16630 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
16631 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
16632 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
16633 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
16634 X-Original-To.
16635 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16636 @end deftypevr
16637
16638 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
16639 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
16640 it?.
16641 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16642 @end deftypevr
16643
16644 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
16645 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
16646 subscribed?.
16647 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16648 @end deftypevr
16649
16650 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
16651 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
16652 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
16653 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
16654 often.
16655 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
16656 @end deftypevr
16657
16658 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
16659 IMAP logout format string:
16660 @table @code
16661 @item %i
16662 total number of bytes read from client
16663 @item %o
16664 total number of bytes sent to client.
16665 @end table
16666 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
16667 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
16668 @end deftypevr
16669
16670 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
16671 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
16672 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
16673 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16674 @end deftypevr
16675
16676 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
16677 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
16678 is IDLEing.
16679 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
16680 @end deftypevr
16681
16682 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
16683 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
16684 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
16685 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
16686 support-email.
16687 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16688 @end deftypevr
16689
16690 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
16691 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
16692 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16693 @end deftypevr
16694
16695 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
16696 Workarounds for various client bugs:
16697
16698 @table @code
16699 @item delay-newmail
16700 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
16701 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
16702 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
16703 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
16704 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
16705 "Headers Only".
16706
16707 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
16708 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
16709 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
16710 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
16711
16712 @item tb-lsub-flags
16713 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
16714 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
16715 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
16716 @end table
16717 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16718 @end deftypevr
16719
16720 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
16721 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
16722 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16723 @end deftypevr
16724
16725
16726 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
16727 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
16728 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
16729 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
16730 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
16731
16732 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
16733 and running. In that case, you can pass an
16734 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
16735 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
16736 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
16737
16738 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
16739
16740 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
16741 The dovecot package.
16742 @end deftypevr
16743
16744 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
16745 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
16746 @end deftypevr
16747
16748 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
16749 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
16750
16751 @example
16752 (dovecot-service #:config
16753 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
16754 (string "")))
16755 @end example
16756
16757 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
16758
16759 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
16760 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
16761 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
16762 as in this example:
16763
16764 @example
16765 (service opensmtpd-service-type
16766 (opensmtpd-configuration
16767 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
16768 @end example
16769 @end deffn
16770
16771 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
16772 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
16773
16774 @table @asis
16775 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
16776 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
16777
16778 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
16779 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
16780 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
16781 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
16782 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
16783
16784 @end table
16785 @end deftp
16786
16787 @subsubheading Exim Service
16788
16789 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
16790 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
16791 @cindex SMTP
16792
16793 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
16794 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
16795 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
16796 as in this example:
16797
16798 @example
16799 (service exim-service-type
16800 (exim-configuration
16801 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
16802 @end example
16803 @end deffn
16804
16805 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
16806 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
16807 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
16808
16809 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
16810 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
16811
16812 @table @asis
16813 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
16814 Package object of the Exim server.
16815
16816 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
16817 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
16818 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
16819 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
16820 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
16821 variables.
16822
16823 @end table
16824 @end deftp
16825
16826 @subsubheading Getmail service
16827
16828 @cindex IMAP
16829 @cindex POP
16830
16831 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
16832 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
16833 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
16834 @end deffn
16835
16836 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
16837
16838 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
16839 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
16840
16841 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
16842
16843 @end deftypevr
16844
16845 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
16846 The getmail package to use.
16847
16848 @end deftypevr
16849
16850 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
16851 The user to run getmail as.
16852
16853 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
16854
16855 @end deftypevr
16856
16857 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
16858 The group to run getmail as.
16859
16860 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
16861
16862 @end deftypevr
16863
16864 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
16865 The getmail directory to use.
16866
16867 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
16868
16869 @end deftypevr
16870
16871 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
16872 The getmail configuration file to use.
16873
16874 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
16875
16876 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
16877 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
16878
16879 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
16880
16881 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
16882 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
16883 and @samp{static}.
16884
16885 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
16886
16887 @end deftypevr
16888
16889 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
16890 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16891
16892 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
16893
16894 @end deftypevr
16895
16896 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
16897 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16898
16899 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
16900
16901 @end deftypevr
16902
16903 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
16904 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
16905
16906 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16907
16908 @end deftypevr
16909
16910 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
16911 Override fields from passwd.
16912
16913 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16914
16915 @end deftypevr
16916
16917 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
16918 Override fields from passwd.
16919
16920 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16921
16922 @end deftypevr
16923
16924 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
16925 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation
16926
16927 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16928
16929 @end deftypevr
16930
16931 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
16932 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation
16933
16934 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16935
16936 @end deftypevr
16937
16938 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
16939 CA certificates to use
16940
16941 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16942
16943 @end deftypevr
16944
16945 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
16946 Extra retriever parameters
16947
16948 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16949
16950 @end deftypevr
16951
16952 @end deftypevr
16953
16954 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
16955 What to do with retrieved messages.
16956
16957 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
16958
16959 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
16960 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
16961 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
16962
16963 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
16964
16965 @end deftypevr
16966
16967 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
16968 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
16969 chosen type.
16970
16971 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16972
16973 @end deftypevr
16974
16975 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
16976 Extra destination parameters
16977
16978 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16979
16980 @end deftypevr
16981
16982 @end deftypevr
16983
16984 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
16985 Configure getmail.
16986
16987 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
16988
16989 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
16990 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
16991 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
16992 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
16993 about each of it's actions.
16994
16995 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16996
16997 @end deftypevr
16998
16999 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
17000 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
17001 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
17002
17003 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17004
17005 @end deftypevr
17006
17007 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
17008 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
17009 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
17010 be left on the server.
17011
17012 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17013
17014 @end deftypevr
17015
17016 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
17017 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
17018 they have not been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
17019 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
17020 disabled this feature.
17021
17022 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17023
17024 @end deftypevr
17025
17026 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
17027 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
17028 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
17029 disables this feature.
17030
17031 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17032
17033 @end deftypevr
17034
17035 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
17036 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
17037 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
17038
17039 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17040
17041 @end deftypevr
17042
17043 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
17044 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
17045 @samp{0} disables this feature.
17046
17047 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17048
17049 @end deftypevr
17050
17051 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
17052 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
17053
17054 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17055
17056 @end deftypevr
17057
17058 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
17059 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
17060
17061 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17062
17063 @end deftypevr
17064
17065 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
17066 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
17067 @samp{""} disables this feature.
17068
17069 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17070
17071 @end deftypevr
17072
17073 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
17074 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
17075 logger.
17076
17077 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17078
17079 @end deftypevr
17080
17081 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
17082 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
17083 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
17084 information lines.
17085
17086 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17087
17088 @end deftypevr
17089
17090 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17091 Extra options to include.
17092
17093 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17094
17095 @end deftypevr
17096
17097 @end deftypevr
17098
17099 @end deftypevr
17100
17101 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
17102 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
17103 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
17104 extension.
17105
17106 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17107
17108 @end deftypevr
17109
17110 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
17111 Environment variables to set for getmail.
17112
17113 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17114
17115 @end deftypevr
17116
17117 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
17118
17119 @cindex email aliases
17120 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
17121
17122 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
17123 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
17124 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
17125
17126 @example
17127 (service mail-aliases-service-type
17128 '(("postmaster" "bob")
17129 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
17130 @end example
17131 @end deffn
17132
17133 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
17134 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
17135 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
17136 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
17137 where to deliver this user's mail.
17138
17139 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
17140 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
17141 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
17142 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
17143 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
17144
17145 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17146 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17147
17148 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
17149 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
17150 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
17151 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
17152
17153 @example
17154 (service imap4d-service-type
17155 (imap4d-configuration
17156 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
17157 @end example
17158 @end deffn
17159
17160 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
17161 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
17162
17163 @table @asis
17164 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
17165 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
17166
17167 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
17168 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
17169 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
17170 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
17171
17172 @end table
17173 @end deftp
17174
17175 @node Messaging Services
17176 @subsection Messaging Services
17177
17178 @cindex messaging
17179 @cindex jabber
17180 @cindex XMPP
17181 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
17182 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
17183
17184 @subsubheading Prosody Service
17185
17186 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
17187 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
17188 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
17189 record as in this example:
17190
17191 @example
17192 (service prosody-service-type
17193 (prosody-configuration
17194 (modules-enabled (cons "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
17195 (int-components
17196 (list
17197 (int-component-configuration
17198 (hostname "conference.example.net")
17199 (plugin "muc")
17200 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
17201 (virtualhosts
17202 (list
17203 (virtualhost-configuration
17204 (domain "example.net"))))))
17205 @end example
17206
17207 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
17208
17209 @end deffn
17210
17211 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
17212 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
17213 Prosody to serve.
17214
17215 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
17216 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
17217
17218 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
17219 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
17220 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
17221
17222 @example
17223 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
17224 @end example
17225
17226 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
17227 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
17228 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
17229 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
17230 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
17231
17232 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
17233 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
17234 some other system; see the end for more details.
17235
17236 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
17237 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
17238
17239 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
17240 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
17241 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
17242 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
17243 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
17244 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
17245 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
17246
17247 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
17248
17249 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
17250 The Prosody package.
17251 @end deftypevr
17252
17253 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
17254 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
17255 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
17256 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
17257 @end deftypevr
17258
17259 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
17260 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
17261 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
17262 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17263 @end deftypevr
17264
17265 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
17266 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
17267 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
17268 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
17269 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
17270 @end deftypevr
17271
17272 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
17273 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
17274 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
17275 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
17276 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
17277 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17278 @end deftypevr
17279
17280 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
17281 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
17282 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
17283 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17284 @end deftypevr
17285
17286 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
17287 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
17288 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
17289 Documentation on modules can be found at:
17290 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
17291 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
17292 @end deftypevr
17293
17294 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
17295 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
17296 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
17297 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17298 @end deftypevr
17299
17300 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
17301 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
17302 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
17303 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
17304 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
17305 @end deftypevr
17306
17307 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
17308 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
17309 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
17310 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17311 @end deftypevr
17312
17313 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
17314 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
17315 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
17316 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
17317 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
17318
17319 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
17320
17321 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
17322 This determines what handshake to use.
17323 @end deftypevr
17324
17325 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
17326 Path to your private key file.
17327 @end deftypevr
17328
17329 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
17330 Path to your certificate file.
17331 @end deftypevr
17332
17333 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
17334 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
17335 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
17336 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
17337 @end deftypevr
17338
17339 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
17340 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
17341 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
17342 @end deftypevr
17343
17344 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
17345 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
17346 @code{set_verify()} flags).
17347 @end deftypevr
17348
17349 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
17350 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
17351 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
17352 LuaSec source.
17353 @end deftypevr
17354
17355 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
17356 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
17357 trusted root certificate.
17358 @end deftypevr
17359
17360 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
17361 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
17362 clients, and in what order.
17363 @end deftypevr
17364
17365 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
17366 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
17367 can create such a file with:
17368 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
17369 @end deftypevr
17370
17371 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
17372 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
17373 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
17374 @end deftypevr
17375
17376 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
17377 A list of "extra" verification options.
17378 @end deftypevr
17379
17380 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
17381 Password for encrypted private keys.
17382 @end deftypevr
17383
17384 @end deftypevr
17385
17386 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
17387 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
17388 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
17389 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17390 @end deftypevr
17391
17392 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
17393 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
17394 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
17395 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
17396 @end deftypevr
17397
17398 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
17399 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
17400 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
17401 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17402 @end deftypevr
17403
17404 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
17405 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
17406 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
17407 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
17408 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17409 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17410 @end deftypevr
17411
17412 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
17413 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
17414 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
17415 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
17416 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17417 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17418 @end deftypevr
17419
17420 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
17421 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
17422 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
17423 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17424 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17425 @end deftypevr
17426
17427 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
17428 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
17429 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
17430 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
17431 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
17432 about using the hashed backend. See also
17433 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
17434 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
17435 @end deftypevr
17436
17437 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
17438 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
17439 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
17440 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
17441 @end deftypevr
17442
17443 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
17444 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
17445 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
17446 @end deftypevr
17447
17448 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
17449 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
17450 @end deftypevr
17451
17452 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
17453 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
17454 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
17455 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
17456 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
17457 @end deftypevr
17458
17459 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
17460 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
17461 example if you want your users to have addresses like
17462 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
17463 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
17464
17465 Note: the name "virtual" host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
17466 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
17467 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
17468 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
17469 have just one VirtualHost entry.
17470
17471 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
17472
17473 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
17474
17475 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17476 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
17477 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
17478 @end deftypevr
17479
17480 @end deftypevr
17481
17482 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
17483 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
17484 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
17485 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
17486 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
17487
17488 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
17489 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
17490 to use for the component.
17491
17492 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
17493 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17494
17495 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
17496
17497 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17498 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17499 Hostname of the component.
17500 @end deftypevr
17501
17502 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
17503 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
17504 @end deftypevr
17505
17506 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
17507 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
17508 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
17509
17510 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
17511 in the "Chatrooms" documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
17512 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
17513
17514 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
17515
17516 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
17517
17518 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
17519 The name to return in service discovery responses.
17520 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
17521 @end deftypevr
17522
17523 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
17524 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
17525 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
17526 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
17527 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
17528 restricts to service administrators only.
17529 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17530 @end deftypevr
17531
17532 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
17533 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
17534 just joined the room.
17535 Defaults to @samp{20}.
17536 @end deftypevr
17537
17538 @end deftypevr
17539
17540 @end deftypevr
17541
17542 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
17543 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
17544 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
17545 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
17546 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17547
17548 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
17549
17550 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17551 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
17552 Password which the component will use to log in.
17553 @end deftypevr
17554
17555 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17556 Hostname of the component.
17557 @end deftypevr
17558
17559 @end deftypevr
17560
17561 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
17562 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
17563 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
17564 @end deftypevr
17565
17566 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
17567 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
17568 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
17569 @end deftypevr
17570
17571 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
17572 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
17573 @end deftypevr
17574
17575 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
17576 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
17577 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
17578 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
17579 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
17580 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
17581
17582 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
17583 The prosody package.
17584 @end deftypevr
17585
17586 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
17587 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
17588 @end deftypevr
17589
17590 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
17591 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
17592
17593 @example
17594 (service prosody-service-type
17595 (opaque-prosody-configuration
17596 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
17597 @end example
17598
17599 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
17600
17601 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
17602
17603 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
17604 @cindex IRC gateway
17605 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
17606 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
17607
17608 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
17609 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
17610 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
17611 below).
17612
17613 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
17614 services:
17615
17616 @example
17617 (service bitlbee-service-type)
17618 @end example
17619 @end defvr
17620
17621 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
17622 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
17623
17624 @table @asis
17625 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
17626 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
17627 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
17628 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
17629
17630 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
17631 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
17632 networking interface.
17633
17634 @item @code{package} (default: @code{bitlbee})
17635 The BitlBee package to use.
17636
17637 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
17638 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
17639
17640 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
17641 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
17642 @end table
17643 @end deftp
17644
17645 @subsubheading Quassel Service
17646
17647 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
17648 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
17649 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
17650 central core.
17651
17652 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
17653 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
17654 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
17655 (see below).
17656 @end defvr
17657
17658 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
17659 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
17660
17661 @table @asis
17662 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
17663 The Quassel package to use.
17664
17665 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
17666 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
17667 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
17668 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
17669 @var{port}.
17670
17671 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
17672 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
17673 and Error.
17674 @end table
17675 @end deftp
17676
17677 @node Telephony Services
17678 @subsection Telephony Services
17679
17680 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
17681 @cindex VoIP server
17682 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
17683 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
17684 (VoIP) suite.
17685
17686 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
17687 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
17688 look like this:
17689
17690 @example
17691 (service murmur-service-type
17692 (murmur-configuration
17693 (welcome-text
17694 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
17695 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
17696 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
17697 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
17698 @end example
17699
17700 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
17701 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
17702
17703 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
17704 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
17705 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
17706 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
17707 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
17708 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
17709 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
17710 rights and create some channels.
17711
17712 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
17713
17714 @table @asis
17715 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
17716 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
17717
17718 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
17719 User who will run the Murmur server.
17720
17721 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
17722 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
17723
17724 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
17725 Port on which the server will listen.
17726
17727 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
17728 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
17729
17730 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
17731 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
17732
17733 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
17734 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
17735
17736 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
17737 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
17738
17739 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
17740 File name of the sqlite database.
17741 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
17742
17743 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
17744 File name of the log file.
17745 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
17746
17747 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
17748 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
17749 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
17750
17751 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
17752 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
17753
17754 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
17755 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
17756 when violating the autoban limits.
17757
17758 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
17759 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
17760 before switching over to opus audio codec.
17761
17762 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
17763 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
17764
17765 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
17766 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
17767
17768 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
17769 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
17770
17771 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
17772 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
17773
17774 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
17775 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
17776
17777 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
17778 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
17779 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
17780
17781 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
17782 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
17783 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
17784
17785 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
17786 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
17787
17788 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
17789 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
17790 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
17791 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
17792
17793 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
17794
17795 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
17796 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
17797
17798 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
17799 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
17800
17801 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
17802 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
17803 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
17804 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
17805
17806 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
17807 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
17808
17809 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
17810 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
17811
17812 @example
17813 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
17814 @end example
17815 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
17816 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
17817 @example
17818 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
17819 @end example
17820
17821 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
17822 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
17823 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
17824 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
17825 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
17826
17827 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
17828 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
17829 in SSL/TLS.
17830
17831 This option is specified using
17832 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
17833 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
17834
17835 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
17836 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
17837 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
17838 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
17839
17840 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
17841 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
17842 to connect to it.
17843
17844 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
17845 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
17846
17847 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
17848 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
17849 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
17850 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
17851
17852 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
17853
17854 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
17855 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
17856 @end table
17857 @end deftp
17858
17859 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
17860 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
17861
17862 @table @asis
17863 @item @code{name}
17864 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
17865
17866 @item @code{password}
17867 A password to identify your registration.
17868 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
17869
17870 @item @code{url}
17871 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
17872 site.
17873
17874 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
17875 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
17876 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
17877 @end table
17878 @end deftp
17879
17880
17881
17882 @node Monitoring Services
17883 @subsection Monitoring Services
17884
17885 @subsubheading Tailon Service
17886
17887 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
17888 viewing and searching log files.
17889
17890 The following example will configure the service with default values.
17891 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
17892
17893 @example
17894 (service tailon-service-type)
17895 @end example
17896
17897 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
17898 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
17899
17900 @example
17901 (service tailon-service-type
17902 (tailon-configuration
17903 (config-file
17904 (tailon-configuration-file
17905 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
17906 @end example
17907
17908
17909 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
17910 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
17911 This type has the following parameters:
17912
17913 @table @asis
17914 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
17915 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
17916 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
17917 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
17918
17919 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
17920 can be used:
17921
17922 @example
17923 (service tailon-service-type
17924 (tailon-configuration
17925 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
17926 @end example
17927
17928 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
17929 The tailon package to use.
17930
17931 @end table
17932 @end deftp
17933
17934 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
17935 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
17936 This type has the following parameters:
17937
17938 @table @asis
17939 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
17940 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
17941 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
17942 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
17943 subsection.
17944
17945 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
17946 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
17947
17948 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
17949 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
17950
17951 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
17952 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
17953
17954 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
17955 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
17956
17957 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
17958 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
17959
17960 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
17961 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
17962
17963 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
17964 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
17965
17966 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
17967 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
17968 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
17969 wrap lines.
17970
17971 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
17972 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
17973 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
17974 @code{"basic"}.
17975
17976 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
17977 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
17978 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
17979 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
17980 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
17981
17982 @example
17983 (tailon-configuration-file
17984 (http-auth "basic")
17985 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
17986 ("user2" . "password2"))))
17987 @end example
17988
17989 @end table
17990 @end deftp
17991
17992
17993 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
17994 @cindex darkstat
17995 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
17996 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
17997
17998 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
17999 This is the service type for the
18000 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
18001 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
18002 this example:
18003
18004 @example
18005 (service darkstat-service-type
18006 (darkstat-configuration
18007 (interface "eno1")))
18008 @end example
18009 @end defvar
18010
18011 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
18012 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
18013
18014 @table @asis
18015 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
18016 The darkstat package to use.
18017
18018 @item @code{interface}
18019 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
18020
18021 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
18022 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
18023
18024 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18025 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18026
18027 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
18028 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
18029 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
18030
18031 @end table
18032 @end deftp
18033
18034 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
18035
18036 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
18037 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
18038 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
18039 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
18040 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
18041
18042 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18043 This is the service type for the
18044 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
18045 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}
18046 record as in this example:
18047
18048 @example
18049 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18050 (prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18051 (web-listen-address ":9100")))
18052 @end example
18053 @end defvar
18054
18055 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18056 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
18057
18058 @table @asis
18059 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
18060 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
18061
18062 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
18063 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18064
18065 @end table
18066 @end deftp
18067
18068 @subsubheading Zabbix server
18069 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
18070 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
18071 and disk space consumption:
18072
18073 @itemize
18074 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
18075 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
18076 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
18077 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
18078 @item Native high performance agents.
18079 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
18080 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
18081 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
18082 @end itemize
18083
18084 @c %start of fragment
18085
18086 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
18087
18088 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
18089 The zabbix-server package.
18090
18091 @end deftypevr
18092
18093 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
18094 User who will run the Zabbix server.
18095
18096 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18097
18098 @end deftypevr
18099
18100 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
18101 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
18102
18103 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18104
18105 @end deftypevr
18106
18107 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
18108 Database host name.
18109
18110 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
18111
18112 @end deftypevr
18113
18114 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
18115 Database name.
18116
18117 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18118
18119 @end deftypevr
18120
18121 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
18122 Database user.
18123
18124 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18125
18126 @end deftypevr
18127
18128 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
18129 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
18130 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
18131
18132 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18133
18134 @end deftypevr
18135
18136 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
18137 Database port.
18138
18139 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
18140
18141 @end deftypevr
18142
18143 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18144 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18145
18146 @itemize @bullet
18147 @item
18148 @code{system} - syslog.
18149
18150 @item
18151 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
18152
18153 @item
18154 @code{console} - standard output.
18155
18156 @end itemize
18157
18158 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18159
18160 @end deftypevr
18161
18162 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
18163 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
18164
18165 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
18166
18167 @end deftypevr
18168
18169 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
18170 Name of PID file.
18171
18172 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
18173
18174 @end deftypevr
18175
18176 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
18177 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
18178 certificate verification.
18179
18180 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
18181
18182 @end deftypevr
18183
18184 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
18185 Location of SSL client certificates.
18186
18187 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
18188
18189 @end deftypevr
18190
18191 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
18192 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
18193
18194 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18195
18196 @end deftypevr
18197
18198 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
18199 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
18200 configuration file.
18201
18202 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18203
18204 @end deftypevr
18205
18206 @c %end of fragment
18207
18208 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
18209 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
18210
18211 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
18212
18213 @c %start of fragment
18214
18215 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
18216
18217 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
18218 The zabbix-agent package.
18219
18220 @end deftypevr
18221
18222 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
18223 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
18224
18225 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18226
18227 @end deftypevr
18228
18229 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
18230 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
18231
18232 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18233
18234 @end deftypevr
18235
18236 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18237 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
18238 must match hostname as configured on the server.
18239
18240 Defaults to @samp{"Zabbix server"}.
18241
18242 @end deftypevr
18243
18244 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18245 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18246
18247 @itemize @bullet
18248 @item
18249 @code{system} - syslog.
18250
18251 @item
18252 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
18253
18254 @item
18255 @code{console} - standard output.
18256
18257 @end itemize
18258
18259 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18260
18261 @end deftypevr
18262
18263 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
18264 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
18265
18266 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
18267
18268 @end deftypevr
18269
18270 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
18271 Name of PID file.
18272
18273 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
18274
18275 @end deftypevr
18276
18277 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
18278 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
18279 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
18280 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
18281
18282 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
18283
18284 @end deftypevr
18285
18286 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
18287 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
18288 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
18289 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
18290
18291 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
18292
18293 @end deftypevr
18294
18295 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
18296 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
18297
18298 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18299
18300 @end deftypevr
18301
18302 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
18303 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
18304 configuration file.
18305
18306 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18307
18308 @end deftypevr
18309
18310 @c %end of fragment
18311
18312 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
18313 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
18314
18315 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
18316
18317 @c %start of fragment
18318
18319 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
18320
18321 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
18322 NGINX configuration.
18323
18324 @end deftypevr
18325
18326 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
18327 Database host name.
18328
18329 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18330
18331 @end deftypevr
18332
18333 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
18334 Database port.
18335
18336 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
18337
18338 @end deftypevr
18339
18340 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
18341 Database name.
18342
18343 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18344
18345 @end deftypevr
18346
18347 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
18348 Database user.
18349
18350 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18351
18352 @end deftypevr
18353
18354 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
18355 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
18356
18357 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18358
18359 @end deftypevr
18360
18361 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
18362 Secret file which will be appended to @file{zabbix.conf.php} file. This
18363 file contains credentials for use by Zabbix front-end. You are expected
18364 to create it manually.
18365
18366 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18367
18368 @end deftypevr
18369
18370 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
18371 Zabbix server hostname.
18372
18373 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18374
18375 @end deftypevr
18376
18377 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
18378 Zabbix server port.
18379
18380 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
18381
18382 @end deftypevr
18383
18384
18385 @c %end of fragment
18386
18387 @node Kerberos Services
18388 @subsection Kerberos Services
18389 @cindex Kerberos
18390
18391 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
18392 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
18393
18394 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
18395
18396 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
18397 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
18398 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
18399 operating system declaration.
18400 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
18401
18402 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
18403 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
18404 Other implementations have not been tested.
18405
18406 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
18407 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
18408 @end defvr
18409
18410 @noindent
18411 Here is an example of its use:
18412 @lisp
18413 (service krb5-service-type
18414 (krb5-configuration
18415 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
18416 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
18417 (realms (list
18418 (krb5-realm
18419 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
18420 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
18421 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
18422 (krb5-realm
18423 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
18424 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
18425 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
18426 @end lisp
18427
18428 @noindent
18429 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
18430 @itemize
18431 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
18432 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
18433 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
18434 specified by clients;
18435 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
18436 @end itemize
18437
18438 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
18439 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
18440 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
18441 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
18442 documentation.
18443
18444
18445 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
18446 @cindex realm, kerberos
18447 @table @asis
18448 @item @code{name}
18449 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
18450 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
18451 converted to upper case.
18452
18453 @item @code{admin-server}
18454 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
18455 running.
18456
18457 @item @code{kdc}
18458 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
18459 for the realm.
18460 @end table
18461 @end deftp
18462
18463 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
18464
18465 @table @asis
18466 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
18467 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
18468 known to be weak will be accepted.
18469
18470 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
18471 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
18472 realm for the client.
18473 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
18474 If this value is @code{#f}
18475 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
18476 such as @command{kinit}.
18477
18478 @item @code{realms}
18479 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
18480 access.
18481 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
18482 field.
18483 @end table
18484 @end deftp
18485
18486
18487 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
18488 @cindex pam-krb5
18489
18490 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
18491 management via Kerberos.
18492 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
18493 users using Kerberos.
18494
18495 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
18496 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
18497 @end defvr
18498
18499 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
18500 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
18501 This type has the following parameters:
18502 @table @asis
18503 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
18504 The pam-krb5 package to use.
18505
18506 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
18507 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
18508 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
18509 @end table
18510 @end deftp
18511
18512
18513 @node LDAP Services
18514 @subsection LDAP Services
18515 @cindex LDAP
18516 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
18517
18518 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
18519 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
18520 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
18521 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
18522 Switch} for detailed information.
18523
18524 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
18525 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
18526 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
18527
18528 @example
18529 (use-service-modules authentication)
18530 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
18531 ...
18532 (operating-system
18533 ...
18534 (services
18535 (cons*
18536 (service nslcd-service-type)
18537 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
18538 %base-services))
18539 (name-service-switch
18540 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
18541 (name-service (name "files"))
18542 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
18543 (name-service-switch
18544 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
18545 (password services)
18546 (shadow services)
18547 (group services)
18548 (netgroup services)
18549 (gshadow services)))))
18550 @end example
18551
18552 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
18553
18554 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
18555
18556 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
18557 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
18558
18559 @end deftypevr
18560
18561 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
18562 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
18563 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
18564 The default is to start 5 threads.
18565
18566 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18567
18568 @end deftypevr
18569
18570 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
18571 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
18572
18573 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
18574
18575 @end deftypevr
18576
18577 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
18578 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
18579
18580 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
18581
18582 @end deftypevr
18583
18584 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
18585 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
18586 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols "none"
18587 or "syslog", or an absolute file name. The LEVEL argument is optional
18588 and specifies the log level. The log level may be one of the following
18589 symbols: "crit", "error", "warning", "notice", "info" or "debug". All
18590 messages with the specified log level or higher are logged.
18591
18592 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
18593
18594 @end deftypevr
18595
18596 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
18597 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
18598 used with the following servers as fall-back.
18599
18600 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
18601
18602 @end deftypevr
18603
18604 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
18605 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
18606 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
18607
18608 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18609
18610 @end deftypevr
18611
18612 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
18613 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
18614 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
18615
18616 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18617
18618 @end deftypevr
18619
18620 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
18621 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
18622 applicable when used with binddn.
18623
18624 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18625
18626 @end deftypevr
18627
18628 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
18629 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
18630 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
18631
18632 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18633
18634 @end deftypevr
18635
18636 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
18637 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
18638 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
18639 rootpwmoddn
18640
18641 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18642
18643 @end deftypevr
18644
18645 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
18646 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
18647 authentication.
18648
18649 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18650
18651 @end deftypevr
18652
18653 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
18654 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
18655
18656 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18657
18658 @end deftypevr
18659
18660 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
18661 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
18662 authentication.
18663
18664 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18665
18666 @end deftypevr
18667
18668 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
18669 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
18670 authentication.
18671
18672 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18673
18674 @end deftypevr
18675
18676 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
18677 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
18678 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
18679 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
18680 performed or not.
18681
18682 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18683
18684 @end deftypevr
18685
18686 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
18687 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
18688
18689 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18690
18691 @end deftypevr
18692
18693 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
18694 The directory search base.
18695
18696 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
18697
18698 @end deftypevr
18699
18700 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
18701 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
18702 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
18703 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
18704
18705 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
18706
18707 @end deftypevr
18708
18709 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
18710 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
18711 to never dereference aliases.
18712
18713 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18714
18715 @end deftypevr
18716
18717 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
18718 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
18719 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
18720
18721 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18722
18723 @end deftypevr
18724
18725 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
18726 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
18727 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
18728 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
18729 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
18730
18731 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18732
18733 @end deftypevr
18734
18735 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
18736 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
18737 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
18738
18739 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18740
18741 @end deftypevr
18742
18743 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
18744 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
18745 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
18746
18747 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18748
18749 @end deftypevr
18750
18751 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
18752 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
18753 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
18754 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
18755
18756 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18757
18758 @end deftypevr
18759
18760 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
18761 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
18762 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
18763 out connections.
18764
18765 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18766
18767 @end deftypevr
18768
18769 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
18770 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
18771 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
18772 failure and the first retry.
18773
18774 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18775
18776 @end deftypevr
18777
18778 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
18779 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
18780 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
18781 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
18782
18783 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18784
18785 @end deftypevr
18786
18787 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
18788 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
18789 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
18790 SSL.
18791
18792 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18793
18794 @end deftypevr
18795
18796 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
18797 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
18798 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
18799
18800 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18801
18802 @end deftypevr
18803
18804 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
18805 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
18806 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
18807
18808 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18809
18810 @end deftypevr
18811
18812 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
18813 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
18814
18815 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18816
18817 @end deftypevr
18818
18819 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
18820 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
18821 using GnuTLS.
18822
18823 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18824
18825 @end deftypevr
18826
18827 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
18828 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
18829
18830 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18831
18832 @end deftypevr
18833
18834 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
18835 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
18836 client TLS authentication.
18837
18838 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18839
18840 @end deftypevr
18841
18842 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
18843 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
18844 authentication.
18845
18846 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18847
18848 @end deftypevr
18849
18850 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
18851 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
18852 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
18853 request paged results.
18854
18855 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18856
18857 @end deftypevr
18858
18859 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
18860 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
18861 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
18862 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
18863
18864 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18865
18866 @end deftypevr
18867
18868 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
18869 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
18870 the specified value are ignored.
18871
18872 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18873
18874 @end deftypevr
18875
18876 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
18877 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
18878 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
18879
18880 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18881
18882 @end deftypevr
18883
18884 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
18885 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
18886 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
18887
18888 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18889
18890 @end deftypevr
18891
18892 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
18893 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
18894 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
18895 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
18896 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
18897 groups.
18898
18899 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18900
18901 @end deftypevr
18902
18903 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
18904 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
18905 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
18906 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
18907 groups assigned on login.
18908
18909 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18910
18911 @end deftypevr
18912
18913 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
18914 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
18915 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
18916 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
18917 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
18918 most configurations.
18919
18920 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18921
18922 @end deftypevr
18923
18924 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
18925 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
18926 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
18927 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
18928
18929 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18930
18931 @end deftypevr
18932
18933 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
18934 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
18935 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
18936 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
18937 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
18938
18939 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18940
18941 @end deftypevr
18942
18943 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
18944 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
18945 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
18946
18947 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18948
18949 @end deftypevr
18950
18951 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
18952 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
18953 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
18954 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
18955 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
18956 It should return at least one entry.
18957
18958 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18959
18960 @end deftypevr
18961
18962 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
18963 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
18964 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
18965 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
18966
18967 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18968
18969 @end deftypevr
18970
18971 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
18972 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
18973 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
18974 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
18975 changing their password.
18976
18977 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18978
18979 @end deftypevr
18980
18981 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
18982 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
18983
18984 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18985
18986 @end deftypevr
18987
18988 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
18989
18990
18991 @node Web Services
18992 @subsection Web Services
18993
18994 @cindex web
18995 @cindex www
18996 @cindex HTTP
18997 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
18998 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
18999
19000 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
19001
19002 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
19003 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
19004 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
19005 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
19006
19007 A simple example configuration is given below.
19008
19009 @example
19010 (service httpd-service-type
19011 (httpd-configuration
19012 (config
19013 (httpd-config-file
19014 (server-name "www.example.com")
19015 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
19016 @end example
19017
19018 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
19019 the configuration.
19020
19021 @example
19022 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
19023 (list
19024 (httpd-virtualhost
19025 "*:80"
19026 (list (string-append
19027 "ServerName "www.example.com
19028 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
19029 @end example
19030 @end deffn
19031
19032 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
19033 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
19034 given below.
19035
19036 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
19037 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
19038
19039 @table @asis
19040 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
19041 The httpd package to use.
19042
19043 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19044 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
19045
19046 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
19047 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
19048 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
19049 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
19050 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
19051
19052 @end table
19053 @end deffn
19054
19055 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
19056 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
19057
19058 @table @asis
19059 @item @code{name}
19060 The name of the module.
19061
19062 @item @code{file}
19063 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
19064 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
19065 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
19066 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
19067
19068 @end table
19069 @end deffn
19070
19071 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
19072 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
19073 @end defvr
19074
19075 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
19076 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
19077
19078 @table @asis
19079 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
19080 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
19081 additional configuration.
19082
19083 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
19084 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
19085
19086 @example
19087 (service httpd-service-type
19088 (httpd-configuration
19089 (config
19090 (httpd-config-file
19091 (modules (cons*
19092 (httpd-module
19093 (name "proxy_module")
19094 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
19095 (httpd-module
19096 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
19097 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
19098 %default-httpd-modules))
19099 (extra-config (list "\
19100 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
19101 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
19102 </FilesMatch>"))))))
19103 (service php-fpm-service-type
19104 (php-fpm-configuration
19105 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
19106 (socket-group "httpd")))
19107 @end example
19108
19109 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
19110 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
19111 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
19112 taken as relative to the server root.
19113
19114 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
19115 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
19116 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
19117 itself.
19118
19119 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specifyed
19120 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
19121 @code{ServerName}.
19122
19123 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
19124 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
19125
19126 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
19127 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
19128 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
19129 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
19130 protocol to use.
19131
19132 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19133 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
19134 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
19135 configured correctly.
19136
19137 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
19138 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
19139
19140 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19141 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
19142
19143 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19144 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
19145
19146 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
19147 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
19148 of the configuration file.
19149
19150 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
19151 list.
19152
19153 @end table
19154 @end deffn
19155
19156 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
19157 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
19158
19159 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
19160
19161 @example
19162 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
19163 (list
19164 (httpd-virtualhost
19165 "*:80"
19166 (list (string-append
19167 "ServerName "www.example.com
19168 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
19169 @end example
19170
19171 @table @asis
19172 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
19173 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
19174
19175 @item @code{contents}
19176 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
19177 of strings and G-expressions.
19178
19179 @end table
19180 @end deffn
19181
19182 @subsubheading NGINX
19183
19184 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
19185 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
19186 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
19187
19188 A simple example configuration is given below.
19189
19190 @example
19191 (service nginx-service-type
19192 (nginx-configuration
19193 (server-blocks
19194 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19195 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19196 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
19197 @end example
19198
19199 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
19200 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
19201 blocks, as in this example:
19202
19203 @example
19204 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
19205 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19206 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
19207 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
19208 @end example
19209 @end deffn
19210
19211 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
19212 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
19213 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
19214 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
19215 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
19216 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
19217 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
19218 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
19219
19220 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
19221 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
19222 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
19223 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
19224
19225 @table @asis
19226 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
19227 The nginx package to use.
19228
19229 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
19230 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
19231
19232 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
19233 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
19234 files.
19235
19236 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
19237 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
19238 file, the elements should be of type
19239 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
19240
19241 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
19242 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
19243 HTTPS.
19244 @example
19245 (service nginx-service-type
19246 (nginx-configuration
19247 (server-blocks
19248 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19249 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19250 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
19251 @end example
19252
19253 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
19254 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
19255 file, the elements should be of type
19256 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
19257
19258 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
19259 when combined with @code{locations} in the
19260 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
19261 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
19262 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
19263 requests with two servers.
19264
19265 @example
19266 (service
19267 nginx-service-type
19268 (nginx-configuration
19269 (server-blocks
19270 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19271 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19272 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
19273 (locations
19274 (list
19275 (nginx-location-configuration
19276 (uri "/path1")
19277 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
19278 (upstream-blocks
19279 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
19280 (name "server-proxy")
19281 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
19282 "server2.example.com")))))))
19283 @end example
19284
19285 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
19286 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
19287 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
19288 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
19289 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
19290 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
19291
19292 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
19293 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
19294 nginx-configuration record.
19295
19296 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
19297 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
19298 use the size of the processors cache line.
19299
19300 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
19301 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
19302
19303 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
19304 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
19305 valued G-expression.
19306
19307 @end table
19308 @end deffn
19309
19310 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
19311 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
19312 This type has the following parameters:
19313
19314 @table @asis
19315 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
19316 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
19317 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
19318 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
19319 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
19320
19321 @example
19322 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
19323 @end example
19324
19325 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
19326 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
19327 default server for connections matching no other server.
19328
19329 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
19330 Root of the website nginx will serve.
19331
19332 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
19333 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
19334 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
19335 server block.
19336
19337 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
19338 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
19339 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
19340
19341 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
19342 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
19343 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
19344
19345 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
19346 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
19347 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
19348
19349 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
19350 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
19351 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
19352
19353 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
19354 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
19355
19356 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
19357 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
19358
19359 @end table
19360 @end deftp
19361
19362 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
19363 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
19364 block. This type has the following parameters:
19365
19366 @table @asis
19367 @item @code{name}
19368 Name for this group of servers.
19369
19370 @item @code{servers}
19371 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
19372 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
19373 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
19374 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
19375 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
19376 explicitly.
19377
19378 @end table
19379 @end deftp
19380
19381 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
19382 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
19383 block. This type has the following parameters:
19384
19385 @table @asis
19386 @item @code{uri}
19387 URI which this location block matches.
19388
19389 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
19390 @item @code{body}
19391 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
19392 many
19393 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
19394 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
19395 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
19396 http://upstream-name;")}.
19397
19398 @end table
19399 @end deftp
19400
19401 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
19402 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
19403 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
19404 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
19405 parameters:
19406
19407 @table @asis
19408 @item @code{name}
19409 Name to identify this location block.
19410
19411 @item @code{body}
19412 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
19413 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
19414 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
19415 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
19416
19417 @end table
19418 @end deftp
19419
19420 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
19421 @cindex Varnish
19422 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
19423 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
19424 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
19425 creates one request to the back-end.
19426
19427 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
19428 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
19429 @end defvr
19430
19431 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
19432 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
19433 This type has the following parameters:
19434
19435 @table @asis
19436 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
19437 The Varnish package to use.
19438
19439 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
19440 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
19441 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
19442 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
19443 directory name.
19444
19445 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
19446 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
19447
19448 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
19449 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
19450
19451 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
19452 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
19453 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
19454 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
19455 VCL syntax.
19456
19457 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
19458 For example, to mirror @url{http://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
19459 can do something along these lines:
19460
19461 @example
19462 (define %gnu-mirror
19463 (plain-file
19464 "gnu.vcl"
19465 "vcl 4.1;
19466 backend gnu @{ .host = "www.gnu.org"; @}"))
19467
19468 (operating-system
19469 ...
19470 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
19471 (varnish-configuration
19472 (listen '(":80"))
19473 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
19474 %base-services)))
19475 @end example
19476
19477 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
19478 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
19479
19480 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
19481 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
19482 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
19483
19484 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
19485 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
19486
19487 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
19488 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
19489
19490 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
19491 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
19492
19493 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
19494 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
19495
19496 @end table
19497 @end deftp
19498
19499 @subsubheading Patchwork
19500 @cindex Patchwork
19501 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
19502 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
19503
19504 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
19505 Service type for Patchwork.
19506 @end defvr
19507
19508 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
19509 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
19510
19511 @example
19512 (service patchwork-service-type
19513 (patchwork-configuration
19514 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
19515 (settings-module
19516 (patchwork-settings-module
19517 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
19518 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
19519 (getmail-retriever-config
19520 (getmail-retriever-configuration
19521 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
19522 (server "imap.example.com")
19523 (port 993)
19524 (username "patchwork")
19525 (password-command
19526 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
19527 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
19528 (extra-parameters
19529 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
19530
19531 @end example
19532
19533 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
19534 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
19535 within the HTTPD service.
19536
19537 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
19538 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
19539 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
19540
19541 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
19542 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
19543 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
19544
19545 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
19546 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
19547 following parameters:
19548
19549 @table @asis
19550 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
19551 The Patchwork package to use.
19552
19553 @item @code{domain}
19554 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
19555 host.
19556
19557 @item @code{settings-module}
19558 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
19559 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
19560 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
19561 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
19562 store.
19563
19564 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
19565 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
19566
19567 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
19568 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
19569 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
19570 delivered to Patchwork.
19571
19572 @end table
19573 @end deftp
19574
19575 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
19576 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
19577 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
19578 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
19579 has the following parameters:
19580
19581 @table @asis
19582 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
19583 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
19584 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
19585
19586 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
19587 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
19588 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
19589
19590 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
19591 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
19592
19593 This setting relates to Django.
19594
19595 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
19596 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
19597 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
19598
19599 This is a Django setting.
19600
19601 @item @code{default-from-email}
19602 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
19603
19604 This is a Patchwork setting.
19605
19606 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
19607 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
19608 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
19609
19610 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
19611 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
19612
19613 This is a Django setting.
19614
19615 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
19616 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
19617 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
19618
19619 This is a Django setting.
19620
19621 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
19622 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
19623 messages will be shown.
19624
19625 This is a Django setting.
19626
19627 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
19628 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
19629
19630 This is a Patchwork setting.
19631
19632 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
19633 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
19634
19635 This is a Patchwork setting.
19636
19637 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
19638 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
19639
19640 This is a Patchwork setting.
19641
19642 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
19643 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
19644
19645 @end table
19646 @end deftp
19647
19648 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
19649 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
19650
19651 @table @asis
19652 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
19653 The database engine to use.
19654
19655 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
19656 The name of the database to use.
19657
19658 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19659 The user to connect to the database as.
19660
19661 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
19662 The password to use when connecting to the database.
19663
19664 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
19665 The host to make the database connection to.
19666
19667 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
19668 The port on which to connect to the database.
19669
19670 @end table
19671 @end deftp
19672
19673 @subsubheading FastCGI
19674 @cindex fastcgi
19675 @cindex fcgiwrap
19676 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
19677 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
19678 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
19679 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
19680 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
19681 support for it in Guix.
19682
19683 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
19684 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
19685 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
19686 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
19687 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
19688 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
19689
19690 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
19691 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
19692 @end defvr
19693
19694 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
19695 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
19696 This type has the following parameters:
19697 @table @asis
19698 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19699 The fcgiwrap package to use.
19700
19701 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
19702 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
19703 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
19704 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
19705 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
19706 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
19707
19708 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19709 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19710 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
19711 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
19712 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
19713 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
19714
19715 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
19716 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
19717 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
19718 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end., run
19719 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
19720 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
19721 @end table
19722 @end deftp
19723
19724 @cindex php-fpm
19725 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
19726 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
19727
19728 These features include:
19729 @itemize @bullet
19730 @item Adaptive process spawning
19731 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
19732 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
19733 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
19734 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
19735 @item Stdout & stderr logging
19736 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
19737 @item Accelerated upload support
19738 @item Support for a "slowlog"
19739 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
19740 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
19741 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
19742 @end itemize
19743 ...@: and much more.
19744
19745 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
19746 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
19747 @end defvr
19748
19749 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
19750 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
19751 @table @asis
19752 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
19753 The php package to use.
19754 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
19755 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
19756 @table @asis
19757 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
19758 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
19759 @item @code{"port"}
19760 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
19761 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
19762 Listen on a unix socket.
19763 @end table
19764
19765 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19766 User who will own the php worker processes.
19767 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19768 Group of the worker processes.
19769 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19770 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
19771 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19772 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
19773 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
19774 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
19775 once the service has started.
19776 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
19777 Log for the php-fpm master process.
19778 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
19779 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
19780 Must be either:
19781 @table @asis
19782 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
19783 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
19784 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
19785 @end table
19786 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
19787 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
19788 and displayed in their browsers.
19789 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
19790 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
19791 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
19792 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
19793 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
19794 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
19795 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
19796 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
19797 An optional override of the whole configuration.
19798 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
19799 @end table
19800 @end deftp
19801
19802 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
19803 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
19804 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
19805 based on it's configured limits.
19806 @table @asis
19807 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19808 Maximum of worker processes.
19809 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
19810 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
19811 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
19812 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
19813 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
19814 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
19815 @end table
19816 @end deftp
19817
19818 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
19819 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
19820 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
19821 are created.
19822 @table @asis
19823 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19824 Maximum of worker processes.
19825 @end table
19826 @end deftp
19827
19828 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
19829 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
19830 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
19831 requests arrive.
19832 @table @asis
19833 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
19834 Maximum of worker processes.
19835 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
19836 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
19837 @end table
19838 @end deftp
19839
19840
19841 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-fpm-location @
19842 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
19843 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
19844 (version-major (package-version php)) @
19845 "-fpm.sock")]
19846 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
19847 @end deffn
19848
19849 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
19850 @example
19851 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
19852 (service php-fpm-service-type)
19853 (service nginx-service-type
19854 (nginx-server-configuration
19855 (server-name '("example.com"))
19856 (root "/srv/http/")
19857 (locations
19858 (list (nginx-php-location)))
19859 (listen '("80"))
19860 (ssl-certificate #f)
19861 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
19862 %base-services))
19863 @end example
19864
19865 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
19866 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
19867 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
19868 the hash of a user's email address.
19869
19870 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
19871 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
19872 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
19873 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
19874 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
19875 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
19876 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
19877 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
19878 @end deffn
19879
19880 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
19881 @example
19882 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
19883 #:configuration
19884 (nginx-server-configuration
19885 (server-name '("example.com"))))
19886 ...
19887 %base-services))
19888 @end example
19889
19890 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
19891
19892 @cindex hpcguix-web
19893 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
19894 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
19895 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
19896 clusters.
19897
19898 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
19899 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
19900 @end defvr
19901
19902 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
19903 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
19904
19905 @table @asis
19906 @item @code{specs}
19907 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
19908 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
19909
19910 @table @asis
19911 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
19912 The page title prefix.
19913
19914 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
19915 The @command{guix} command.
19916
19917 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
19918 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
19919
19920 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
19921 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
19922
19923 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
19924 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
19925
19926 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
19927 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
19928
19929 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
19930 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
19931 the latest instances of the given channels.
19932 @end table
19933
19934 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
19935 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
19936 complete example}.
19937
19938 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
19939 The hpcguix-web package to use.
19940 @end table
19941 @end deftp
19942
19943 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
19944
19945 @example
19946 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
19947 (hpcguix-web-configuration
19948 (specs
19949 #~(define site-config
19950 (hpcweb-configuration
19951 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
19952 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
19953 @end example
19954
19955 @quotation Note
19956 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
19957 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
19958 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
19959 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
19960
19961 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
19962 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
19963 more information on X.509 certificates.
19964 @end quotation
19965
19966 @node Certificate Services
19967 @subsection Certificate Services
19968
19969 @cindex Web
19970 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
19971 @cindex Let's Encrypt
19972 @cindex TLS certificates
19973 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
19974 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
19975 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
19976 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
19977 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
19978 authenticity.
19979
19980 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
19981 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
19982 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
19983 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
19984 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
19985 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
19986 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
19987 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
19988 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
19989 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
19990 signature.
19991
19992 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
19993 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
19994 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
19995 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
19996 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
19997 with different permissions).
19998
19999 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
20000 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
20001 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
20002 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
20003 some reason.
20004
20005 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
20006 can be found there:
20007 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
20008
20009 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
20010 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
20011 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
20012
20013 @example
20014 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
20015 (program-file
20016 "nginx-deploy-hook"
20017 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
20018 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
20019
20020 (service certbot-service-type
20021 (certbot-configuration
20022 (email "foo@@example.net")
20023 (certificates
20024 (list
20025 (certificate-configuration
20026 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
20027 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
20028 (certificate-configuration
20029 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
20030 @end example
20031
20032 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
20033 @end defvr
20034
20035 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
20036 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
20037 This type has the following parameters:
20038
20039 @table @asis
20040 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
20041 The certbot package to use.
20042
20043 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
20044 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
20045 files.
20046
20047 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
20048 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
20049 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
20050 and several @code{domains}.
20051
20052 @item @code{email}
20053 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
20054 account notifications.
20055
20056 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
20057 Size of the RSA key.
20058
20059 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
20060 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
20061 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
20062 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
20063 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
20064 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
20065 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
20066 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
20067 these nginx configuration data types.
20068
20069 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
20070 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
20071 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
20072
20073 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
20074 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
20075 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
20076
20077 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
20078 @end table
20079 @end deftp
20080
20081 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
20082 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
20083 This type has the following parameters:
20084
20085 @table @asis
20086 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
20087 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
20088 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
20089 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
20090
20091 Its default is the first provided domain.
20092
20093 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
20094 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
20095 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
20096
20097 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
20098 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
20099 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
20100 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
20101 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}).
20102
20103 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20104 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
20105 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
20106 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
20107 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
20108 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
20109
20110 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20111 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
20112 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
20113 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
20114 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
20115 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
20116
20117 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20118 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
20119 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
20120 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
20121 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
20122 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
20123 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
20124 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
20125
20126 @end table
20127 @end deftp
20128
20129 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
20130 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
20131 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
20132 @node DNS Services
20133 @subsection DNS Services
20134 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
20135 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
20136
20137 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
20138 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
20139 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
20140 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
20141 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
20142 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
20143
20144 @subsubheading Knot Service
20145
20146 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
20147 and one slave, is:
20148
20149 @lisp
20150 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
20151 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
20152 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
20153 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
20154 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
20155
20156 (define master-zone
20157 (knot-zone-configuration
20158 (domain "example.org")
20159 (zone (zone-file
20160 (origin "example.org")
20161 (entries example.org.zone)))))
20162
20163 (define slave-zone
20164 (knot-zone-configuration
20165 (domain "plop.org")
20166 (dnssec-policy "default")
20167 (master (list "plop-master"))))
20168
20169 (define plop-master
20170 (knot-remote-configuration
20171 (id "plop-master")
20172 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
20173
20174 (operating-system
20175 ;; ...
20176 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
20177 (knot-configuration
20178 (remotes (list plop-master))
20179 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
20180 ;; ...
20181 %base-services)))
20182 @end lisp
20183
20184 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
20185 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
20186
20187 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
20188 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
20189 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
20190 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
20191 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
20192 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
20193 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
20194
20195 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
20196 @end deffn
20197
20198 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
20199 Data type representing a key.
20200 This type has the following parameters:
20201
20202 @table @asis
20203 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20204 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
20205 be unique and must not be empty.
20206
20207 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
20208 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
20209 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
20210 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
20211
20212 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
20213 The secret key itself.
20214
20215 @end table
20216 @end deftp
20217
20218 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
20219 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
20220 This type has the following parameters:
20221
20222 @table @asis
20223 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20224 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
20225 unique and must not be empty.
20226
20227 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
20228 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
20229 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
20230 address match is not required.
20231
20232 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
20233 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
20234 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
20235 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
20236
20237 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
20238 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
20239 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
20240 and @code{'update}.
20241
20242 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
20243 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
20244 false, listed actions are allowed.
20245
20246 @end table
20247 @end deftp
20248
20249 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
20250 Data type represnting a record entry in a zone file.
20251 This type has the following parameters:
20252
20253 @table @asis
20254 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
20255 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
20256 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
20257 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
20258 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
20259 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
20260
20261 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
20262 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
20263
20264 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
20265 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
20266 partially @code{"CH"}.
20267
20268 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
20269 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
20270 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
20271 defined.
20272
20273 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
20274 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
20275 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
20276 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
20277
20278 @end table
20279 @end deftp
20280
20281 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
20282 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
20283 This type has the following parameters:
20284
20285 @table @asis
20286 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
20287 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
20288 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
20289 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
20290 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
20291 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
20292 field of the @code{zone-file}.
20293
20294 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
20295 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
20296
20297 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
20298 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
20299 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
20300 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
20301 to an IP address in the list of entries.
20302
20303 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
20304 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
20305 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
20306
20307 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
20308 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
20309 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
20310 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
20311
20312 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
20313 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
20314 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
20315 @code{(string->duration)}.
20316
20317 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
20318 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
20319 to do so a first time.
20320
20321 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
20322 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
20323 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
20324 and check again that it still exists.
20325
20326 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
20327 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
20328 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
20329
20330 @end table
20331 @end deftp
20332
20333 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
20334 Data type representing a remote configuration.
20335 This type has the following parameters:
20336
20337 @table @asis
20338 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20339 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
20340 be unique and must not be empty.
20341
20342 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
20343 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
20344 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
20345 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
20346
20347 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
20348 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
20349 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
20350 The default is to choose at random.
20351
20352 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
20353 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
20354 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
20355
20356 @end table
20357 @end deftp
20358
20359 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
20360 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
20361 This type has the following parameters:
20362
20363 @table @asis
20364 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20365 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
20366
20367 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
20368 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
20369
20370 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
20371 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
20372 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
20373 For the pem backend, the string reprensents a path in the file system.
20374
20375 @end table
20376 @end deftp
20377
20378 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
20379 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
20380 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
20381 use keys that you generate.
20382
20383 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
20384 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
20385 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
20386 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
20387 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
20388 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
20389
20390 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
20391 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
20392 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
20393 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
20394 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
20395
20396 This type has the following parameters:
20397
20398 @table @asis
20399 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20400 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
20401
20402 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
20403 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
20404 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
20405 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
20406 was setup by this service).
20407
20408 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
20409 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
20410
20411 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
20412 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
20413
20414 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
20415 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
20416
20417 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
20418 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
20419 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
20420
20421 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
20422 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
20423 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
20424
20425 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
20426 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
20427 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
20428
20429 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
20430 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
20431
20432 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
20433 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
20434 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
20435
20436 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
20437 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
20438
20439 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
20440 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
20441
20442 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
20443 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
20444
20445 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
20446 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
20447
20448 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
20449 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
20450 name before hashing.
20451
20452 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
20453 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
20454
20455 @end table
20456 @end deftp
20457
20458 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
20459 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
20460 This type has the following parameters:
20461
20462 @table @asis
20463 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
20464 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
20465
20466 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
20467 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
20468 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
20469
20470 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
20471 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
20472 must contain a zone-file record.
20473
20474 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
20475 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
20476 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
20477
20478 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
20479 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
20480 masters.
20481
20482 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
20483 A list of slave remote identifiers.
20484
20485 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
20486 A list of acl identifiers.
20487
20488 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
20489 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
20490
20491 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
20492 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
20493
20494 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
20495 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
20496 synchronization.
20497
20498 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
20499 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
20500 are:
20501
20502 @itemize
20503 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
20504 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
20505 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
20506 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
20507 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
20508 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
20509 automatically.
20510 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
20511 @end itemize
20512
20513 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
20514 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
20515 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
20516 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
20517 default value from Knot is used.
20518
20519 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
20520 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
20521 so the default value from Knot is used.
20522
20523 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
20524 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
20525 default value from Knot is used.
20526
20527 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
20528 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
20529 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
20530 value from Knot is used.
20531
20532 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
20533 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
20534 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
20535 on this zone.
20536
20537 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
20538 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
20539
20540 @end table
20541 @end deftp
20542
20543 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
20544 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
20545 This type has the following parameters:
20546
20547 @table @asis
20548 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
20549 The Knot package.
20550
20551 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
20552 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
20553
20554 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
20555 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
20556 included at the top of the configuration file.
20557
20558 @cindex secrets, Knot service
20559 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
20560 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
20561 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
20562 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
20563 to the @code{includes} list.
20564
20565 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
20566
20567 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
20568 An ip address on which to listen.
20569
20570 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
20571 An ip address on which to listen.
20572
20573 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
20574 A port on which to listen.
20575
20576 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
20577 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
20578
20579 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
20580 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
20581
20582 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
20583 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
20584
20585 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
20586 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
20587
20588 @end table
20589 @end deftp
20590
20591 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
20592
20593 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
20594 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
20595 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
20596
20597 @example
20598 (service dnsmasq-service-type
20599 (dnsmasq-configuration
20600 (no-resolv? #t)
20601 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
20602 @end example
20603 @end deffn
20604
20605 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
20606 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
20607
20608 @table @asis
20609 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
20610 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
20611
20612 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
20613 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
20614
20615 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
20616 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
20617 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
20618
20619 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
20620 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
20621 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
20622
20623 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
20624 Listen on the given IP addresses.
20625
20626 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
20627 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
20628
20629 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
20630 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
20631
20632 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
20633 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
20634
20635 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
20636 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
20637 disables caching.
20638
20639 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
20640 When false, disable negative caching.
20641
20642 @end table
20643 @end deftp
20644
20645 @subsubheading ddclient Service
20646
20647 @cindex ddclient
20648 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
20649 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
20650 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
20651
20652 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
20653 configuration:
20654
20655 @example
20656 (service ddclient-service-type)
20657 @end example
20658
20659 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
20660 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
20661 @code{secret-file} below.) You are expected to create this file manually, in
20662 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
20663 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
20664 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}.) See the examples in the
20665 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
20666
20667 @c %start of fragment
20668
20669 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
20670
20671 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
20672 The ddclient package.
20673
20674 @end deftypevr
20675
20676 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
20677 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
20678
20679 Defaults to @samp{300}.
20680
20681 @end deftypevr
20682
20683 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
20684 Use syslog for the output.
20685
20686 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20687
20688 @end deftypevr
20689
20690 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
20691 Mail to user.
20692
20693 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
20694
20695 @end deftypevr
20696
20697 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
20698 Mail failed update to user.
20699
20700 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
20701
20702 @end deftypevr
20703
20704 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
20705 The ddclient PID file.
20706
20707 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
20708
20709 @end deftypevr
20710
20711 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
20712 Enable SSL support.
20713
20714 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20715
20716 @end deftypevr
20717
20718 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
20719 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
20720 program.
20721
20722 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
20723
20724 @end deftypevr
20725
20726 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
20727 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
20728
20729 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
20730
20731 @end deftypevr
20732
20733 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
20734 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
20735 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
20736 create it manually.
20737
20738 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
20739
20740 @end deftypevr
20741
20742 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
20743 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
20744
20745 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20746
20747 @end deftypevr
20748
20749
20750 @c %end of fragment
20751
20752
20753 @node VPN Services
20754 @subsection VPN Services
20755 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
20756 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
20757
20758 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
20759 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
20760 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
20761 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
20762
20763 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
20764 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
20765
20766 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
20767 @end deffn
20768
20769 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
20770 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
20771
20772 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
20773
20774 Both can be run simultaneously.
20775 @end deffn
20776
20777 @c %automatically generated documentation
20778
20779 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
20780
20781 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
20782 The OpenVPN package.
20783
20784 @end deftypevr
20785
20786 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
20787 The OpenVPN pid file.
20788
20789 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
20790
20791 @end deftypevr
20792
20793 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
20794 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
20795 servers.
20796
20797 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
20798
20799 @end deftypevr
20800
20801 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
20802 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
20803
20804 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
20805
20806 @end deftypevr
20807
20808 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
20809 The certificate authority to check connections against.
20810
20811 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
20812
20813 @end deftypevr
20814
20815 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
20816 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
20817 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
20818
20819 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
20820
20821 @end deftypevr
20822
20823 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
20824 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
20825 certificate is @code{cert}.
20826
20827 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
20828
20829 @end deftypevr
20830
20831 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
20832 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
20833
20834 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20835
20836 @end deftypevr
20837
20838 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
20839 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
20840
20841 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20842
20843 @end deftypevr
20844
20845 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
20846 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
20847 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
20848
20849 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20850
20851 @end deftypevr
20852
20853 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
20854 Verbosity level.
20855
20856 Defaults to @samp{3}.
20857
20858 @end deftypevr
20859
20860 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
20861 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
20862 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
20863
20864 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20865
20866 @end deftypevr
20867
20868 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
20869 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
20870
20871 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20872
20873 @end deftypevr
20874
20875 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
20876 Bind to a specific local port number.
20877
20878 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
20879
20880 @end deftypevr
20881
20882 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
20883 Retry resolving server address.
20884
20885 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20886
20887 @end deftypevr
20888
20889 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
20890 A list of remote servers to connect to.
20891
20892 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20893
20894 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
20895
20896 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
20897 Server name.
20898
20899 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
20900
20901 @end deftypevr
20902
20903 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
20904 Port number the server listens to.
20905
20906 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
20907
20908 @end deftypevr
20909
20910 @end deftypevr
20911 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
20912
20913 @c %automatically generated documentation
20914
20915 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
20916
20917 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
20918 The OpenVPN package.
20919
20920 @end deftypevr
20921
20922 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
20923 The OpenVPN pid file.
20924
20925 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
20926
20927 @end deftypevr
20928
20929 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
20930 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
20931 servers.
20932
20933 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
20934
20935 @end deftypevr
20936
20937 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
20938 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
20939
20940 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
20941
20942 @end deftypevr
20943
20944 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
20945 The certificate authority to check connections against.
20946
20947 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
20948
20949 @end deftypevr
20950
20951 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
20952 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
20953 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
20954
20955 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
20956
20957 @end deftypevr
20958
20959 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
20960 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
20961 certificate is @code{cert}.
20962
20963 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
20964
20965 @end deftypevr
20966
20967 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
20968 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
20969
20970 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20971
20972 @end deftypevr
20973
20974 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
20975 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
20976
20977 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20978
20979 @end deftypevr
20980
20981 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
20982 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
20983 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
20984
20985 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20986
20987 @end deftypevr
20988
20989 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
20990 Verbosity level.
20991
20992 Defaults to @samp{3}.
20993
20994 @end deftypevr
20995
20996 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
20997 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
20998 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
20999
21000 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21001
21002 @end deftypevr
21003
21004 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
21005 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
21006
21007 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21008
21009 @end deftypevr
21010
21011 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
21012 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
21013
21014 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
21015
21016 @end deftypevr
21017
21018 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
21019 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
21020
21021 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21022
21023 @end deftypevr
21024
21025 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
21026 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
21027
21028 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
21029
21030 @end deftypevr
21031
21032 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
21033 The file that records client IPs.
21034
21035 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
21036
21037 @end deftypevr
21038
21039 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
21040 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
21041
21042 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21043
21044 @end deftypevr
21045
21046 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
21047 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
21048
21049 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21050
21051 @end deftypevr
21052
21053 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
21054 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
21055 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
21056 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
21057 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
21058 down.
21059
21060 @end deftypevr
21061
21062 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
21063 The maximum number of clients.
21064
21065 Defaults to @samp{100}.
21066
21067 @end deftypevr
21068
21069 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
21070 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
21071 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
21072
21073 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
21074
21075 @end deftypevr
21076
21077 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
21078 The list of configuration for some clients.
21079
21080 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21081
21082 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
21083
21084 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
21085 Client name.
21086
21087 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
21088
21089 @end deftypevr
21090
21091 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
21092 Client own network
21093
21094 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21095
21096 @end deftypevr
21097
21098 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
21099 Client VPN IP.
21100
21101 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21102
21103 @end deftypevr
21104
21105 @end deftypevr
21106
21107
21108 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
21109
21110
21111 @node Network File System
21112 @subsection Network File System
21113 @cindex NFS
21114
21115 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
21116 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
21117 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
21118
21119 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
21120 @cindex rpcbind
21121
21122 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
21123 universal addresses.
21124 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
21125 started when a dependent service starts.
21126
21127 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
21128 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
21129 @end defvr
21130
21131
21132 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
21133 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
21134 This type has the following parameters:
21135 @table @asis
21136 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
21137 The rpcbind package to use.
21138
21139 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
21140 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
21141 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
21142 instance.
21143 @end table
21144 @end deftp
21145
21146
21147 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
21148 @cindex pipefs
21149 @cindex rpc_pipefs
21150
21151 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
21152 between the kernel and user space programs.
21153
21154 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
21155 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
21156 @end defvr
21157
21158 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
21159 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
21160 This type has the following parameters:
21161 @table @asis
21162 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21163 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
21164 @end table
21165 @end deftp
21166
21167
21168 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
21169 @cindex GSSD
21170 @cindex GSS
21171 @cindex global security system
21172
21173 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
21174 based protocols.
21175 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
21176 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
21177 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
21178
21179 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
21180 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
21181 @end defvr
21182
21183 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
21184 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
21185 This type has the following parameters:
21186 @table @asis
21187 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
21188 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
21189
21190 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21191 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
21192
21193 @end table
21194 @end deftp
21195
21196
21197 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
21198 @cindex idmapd
21199 @cindex name mapper
21200
21201 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
21202 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
21203
21204 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
21205 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
21206 @end defvr
21207
21208 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
21209 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
21210 This type has the following parameters:
21211 @table @asis
21212 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
21213 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
21214
21215 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21216 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
21217
21218 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
21219 The local NFSv4 domain name.
21220 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
21221 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
21222
21223 @end table
21224 @end deftp
21225
21226 @node Continuous Integration
21227 @subsection Continuous Integration
21228
21229 @cindex continuous integration
21230 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
21231 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
21232 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
21233
21234 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
21235
21236 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
21237 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
21238 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
21239 @end defvr
21240
21241 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
21242 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
21243 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
21244 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
21245 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
21246
21247 @example
21248 (define %cuirass-specs
21249 #~(list
21250 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
21251 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
21252 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
21253 (#:proc-input . "guix")
21254 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
21255 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
21256 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
21257 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
21258 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
21259 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
21260 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
21261 (#:load-path . ".")
21262 (#:branch . "master")
21263 (#:no-compile? . #t))
21264 ((#:name . "config")
21265 (#:url . "git://git.example.org/config.git")
21266 (#:load-path . ".")
21267 (#:branch . "master")
21268 (#:no-compile? . #t))
21269 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
21270 (#:url . "git://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
21271 (#:load-path . ".")
21272 (#:branch . "master")
21273 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
21274
21275 (service cuirass-service-type
21276 (cuirass-configuration
21277 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
21278 @end example
21279
21280 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
21281 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
21282 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
21283
21284 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
21285 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
21286
21287 @table @asis
21288 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
21289 Location of the log file.
21290
21291 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
21292 Location of the repository cache.
21293
21294 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
21295 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
21296
21297 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
21298 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
21299
21300 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
21301 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
21302 Cuirass jobs.
21303
21304 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
21305 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
21306 added specifications.
21307
21308 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21309 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
21310 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
21311 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
21312
21313 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
21314 Port number used by the HTTP server.
21315
21316 @item --listen=@var{host}
21317 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
21318 accept connections from localhost.
21319
21320 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
21321 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
21322 where a specification is an association list
21323 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
21324 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
21325 above.
21326
21327 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
21328 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
21329 from source.
21330
21331 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
21332 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
21333
21334 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
21335 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
21336 packages locally.
21337
21338 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
21339 The Cuirass package to use.
21340 @end table
21341 @end deftp
21342
21343 @node Power Management Services
21344 @subsection Power Management Services
21345
21346 @cindex tlp
21347 @cindex power management with TLP
21348 @subsubheading TLP daemon
21349
21350 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
21351 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
21352
21353 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
21354 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
21355 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
21356 source is detected. More information can be found at
21357 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
21358
21359 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
21360 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
21361 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
21362 write:
21363 @example
21364 (service tlp-service-type)
21365 @end example
21366 @end deffn
21367
21368 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
21369 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
21370
21371 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
21372 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
21373 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
21374 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
21375 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
21376
21377 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
21378 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
21379 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
21380 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
21381 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
21382 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
21383 @c the churn as TLP updates.
21384
21385 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
21386
21387 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
21388 The TLP package.
21389
21390 @end deftypevr
21391
21392 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
21393 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
21394
21395 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21396
21397 @end deftypevr
21398
21399 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
21400 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
21401 and BAT.
21402
21403 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
21404
21405 @end deftypevr
21406
21407 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
21408 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
21409 before syncing on AC.
21410
21411 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21412
21413 @end deftypevr
21414
21415 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
21416 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
21417
21418 Defaults to @samp{2}.
21419
21420 @end deftypevr
21421
21422 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
21423 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
21424
21425 Defaults to @samp{15}.
21426
21427 @end deftypevr
21428
21429 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
21430 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21431
21432 Defaults to @samp{60}.
21433
21434 @end deftypevr
21435
21436 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
21437 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
21438 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
21439 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
21440
21441 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21442
21443 @end deftypevr
21444
21445 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
21446 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21447
21448 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21449
21450 @end deftypevr
21451
21452 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
21453 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
21454
21455 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21456
21457 @end deftypevr
21458
21459 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
21460 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
21461
21462 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21463
21464 @end deftypevr
21465
21466 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
21467 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
21468
21469 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21470
21471 @end deftypevr
21472
21473 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
21474 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
21475
21476 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21477
21478 @end deftypevr
21479
21480 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
21481 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
21482 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
21483
21484 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21485
21486 @end deftypevr
21487
21488 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
21489 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
21490 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
21491
21492 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21493
21494 @end deftypevr
21495
21496 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
21497 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21498
21499 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21500
21501 @end deftypevr
21502
21503 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
21504 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21505
21506 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21507
21508 @end deftypevr
21509
21510 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
21511 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
21512
21513 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21514
21515 @end deftypevr
21516
21517 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
21518 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
21519
21520 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21521
21522 @end deftypevr
21523
21524 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
21525 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
21526 used under light load conditions.
21527
21528 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21529
21530 @end deftypevr
21531
21532 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
21533 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
21534
21535 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21536
21537 @end deftypevr
21538
21539 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
21540 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
21541
21542 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21543
21544 @end deftypevr
21545
21546 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
21547 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
21548 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
21549
21550 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21551
21552 @end deftypevr
21553
21554 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
21555 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
21556 performance, normal, powersave.
21557
21558 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21559
21560 @end deftypevr
21561
21562 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
21563 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
21564
21565 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
21566
21567 @end deftypevr
21568
21569 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
21570 Hard disk devices.
21571
21572 @end deftypevr
21573
21574 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
21575 Hard disk advanced power management level.
21576
21577 @end deftypevr
21578
21579 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
21580 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
21581
21582 @end deftypevr
21583
21584 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
21585 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
21586 declared hard disk.
21587
21588 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21589
21590 @end deftypevr
21591
21592 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
21593 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21594
21595 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21596
21597 @end deftypevr
21598
21599 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
21600 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
21601 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
21602 noop.
21603
21604 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21605
21606 @end deftypevr
21607
21608 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
21609 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
21610 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
21611
21612 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
21613
21614 @end deftypevr
21615
21616 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
21617 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
21618
21619 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
21620
21621 @end deftypevr
21622
21623 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
21624 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
21625
21626 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21627
21628 @end deftypevr
21629
21630 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
21631 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
21632 mode.
21633
21634 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21635
21636 @end deftypevr
21637
21638 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
21639 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21640
21641 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21642
21643 @end deftypevr
21644
21645 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
21646 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
21647
21648 Defaults to @samp{15}.
21649
21650 @end deftypevr
21651
21652 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
21653 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
21654 default, performance, powersave.
21655
21656 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21657
21658 @end deftypevr
21659
21660 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
21661 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
21662
21663 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
21664
21665 @end deftypevr
21666
21667 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
21668 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
21669 auto, default.
21670
21671 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
21672
21673 @end deftypevr
21674
21675 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
21676 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
21677
21678 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
21679
21680 @end deftypevr
21681
21682 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
21683 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
21684 performance.
21685
21686 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21687
21688 @end deftypevr
21689
21690 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
21691 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
21692
21693 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
21694
21695 @end deftypevr
21696
21697 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
21698 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
21699
21700 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21701
21702 @end deftypevr
21703
21704 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
21705 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
21706
21707 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21708
21709 @end deftypevr
21710
21711 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
21712 Wifi power saving mode.
21713
21714 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21715
21716 @end deftypevr
21717
21718 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
21719 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
21720
21721 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21722
21723 @end deftypevr
21724
21725 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
21726 Disable wake on LAN.
21727
21728 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21729
21730 @end deftypevr
21731
21732 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
21733 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
21734 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
21735
21736 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21737
21738 @end deftypevr
21739
21740 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
21741 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
21742
21743 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21744
21745 @end deftypevr
21746
21747 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
21748 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
21749
21750 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21751
21752 @end deftypevr
21753
21754 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
21755 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
21756 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
21757 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
21758
21759 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21760
21761 @end deftypevr
21762
21763 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
21764 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
21765
21766 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
21767
21768 @end deftypevr
21769
21770 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
21771 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
21772 and auto.
21773
21774 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
21775
21776 @end deftypevr
21777
21778 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
21779 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
21780
21781 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21782
21783 @end deftypevr
21784
21785 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
21786 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
21787 ones.
21788
21789 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21790
21791 @end deftypevr
21792
21793 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
21794 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
21795
21796 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21797
21798 @end deftypevr
21799
21800 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
21801 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
21802 Power Management.
21803
21804 @end deftypevr
21805
21806 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
21807 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
21808
21809 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21810
21811 @end deftypevr
21812
21813 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
21814 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
21815
21816 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21817
21818 @end deftypevr
21819
21820 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
21821 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
21822
21823 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21824
21825 @end deftypevr
21826
21827 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
21828 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
21829 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
21830
21831 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21832
21833 @end deftypevr
21834
21835 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
21836 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
21837
21838 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21839
21840 @end deftypevr
21841
21842 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
21843 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
21844 shutdown on system startup.
21845
21846 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21847
21848 @end deftypevr
21849
21850 @cindex thermald
21851 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
21852 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
21853
21854 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
21855 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
21856
21857 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
21858 This is the service type for
21859 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
21860 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
21861 of processors and preventing overheating.
21862 @end defvr
21863
21864 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
21865 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
21866
21867 @table @asis
21868 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
21869 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
21870
21871 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
21872 Package object of thermald.
21873
21874 @end table
21875 @end deftp
21876
21877 @node Audio Services
21878 @subsection Audio Services
21879
21880 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
21881 (the Music Player Daemon).
21882
21883 @cindex mpd
21884 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
21885
21886 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
21887 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
21888 of clients.
21889
21890 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
21891 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
21892
21893 @example
21894 (service mpd-service-type
21895 (mpd-configuration
21896 (user "bob")
21897 (port "6666")))
21898 @end example
21899
21900 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
21901 The service type for @command{mpd}
21902 @end defvr
21903
21904 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
21905 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
21906
21907 @table @asis
21908 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
21909 The user to run mpd as.
21910
21911 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
21912 The directory to scan for music files.
21913
21914 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
21915 The directory to store playlists.
21916
21917 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
21918 The location of the music database.
21919
21920 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
21921 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
21922
21923 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
21924 The location of the sticker database.
21925
21926 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
21927 The port to run mpd on.
21928
21929 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
21930 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
21931 an absolute path can be specified here.
21932
21933 @end table
21934 @end deftp
21935
21936 @node Virtualization Services
21937 @subsection Virtualization services
21938
21939 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
21940 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
21941 services.
21942
21943 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
21944 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
21945 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
21946 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
21947
21948 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
21949 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
21950 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
21951
21952 @example
21953 (service libvirt-service-type
21954 (libvirt-configuration
21955 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
21956 (tls-port "16555")))
21957 @end example
21958 @end deffn
21959
21960 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
21961 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
21962
21963 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
21964 Libvirt package.
21965
21966 @end deftypevr
21967
21968 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
21969 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
21970 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
21971
21972 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
21973 this capability.
21974
21975 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21976
21977 @end deftypevr
21978
21979 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
21980 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
21981 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
21982
21983 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
21984 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
21985 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
21986
21987 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21988
21989 @end deftypevr
21990
21991 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
21992 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
21993 service name
21994
21995 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
21996
21997 @end deftypevr
21998
21999 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
22000 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
22001 or service name
22002
22003 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
22004
22005 @end deftypevr
22006
22007 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
22008 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
22009
22010 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
22011
22012 @end deftypevr
22013
22014 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
22015 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
22016
22017 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
22018 Avahi daemon.
22019
22020 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22021
22022 @end deftypevr
22023
22024 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
22025 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
22026 broadcast network.
22027
22028 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
22029
22030 @end deftypevr
22031
22032 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
22033 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
22034 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
22035 becoming root.
22036
22037 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
22038
22039 @end deftypevr
22040
22041 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
22042 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
22043 VM status only.
22044
22045 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
22046
22047 @end deftypevr
22048
22049 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
22050 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
22051 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
22052 everyone (eg, 0777)
22053
22054 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
22055
22056 @end deftypevr
22057
22058 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
22059 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
22060 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
22061 the access to.
22062
22063 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
22064
22065 @end deftypevr
22066
22067 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
22068 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
22069
22070 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
22071
22072 @end deftypevr
22073
22074 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
22075 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
22076 permissions allow anyone to connect
22077
22078 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
22079
22080 @end deftypevr
22081
22082 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
22083 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
22084 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
22085 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
22086
22087 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
22088
22089 @end deftypevr
22090
22091 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
22092 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
22093 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
22094 scenario.
22095
22096 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
22097
22098 @end deftypevr
22099
22100 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
22101 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
22102 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
22103 by certificates.
22104
22105 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
22106 by using 'sasl' for this option
22107
22108 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
22109
22110 @end deftypevr
22111
22112 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
22113 API access control scheme.
22114
22115 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
22116 drivers can place restrictions on this.
22117
22118 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22119
22120 @end deftypevr
22121
22122 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
22123 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
22124 loaded.
22125
22126 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22127
22128 @end deftypevr
22129
22130 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
22131 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
22132 loaded.
22133
22134 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22135
22136 @end deftypevr
22137
22138 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
22139 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
22140 is loaded.
22141
22142 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22143
22144 @end deftypevr
22145
22146 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
22147 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
22148 CRL is loaded.
22149
22150 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22151
22152 @end deftypevr
22153
22154 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
22155 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
22156
22157 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
22158 certificates.
22159
22160 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22161
22162 @end deftypevr
22163
22164 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
22165 Disable verification of client certificates.
22166
22167 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
22168 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
22169 rejected.
22170
22171 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22172
22173 @end deftypevr
22174
22175 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
22176 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
22177
22178 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22179
22180 @end deftypevr
22181
22182 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
22183 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
22184 the SASL authentication mechanism.
22185
22186 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22187
22188 @end deftypevr
22189
22190 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
22191 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
22192 usually "NORMAL" unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
22193 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
22194
22195 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
22196
22197 @end deftypevr
22198
22199 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
22200 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
22201 sockets combined.
22202
22203 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
22204
22205 @end deftypevr
22206
22207 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
22208 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
22209 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
22210 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
22211
22212 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
22213
22214 @end deftypevr
22215
22216 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
22217 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
22218 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
22219
22220 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22221
22222 @end deftypevr
22223
22224 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
22225 Number of workers to start up initially.
22226
22227 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22228
22229 @end deftypevr
22230
22231 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
22232 Maximum number of worker threads.
22233
22234 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
22235 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
22236 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
22237
22238 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22239
22240 @end deftypevr
22241
22242 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
22243 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
22244 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
22245 executed in this pool.
22246
22247 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22248
22249 @end deftypevr
22250
22251 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
22252 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
22253
22254 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22255
22256 @end deftypevr
22257
22258 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
22259 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
22260 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
22261 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
22262
22263 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22264
22265 @end deftypevr
22266
22267 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
22268 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
22269
22270 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22271
22272 @end deftypevr
22273
22274 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
22275 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
22276
22277 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22278
22279 @end deftypevr
22280
22281 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
22282 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
22283
22284 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22285
22286 @end deftypevr
22287
22288 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
22289 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
22290
22291 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22292
22293 @end deftypevr
22294
22295 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
22296 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
22297
22298 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22299
22300 @end deftypevr
22301
22302 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
22303 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
22304
22305 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22306
22307 @end deftypevr
22308
22309 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
22310 Logging filters.
22311
22312 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
22313 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
22314
22315 @itemize @bullet
22316 @item
22317 x:name
22318
22319 @item
22320 x:+name
22321
22322 @end itemize
22323
22324 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
22325 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
22326 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
22327 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
22328 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
22329 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
22330 where matching messages should be logged:
22331
22332 @itemize @bullet
22333 @item
22334 1: DEBUG
22335
22336 @item
22337 2: INFO
22338
22339 @item
22340 3: WARNING
22341
22342 @item
22343 4: ERROR
22344
22345 @end itemize
22346
22347 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
22348 need to be separated by spaces.
22349
22350 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
22351
22352 @end deftypevr
22353
22354 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
22355 Logging outputs.
22356
22357 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
22358 for an output can be:
22359
22360 @table @code
22361 @item x:stderr
22362 output goes to stderr
22363
22364 @item x:syslog:name
22365 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
22366
22367 @item x:file:file_path
22368 output to a file, with the given filepath
22369
22370 @item x:journald
22371 output to journald logging system
22372
22373 @end table
22374
22375 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
22376
22377 @itemize @bullet
22378 @item
22379 1: DEBUG
22380
22381 @item
22382 2: INFO
22383
22384 @item
22385 3: WARNING
22386
22387 @item
22388 4: ERROR
22389
22390 @end itemize
22391
22392 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
22393 spaces.
22394
22395 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
22396
22397 @end deftypevr
22398
22399 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
22400 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
22401
22402 @itemize @bullet
22403 @item
22404 0: disable all auditing
22405
22406 @item
22407 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
22408
22409 @item
22410 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
22411
22412 @end itemize
22413
22414 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22415
22416 @end deftypevr
22417
22418 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
22419 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
22420
22421 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22422
22423 @end deftypevr
22424
22425 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
22426 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
22427
22428 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22429
22430 @end deftypevr
22431
22432 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
22433 Source to read host UUID.
22434
22435 @itemize @bullet
22436 @item
22437 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
22438
22439 @item
22440 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
22441
22442 @end itemize
22443
22444 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
22445 be generated.
22446
22447 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
22448
22449 @end deftypevr
22450
22451 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
22452 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
22453 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
22454 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
22455 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
22456
22457 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22458
22459 @end deftypevr
22460
22461 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
22462 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
22463 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
22464 broken.
22465
22466 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
22467 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
22468 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
22469 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
22470 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
22471 keepalive messages.
22472
22473 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22474
22475 @end deftypevr
22476
22477 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
22478 Same as above but for admin interface.
22479
22480 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22481
22482 @end deftypevr
22483
22484 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
22485 Same as above but for admin interface.
22486
22487 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22488
22489 @end deftypevr
22490
22491 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
22492 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
22493
22494 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
22495 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
22496 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
22497
22498 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22499
22500 @end deftypevr
22501
22502 @c %end of autogenerated docs
22503
22504 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
22505 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
22506 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
22507
22508 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
22509 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
22510 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
22511 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
22512 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
22513
22514 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
22515 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
22516 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
22517
22518 @example
22519 (service virtlog-service-type
22520 (virtlog-configuration
22521 (max-clients 1000)))
22522 @end example
22523 @end deffn
22524
22525 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
22526 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
22527
22528 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22529
22530 @end deftypevr
22531
22532 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
22533 Logging filters.
22534
22535 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
22536 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
22537
22538 @itemize @bullet
22539 @item
22540 x:name
22541
22542 @item
22543 x:+name
22544
22545 @end itemize
22546
22547 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
22548 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
22549 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
22550 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
22551 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
22552 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
22553 where matching messages should be logged:
22554
22555 @itemize @bullet
22556 @item
22557 1: DEBUG
22558
22559 @item
22560 2: INFO
22561
22562 @item
22563 3: WARNING
22564
22565 @item
22566 4: ERROR
22567
22568 @end itemize
22569
22570 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
22571 need to be separated by spaces.
22572
22573 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
22574
22575 @end deftypevr
22576
22577 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
22578 Logging outputs.
22579
22580 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
22581 for an output can be:
22582
22583 @table @code
22584 @item x:stderr
22585 output goes to stderr
22586
22587 @item x:syslog:name
22588 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
22589
22590 @item x:file:file_path
22591 output to a file, with the given filepath
22592
22593 @item x:journald
22594 output to journald logging system
22595
22596 @end table
22597
22598 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
22599
22600 @itemize @bullet
22601 @item
22602 1: DEBUG
22603
22604 @item
22605 2: INFO
22606
22607 @item
22608 3: WARNING
22609
22610 @item
22611 4: ERROR
22612
22613 @end itemize
22614
22615 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
22616 spaces.
22617
22618 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
22619
22620 @end deftypevr
22621
22622 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
22623 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
22624 sockets combined.
22625
22626 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
22627
22628 @end deftypevr
22629
22630 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
22631 Maximum file size before rolling over.
22632
22633 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
22634
22635 @end deftypevr
22636
22637 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
22638 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
22639
22640 Defaults to @samp{3}
22641
22642 @end deftypevr
22643
22644 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
22645
22646 @cindex emulation
22647 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
22648 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
22649 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
22650 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
22651 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
22652 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
22653
22654 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
22655 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
22656 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
22657 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
22658 emulated:
22659
22660 @example
22661 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
22662 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
22663 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64" "mips64el"))))
22664 @end example
22665
22666 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
22667 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
22668 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
22669 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
22670 @end defvr
22671
22672 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
22673 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
22674
22675 @table @asis
22676 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
22677 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
22678 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
22679
22680 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
22681 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
22682 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
22683 @code{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
22684 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
22685 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
22686
22687 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
22688 service:
22689
22690 @example
22691 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
22692 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
22693 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
22694 (guix-support? #t)))
22695 @end example
22696
22697 You can run:
22698
22699 @example
22700 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
22701 @end example
22702
22703 @noindent
22704 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
22705 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
22706 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
22707 access to!
22708
22709 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
22710 The QEMU package to use.
22711 @end table
22712 @end deftp
22713
22714 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
22715 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
22716 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
22717 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
22718 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
22719 @end deffn
22720
22721 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
22722 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
22723 @end deffn
22724
22725 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
22726 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
22727 @end deffn
22728
22729 @node Version Control Services
22730 @subsection Version Control Services
22731
22732 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
22733 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
22734 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
22735 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
22736 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
22737 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
22738 @code{cgit-service-type}.
22739
22740 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
22741
22742 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
22743 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
22744
22745 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
22746 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
22747 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
22748 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
22749 @file{/srv/git}.
22750
22751 @end deffn
22752
22753 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
22754 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
22755
22756 @table @asis
22757 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
22758 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
22759
22760 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
22761 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
22762 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
22763
22764 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
22765 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
22766 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
22767 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
22768 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
22769
22770 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
22771 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
22772 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
22773 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
22774 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
22775 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
22776 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
22777
22778 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
22779 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
22780 all.
22781
22782 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
22783 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
22784
22785 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
22786 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
22787
22788 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
22789 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
22790 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
22791
22792 @end table
22793 @end deftp
22794
22795 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
22796 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
22797 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
22798 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
22799 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
22800 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
22801 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
22802 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
22803 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
22804 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
22805
22806 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
22807 over HTTP.
22808
22809 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
22810 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-http-service}.
22811
22812 @table @asis
22813 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
22814 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
22815
22816 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
22817 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
22818
22819 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
22820 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
22821 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
22822
22823 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @file{/git/})
22824 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @code{/git/} prefix, this
22825 will map @code{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
22826 @code{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
22827 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
22828
22829 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
22830 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
22831 Services}.
22832 @end table
22833 @end deftp
22834
22835 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
22836 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
22837 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
22838 server.
22839
22840 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
22841 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
22842 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
22843 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
22844 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
22845
22846 @example
22847 (service nginx-service-type
22848 (nginx-configuration
22849 (server-blocks
22850 (list
22851 (nginx-server-configuration
22852 (listen '("443 ssl"))
22853 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
22854 (ssl-certificate
22855 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
22856 (ssl-certificate-key
22857 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
22858 (locations
22859 (list
22860 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
22861 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
22862 @end example
22863
22864 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
22865 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
22866 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
22867 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
22868 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
22869 @end deffn
22870
22871 @subsubheading Cgit Service
22872
22873 @cindex Cgit service
22874 @cindex Git, web interface
22875 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
22876 repositories written in C.
22877
22878 The following example will configure the service with default values.
22879 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
22880
22881 @example
22882 (service cgit-service-type)
22883 @end example
22884
22885 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
22886 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
22887
22888 @c %start of fragment
22889
22890 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
22891
22892 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
22893 The CGIT package.
22894
22895 @end deftypevr
22896
22897 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
22898 NGINX configuration.
22899
22900 @end deftypevr
22901
22902 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
22903 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
22904 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
22905
22906 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22907
22908 @end deftypevr
22909
22910 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
22911 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
22912 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
22913
22914 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22915
22916 @end deftypevr
22917
22918 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
22919 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
22920 access.
22921
22922 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22923
22924 @end deftypevr
22925
22926 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
22927 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
22928 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
22929
22930 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
22931
22932 @end deftypevr
22933
22934 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
22935 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
22936
22937 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
22938
22939 @end deftypevr
22940
22941 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
22942 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22943 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
22944
22945 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
22946
22947 @end deftypevr
22948
22949 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
22950 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22951 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
22952
22953 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22954
22955 @end deftypevr
22956
22957 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
22958 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22959 version of the repository summary page.
22960
22961 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22962
22963 @end deftypevr
22964
22965 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
22966 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22967 version of the repository index page.
22968
22969 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22970
22971 @end deftypevr
22972
22973 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
22974 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
22975 scanning a path for Git repositories.
22976
22977 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22978
22979 @end deftypevr
22980
22981 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
22982 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22983 version of the repository about page.
22984
22985 Defaults to @samp{15}.
22986
22987 @end deftypevr
22988
22989 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
22990 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
22991 version of snapshots.
22992
22993 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22994
22995 @end deftypevr
22996
22997 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
22998 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
22999 caching is disabled.
23000
23001 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23002
23003 @end deftypevr
23004
23005 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
23006 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
23007
23008 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23009
23010 @end deftypevr
23011
23012 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
23013 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
23014 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
23015
23016 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23017
23018 @end deftypevr
23019
23020 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
23021 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
23022
23023 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23024
23025 @end deftypevr
23026
23027 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
23028 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
23029
23030 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23031
23032 @end deftypevr
23033
23034 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
23035 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
23036 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
23037 ordering.
23038
23039 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
23040
23041 @end deftypevr
23042
23043 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
23044 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
23045
23046 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
23047
23048 @end deftypevr
23049
23050 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
23051 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
23052 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
23053 places throughout the cgit interface.
23054
23055 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23056
23057 @end deftypevr
23058
23059 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
23060 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
23061 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
23062
23063 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23064
23065 @end deftypevr
23066
23067 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
23068 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
23069 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
23070 repository log page.
23071
23072 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23073
23074 @end deftypevr
23075
23076 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
23077 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
23078 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
23079
23080 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23081
23082 @end deftypevr
23083
23084 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
23085 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
23086 log view.
23087
23088 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23089
23090 @end deftypevr
23091
23092 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
23093 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
23094 clones.
23095
23096 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23097
23098 @end deftypevr
23099
23100 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
23101 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
23102 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
23103
23104 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23105
23106 @end deftypevr
23107
23108 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
23109 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
23110 each repo in the repository index.
23111
23112 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23113
23114 @end deftypevr
23115
23116 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
23117 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
23118 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
23119
23120 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23121
23122 @end deftypevr
23123
23124 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
23125 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
23126 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
23127
23128 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23129
23130 @end deftypevr
23131
23132 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
23133 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
23134 branches in the summary and refs views.
23135
23136 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23137
23138 @end deftypevr
23139
23140 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
23141 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
23142 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
23143 commit view.
23144
23145 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23146
23147 @end deftypevr
23148
23149 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
23150 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
23151 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
23152 commit view.
23153
23154 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23155
23156 @end deftypevr
23157
23158 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
23159 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
23160 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
23161
23162 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23163
23164 @end deftypevr
23165
23166 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
23167 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
23168 set any repo specific settings.
23169
23170 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23171
23172 @end deftypevr
23173
23174 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
23175 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
23176
23177 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
23178
23179 @end deftypevr
23180
23181 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
23182 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23183 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
23184 "generated by..."@: message).
23185
23186 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23187
23188 @end deftypevr
23189
23190 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
23191 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23192 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
23193
23194 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23195
23196 @end deftypevr
23197
23198 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
23199 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23200 verbatim at the top of all pages.
23201
23202 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23203
23204 @end deftypevr
23205
23206 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
23207 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
23208 file is parsed.
23209
23210 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23211
23212 @end deftypevr
23213
23214 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
23215 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23216 verbatim above the repository index.
23217
23218 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23219
23220 @end deftypevr
23221
23222 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
23223 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23224 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
23225
23226 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23227
23228 @end deftypevr
23229
23230 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
23231 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
23232 in the servers timezone.
23233
23234 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23235
23236 @end deftypevr
23237
23238 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
23239 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
23240 on all cgit pages.
23241
23242 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
23243
23244 @end deftypevr
23245
23246 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
23247 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
23248
23249 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23250
23251 @end deftypevr
23252
23253 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
23254 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
23255 page.
23256
23257 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23258
23259 @end deftypevr
23260
23261 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
23262 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
23263
23264 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23265
23266 @end deftypevr
23267
23268 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
23269 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
23270
23271 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23272
23273 @end deftypevr
23274
23275 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
23276 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
23277
23278 Defaults to @samp{80}.
23279
23280 @end deftypevr
23281
23282 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
23283 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
23284 page.
23285
23286 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23287
23288 @end deftypevr
23289
23290 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
23291 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
23292 on the repository index page.
23293
23294 Defaults to @samp{80}.
23295
23296 @end deftypevr
23297
23298 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
23299 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
23300
23301 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23302
23303 @end deftypevr
23304
23305 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
23306 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
23307 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
23308
23309 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23310
23311 @end deftypevr
23312
23313 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
23314 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
23315
23316 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
23317 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
23318 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
23319
23320 @end deftypevr
23321
23322 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
23323 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
23324
23325 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23326
23327 @end deftypevr
23328
23329 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
23330 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23331 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
23332
23333 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23334
23335 @end deftypevr
23336
23337 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
23338 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
23339
23340 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23341
23342 @end deftypevr
23343
23344 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
23345 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
23346 disabled.
23347
23348 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23349
23350 @end deftypevr
23351
23352 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
23353 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
23354 header on all pages.
23355
23356 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23357
23358 @end deftypevr
23359
23360 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
23361 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
23362 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
23363 all subdirectories will be loaded.
23364
23365 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23366
23367 @end deftypevr
23368
23369 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
23370 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
23371
23372 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23373
23374 @end deftypevr
23375
23376 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
23377 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
23378 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
23379 removed for the URL and name.
23380
23381 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23382
23383 @end deftypevr
23384
23385 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
23386 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
23387
23388 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
23389
23390 @end deftypevr
23391
23392 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
23393 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
23394
23395 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23396
23397 @end deftypevr
23398
23399 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
23400 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
23401
23402 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
23403
23404 @end deftypevr
23405
23406 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
23407 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
23408
23409 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
23410
23411 @end deftypevr
23412
23413 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
23414 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23415 verbatim below thef "about" link on the repository index page.
23416
23417 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23418
23419 @end deftypevr
23420
23421 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
23422 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
23423
23424 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23425
23426 @end deftypevr
23427
23428 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
23429 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
23430 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
23431 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
23432 directories, considered as "hidden". Note that this does not apply to
23433 the ".git" directory in non-bare repos.
23434
23435 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23436
23437 @end deftypevr
23438
23439 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
23440 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
23441 generates links for.
23442
23443 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23444
23445 @end deftypevr
23446
23447 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
23448 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
23449 @code{scan-path}).
23450
23451 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
23452
23453 @end deftypevr
23454
23455 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
23456 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
23457 after this option will inherit the current section name.
23458
23459 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23460
23461 @end deftypevr
23462
23463 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
23464 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
23465 repository listing by name.
23466
23467 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23468
23469 @end deftypevr
23470
23471 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
23472 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
23473 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
23474
23475 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23476
23477 @end deftypevr
23478
23479 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
23480 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
23481 default.
23482
23483 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23484
23485 @end deftypevr
23486
23487 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
23488 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
23489 the tree view.
23490
23491 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23492
23493 @end deftypevr
23494
23495 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
23496 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository "summary"
23497 view.
23498
23499 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23500
23501 @end deftypevr
23502
23503 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
23504 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
23505 "summary" view.
23506
23507 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23508
23509 @end deftypevr
23510
23511 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
23512 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository "summary"
23513 view.
23514
23515 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23516
23517 @end deftypevr
23518
23519 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
23520 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
23521 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
23522
23523 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23524
23525 @end deftypevr
23526
23527 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
23528 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
23529
23530 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
23531
23532 @end deftypevr
23533
23534 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
23535 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
23536
23537 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23538
23539 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
23540
23541 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
23542 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
23543 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
23544
23545 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23546
23547 @end deftypevr
23548
23549 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
23550 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
23551
23552 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23553
23554 @end deftypevr
23555
23556 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
23557 The relative URL used to access the repository.
23558
23559 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23560
23561 @end deftypevr
23562
23563 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
23564 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
23565
23566 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23567
23568 @end deftypevr
23569
23570 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
23571 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
23572 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
23573
23574 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23575
23576 @end deftypevr
23577
23578 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
23579 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
23580
23581 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23582
23583 @end deftypevr
23584
23585 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
23586 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
23587
23588 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23589
23590 @end deftypevr
23591
23592 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
23593 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
23594 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
23595 ordering.
23596
23597 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23598
23599 @end deftypevr
23600
23601 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
23602 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
23603 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
23604 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or "master" if
23605 there is no suitable HEAD.
23606
23607 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23608
23609 @end deftypevr
23610
23611 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
23612 The value to show as repository description.
23613
23614 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23615
23616 @end deftypevr
23617
23618 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
23619 The value to show as repository homepage.
23620
23621 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23622
23623 @end deftypevr
23624
23625 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
23626 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
23627
23628 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23629
23630 @end deftypevr
23631
23632 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
23633 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23634 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
23635
23636 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23637
23638 @end deftypevr
23639
23640 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
23641 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23642 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
23643
23644 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23645
23646 @end deftypevr
23647
23648 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
23649 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23650 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
23651
23652 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23653
23654 @end deftypevr
23655
23656 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
23657 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
23658 branches in the summary and refs views.
23659
23660 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23661
23662 @end deftypevr
23663
23664 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
23665 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
23666 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
23667
23668 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23669
23670 @end deftypevr
23671
23672 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
23673 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
23674 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
23675
23676 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23677
23678 @end deftypevr
23679
23680 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
23681 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
23682 repository index.
23683
23684 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23685
23686 @end deftypevr
23687
23688 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
23689 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
23690
23691 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23692
23693 @end deftypevr
23694
23695 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
23696 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
23697 on this repo’s pages.
23698
23699 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23700
23701 @end deftypevr
23702
23703 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
23704 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
23705
23706 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23707
23708 @end deftypevr
23709
23710 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
23711 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
23712
23713 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23714
23715 @end deftypevr
23716
23717 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
23718 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23719 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
23720 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
23721
23722 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23723
23724 @end deftypevr
23725
23726 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
23727 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23728 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
23729 listing.
23730
23731 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23732
23733 @end deftypevr
23734
23735 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
23736 Override the default maximum statistics period.
23737
23738 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23739
23740 @end deftypevr
23741
23742 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
23743 The value to show as repository name.
23744
23745 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23746
23747 @end deftypevr
23748
23749 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
23750 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
23751
23752 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23753
23754 @end deftypevr
23755
23756 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
23757 An absolute path to the repository directory.
23758
23759 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23760
23761 @end deftypevr
23762
23763 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
23764 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
23765 the "About" page for this repo.
23766
23767 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23768
23769 @end deftypevr
23770
23771 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
23772 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
23773 after this option will inherit the current section name.
23774
23775 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23776
23777 @end deftypevr
23778
23779 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
23780 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
23781
23782 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23783
23784 @end deftypevr
23785
23786 @end deftypevr
23787
23788 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
23789 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
23790
23791 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23792
23793 @end deftypevr
23794
23795
23796 @c %end of fragment
23797
23798 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
23799 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
23800 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
23801 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
23802
23803 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
23804
23805 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
23806 The cgit package.
23807 @end deftypevr
23808
23809 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
23810 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
23811 @end deftypevr
23812
23813 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
23814 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
23815
23816 @example
23817 (service cgit-service-type
23818 (opaque-cgit-configuration
23819 (cgitrc "")))
23820 @end example
23821
23822 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
23823
23824 @cindex Gitolite service
23825 @cindex Git, hosting
23826 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
23827 repositories on a central server.
23828
23829 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
23830 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
23831
23832 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
23833 user, and the provided SSH public key.
23834
23835 @example
23836 (service gitolite-service-type
23837 (gitolite-configuration
23838 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
23839 "yourname.pub"
23840 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
23841 @end example
23842
23843 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
23844 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
23845 following command to clone the admin repository.
23846
23847 @example
23848 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
23849 @end example
23850
23851 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
23852 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
23853 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
23854 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
23855
23856 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
23857 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
23858
23859 @table @asis
23860 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
23861 Gitolite package to use.
23862
23863 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
23864 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
23865 Gitolite over SSH.
23866
23867 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
23868 Group to use for Gitolite.
23869
23870 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
23871 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
23872
23873 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
23874 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
23875 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
23876
23877 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
23878 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
23879 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
23880 within the gitolite-admin repository.
23881
23882 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
23883
23884 @example
23885 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
23886 @end example
23887
23888 @end table
23889 @end deftp
23890
23891 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
23892 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
23893
23894 @table @asis
23895 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
23896 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
23897 contents.
23898
23899 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
23900 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
23901 like cgit or gitweb.
23902
23903 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
23904 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the "config" keyword. This
23905 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
23906
23907 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
23908 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
23909
23910 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
23911 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
23912
23913 @end table
23914 @end deftp
23915
23916
23917 @node Game Services
23918 @subsection Game Services
23919
23920 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
23921 @cindex wesnothd
23922 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
23923 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
23924 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
23925
23926 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
23927 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
23928 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
23929 configuration, instantiate it as:
23930
23931 @example
23932 (service wesnothd-service-type)
23933 @end example
23934 @end defvar
23935
23936 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
23937 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
23938
23939 @table @asis
23940 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
23941 The wesnoth server package to use.
23942
23943 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
23944 The port to bind the server to.
23945 @end table
23946 @end deftp
23947
23948 @node Miscellaneous Services
23949 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
23950
23951 @cindex fingerprint
23952 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
23953
23954 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
23955 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
23956
23957 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
23958 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
23959 reading capability.
23960
23961 @example
23962 (service fprintd-service-type)
23963 @end example
23964 @end defvr
23965
23966 @cindex sysctl
23967 @subsubheading System Control Service
23968
23969 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
23970 parameters at boot.
23971
23972 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
23973 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
23974 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
23975 instantiated as:
23976
23977 @example
23978 (service sysctl-service-type
23979 (sysctl-configuration
23980 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
23981 @end example
23982 @end defvr
23983
23984 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
23985 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
23986
23987 @table @asis
23988 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
23989 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
23990
23991 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
23992 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
23993 @end table
23994 @end deftp
23995
23996 @cindex pcscd
23997 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
23998
23999 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
24000 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
24001 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
24002 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
24003 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
24004
24005 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
24006 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
24007 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
24008 configuration, instantiate it as:
24009
24010 @example
24011 (service pcscd-service-type)
24012 @end example
24013 @end defvr
24014
24015 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
24016 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
24017
24018 @table @asis
24019 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
24020 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
24021 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
24022 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
24023 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
24024 @end table
24025 @end deftp
24026
24027 @cindex lirc
24028 @subsubheading Lirc Service
24029
24030 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
24031
24032 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
24033 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
24034 [#:extra-options '()]
24035 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
24036 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
24037
24038 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
24039 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
24040 for details.
24041
24042 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
24043 passed to @command{lircd}.
24044 @end deffn
24045
24046 @cindex spice
24047 @subsubheading Spice Service
24048
24049 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
24050
24051 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
24052 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
24053 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
24054 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
24055 @end deffn
24056
24057 @cindex inputattach
24058 @subsubheading inputattach Service
24059
24060 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
24061 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
24062 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
24063 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
24064 Xorg display server.
24065
24066 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
24067 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
24068 dispatches events from it.
24069 @end deffn
24070
24071 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
24072 @table @asis
24073 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
24074 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
24075 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
24076
24077 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
24078 The device file to connect to the device.
24079
24080 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
24081 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
24082 @end table
24083 @end deftp
24084
24085 @subsection Dictionary Services
24086 @cindex dictionary
24087 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
24088
24089 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
24090 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
24091 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24092
24093 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
24094 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
24095 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
24096
24097 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
24098 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
24099 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24100 @end deffn
24101
24102 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
24103 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
24104
24105 @table @asis
24106 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
24107 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
24108
24109 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
24110 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
24111 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
24112 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24113
24114 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
24115 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
24116
24117 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
24118 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
24119 @end table
24120 @end deftp
24121
24122 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
24123 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
24124
24125 @table @asis
24126 @item @code{name}
24127 Name of the handler (module instance).
24128
24129 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
24130 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
24131 the module has the same name as the handler.
24132 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24133
24134 @item @code{options}
24135 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
24136 @end table
24137 @end deftp
24138
24139 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
24140 Data type representing a dictionary database.
24141
24142 @table @asis
24143 @item @code{name}
24144 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
24145
24146 @item @code{handler}
24147 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
24148 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24149
24150 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
24151 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
24152 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
24153
24154 @item @code{options}
24155 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
24156 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24157 @end table
24158 @end deftp
24159
24160 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
24161 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
24162 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
24163 @end defvr
24164
24165 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
24166
24167 @example
24168 (dicod-service #:config
24169 (dicod-configuration
24170 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
24171 (name "wordnet")
24172 (module "dictorg")
24173 (options
24174 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
24175 (databases (list (dicod-database
24176 (name "wordnet")
24177 (complex? #t)
24178 (handler "wordnet")
24179 (options '("database=wn")))
24180 %dicod-database:gcide))))
24181 @end example
24182
24183 @cindex Docker
24184 @subsubheading Docker Service
24185
24186 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
24187
24188 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
24189
24190 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
24191 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
24192 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
24193
24194 @end defvr
24195
24196 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
24197 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
24198
24199 @table @asis
24200
24201 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
24202 The Docker package to use.
24203
24204 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
24205 The Containerd package to use.
24206
24207 @end table
24208 @end deftp
24209
24210 @cindex Audit
24211 @subsubheading Auditd Service
24212
24213 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
24214
24215 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
24216
24217 This is the type of the service that runs
24218 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
24219 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
24220
24221 Examples of things that can be tracked:
24222
24223 @enumerate
24224 @item
24225 File accesses
24226 @item
24227 System calls
24228 @item
24229 Invoked commands
24230 @item
24231 Failed login attempts
24232 @item
24233 Firewall filtering
24234 @item
24235 Network access
24236 @end enumerate
24237
24238 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
24239 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
24240 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
24241 of auditctl into @file{/etc/audit/audit.rules}.
24242 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
24243 to view a report of all recorded events.
24244 The audit daemon usually logs into the directory @file{/var/log/audit}.
24245
24246 @end defvr
24247
24248 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
24249 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
24250
24251 @table @asis
24252
24253 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
24254 The audit package to use.
24255
24256 @end table
24257 @end deftp
24258
24259 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
24260 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
24261 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
24262 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
24263 service is the Singularity package to use.
24264
24265 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
24266 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
24267 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
24268 @end defvr
24269
24270 @cindex Nix
24271 @subsubheading Nix service
24272
24273 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
24274
24275 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
24276
24277 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
24278 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
24279 how to use it:
24280
24281 @example
24282 (use-modules (gnu))
24283 (use-service-modules nix)
24284 (use-package-modules package-management)
24285
24286 (operating-system
24287 ;; @dots{}
24288 (packages (append (list nix)
24289 %base-packages))
24290
24291 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
24292 %base-services)))
24293 @end example
24294
24295 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
24296
24297 @itemize
24298 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
24299 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
24300
24301 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
24302 @end itemize
24303
24304 @example
24305 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
24306 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
24307 @end example
24308
24309 @end defvr
24310
24311 @node Setuid Programs
24312 @section Setuid Programs
24313
24314 @cindex setuid programs
24315 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
24316 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
24317 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
24318 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
24319 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
24320 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
24321 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
24322 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
24323 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
24324
24325 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
24326 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
24327 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
24328 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
24329 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
24330 should be setuid root.
24331
24332 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
24333 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
24334 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
24335 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
24336 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
24337
24338 @example
24339 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
24340 @end example
24341
24342 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
24343 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
24344
24345 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
24346 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
24347
24348 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
24349 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
24350 @end defvr
24351
24352 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
24353 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
24354 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
24355 store.
24356
24357 @node X.509 Certificates
24358 @section X.509 Certificates
24359
24360 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
24361 @cindex X.509 certificates
24362 @cindex TLS
24363 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
24364 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
24365 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
24366 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
24367 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
24368 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
24369
24370 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
24371 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
24372 out-of-the-box.
24373
24374 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
24375 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
24376 certificates can be found.
24377
24378 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
24379 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
24380 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
24381 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
24382 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
24383 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
24384
24385 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
24386 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
24387 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
24388 to the certificates installed globally.
24389
24390 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
24391 can also install their own certificate package in
24392 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
24393 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
24394 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
24395 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
24396 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
24397 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
24398 would typically run something like:
24399
24400 @example
24401 $ guix install nss-certs
24402 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
24403 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
24404 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
24405 @end example
24406
24407 As another example, R requires the @code{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
24408 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
24409 something like this:
24410
24411 @example
24412 $ guix install nss-certs
24413 $ export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
24414 @end example
24415
24416 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
24417 variable in the relevant documentation.
24418
24419
24420 @node Name Service Switch
24421 @section Name Service Switch
24422
24423 @cindex name service switch
24424 @cindex NSS
24425 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
24426 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
24427 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
24428 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
24429 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
24430 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
24431 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
24432 C Library Reference Manual}).
24433
24434 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
24435 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
24436 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
24437 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
24438 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
24439 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
24440
24441 @cindex nss-mdns
24442 @cindex .local, host name lookup
24443 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
24444 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
24445 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
24446 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
24447
24448 @example
24449 (name-service-switch
24450 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
24451
24452 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
24453 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
24454 (name-service
24455 (name "mdns_minimal")
24456
24457 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
24458 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
24459 ;; no need to try the next methods.
24460 (reaction (lookup-specification
24461 (not-found => return))))
24462
24463 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
24464 (name-service
24465 (name "dns"))
24466
24467 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
24468 (name-service
24469 (name "mdns")))))
24470 @end example
24471
24472 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
24473 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
24474 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
24475
24476 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
24477 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
24478 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
24479 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
24480 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
24481 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
24482 @code{nscd-service}}).
24483
24484 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
24485 configurations.
24486
24487 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
24488 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
24489 @code{name-service-switch} object.
24490 @end defvr
24491
24492 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
24493 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
24494 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
24495 @end defvr
24496
24497 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
24498 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
24499 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
24500 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24501 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
24502 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
24503 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
24504 run @command{guix system}.
24505
24506 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
24507
24508 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
24509 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
24510 system databases.
24511
24512 @table @code
24513 @item aliases
24514 @itemx ethers
24515 @itemx group
24516 @itemx gshadow
24517 @itemx hosts
24518 @itemx initgroups
24519 @itemx netgroup
24520 @itemx networks
24521 @itemx password
24522 @itemx public-key
24523 @itemx rpc
24524 @itemx services
24525 @itemx shadow
24526 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
24527 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
24528 @end table
24529 @end deftp
24530
24531 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
24532
24533 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
24534 associated lookup action.
24535
24536 @table @code
24537 @item name
24538 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
24539 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24540
24541 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
24542 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
24543 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
24544 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
24545
24546 @item reaction
24547 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
24548 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
24549 Reference Manual}). For example:
24550
24551 @example
24552 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
24553 (success => return))
24554 @end example
24555 @end table
24556 @end deftp
24557
24558 @node Initial RAM Disk
24559 @section Initial RAM Disk
24560
24561 @cindex initrd
24562 @cindex initial RAM disk
24563 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
24564 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
24565 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
24566 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
24567 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
24568
24569 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
24570 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
24571 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
24572 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
24573 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
24574 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
24575 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
24576 file system, you would write:
24577
24578 @example
24579 (operating-system
24580 ;; @dots{}
24581 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
24582 @end example
24583
24584 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
24585 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
24586 @end defvr
24587
24588 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
24589 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
24590 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
24591 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
24592 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
24593 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
24594
24595 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
24596 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
24597 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
24598 system declaration like this:
24599
24600 @example
24601 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
24602 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
24603 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
24604 (apply base-initrd file-systems
24605 #:qemu-networking? #t
24606 rest)))
24607 @end example
24608
24609 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
24610 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
24611 volatile root file system.
24612
24613 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
24614 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
24615 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
24616 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
24617 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
24618 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
24619
24620 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
24621 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
24622 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
24623 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
24624
24625 @table @code
24626 @item --load=@var{boot}
24627 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
24628 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
24629
24630 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
24631 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
24632 initialization system.
24633
24634 @item --root=@var{root}
24635 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
24636 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system
24637 UUID.
24638
24639 @item --system=@var{system}
24640 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
24641 @var{system}.
24642
24643 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
24644 @cindex module, black-listing
24645 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
24646 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
24647 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
24648 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
24649 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
24650
24651 @item --repl
24652 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
24653 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
24654 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
24655 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
24656 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
24657
24658 @end table
24659
24660 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
24661 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
24662 here is how to use it and customize it further.
24663
24664 @cindex initrd
24665 @cindex initial RAM disk
24666 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
24667 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
24668 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
24669 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
24670 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
24671 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
24672 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
24673 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
24674 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
24675 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
24676 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
24677 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
24678 the root file system.
24679
24680 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
24681 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
24682 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
24683 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
24684 intended keyboard layout.
24685
24686 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
24687 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
24688 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
24689
24690 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
24691 to it are lost.
24692 @end deffn
24693
24694 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
24695 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
24696 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
24697 [#:linux-modules '()]
24698 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
24699 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
24700 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
24701 on the kernel command line via @code{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
24702 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
24703
24704 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
24705 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
24706 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
24707 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
24708 intended keyboard layout.
24709
24710 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
24711
24712 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
24713 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
24714 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
24715 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
24716 @end deffn
24717
24718 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
24719 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
24720 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
24721 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
24722 program to run in that initrd.
24723
24724 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
24725 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
24726 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
24727 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
24728 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
24729 automatically copied to the initrd.
24730 @end deffn
24731
24732 @node Bootloader Configuration
24733 @section Bootloader Configuration
24734
24735 @cindex bootloader
24736 @cindex boot loader
24737
24738 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
24739 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
24740 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
24741 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
24742 installed.
24743
24744 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
24745 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
24746 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
24747 field.
24748
24749 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
24750 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
24751
24752 @table @asis
24753
24754 @item @code{bootloader}
24755 @cindex EFI, bootloader
24756 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
24757 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
24758 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
24759 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
24760 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
24761
24762 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
24763 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
24764 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
24765 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
24766 when you boot it on your system.
24767
24768 @vindex grub-bootloader
24769 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
24770 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
24771
24772 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
24773 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
24774 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
24775 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
24776 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
24777 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
24778
24779 @item @code{target}
24780 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
24781 bootloader.
24782
24783 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
24784 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
24785 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
24786 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
24787 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
24788 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}.
24789
24790 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
24791 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
24792 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
24793 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
24794
24795 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
24796 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
24797 current system.
24798
24799 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
24800 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
24801 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
24802
24803 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
24804 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
24805 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
24806 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
24807
24808 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
24809 Layout}).
24810
24811 @quotation Note
24812 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
24813 @code{grub-efi}.
24814 @end quotation
24815
24816 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
24817 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
24818 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
24819 for GRUB.
24820
24821 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
24822 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
24823 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
24824 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
24825 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
24826 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
24827 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24828
24829 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
24830 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
24831 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
24832 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
24833 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
24834 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
24835 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
24836 manual}).
24837
24838 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
24839 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
24840 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
24841 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24842
24843 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
24844 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
24845 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
24846 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
24847 @end table
24848
24849 @end deftp
24850
24851 @cindex dual boot
24852 @cindex boot menu
24853 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
24854 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
24855 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
24856 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
24857 along these lines:
24858
24859 @example
24860 (menu-entry
24861 (label "The Other Distro")
24862 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
24863 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
24864 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
24865 @end example
24866
24867 Details below.
24868
24869 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
24870 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
24871
24872 @table @asis
24873
24874 @item @code{label}
24875 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
24876
24877 @item @code{linux}
24878 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
24879
24880 @example
24881 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
24882 @end example
24883
24884 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
24885 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
24886 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
24887
24888 @example
24889 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
24890 @end example
24891
24892 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
24893 field is ignored entirely.
24894
24895 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
24896 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
24897 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
24898
24899 @item @code{initrd}
24900 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
24901 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
24902 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
24903 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
24904 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
24905
24906 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
24907 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
24908 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
24909 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
24910 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
24911
24912 @end table
24913 @end deftp
24914
24915 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
24916 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
24917 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not documented yet.
24918
24919 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
24920 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
24921 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
24922 record.
24923
24924 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
24925 logos.
24926 @end defvr
24927
24928
24929 @node Invoking guix system
24930 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
24931
24932 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
24933 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
24934 system} command. The synopsis is:
24935
24936 @example
24937 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
24938 @end example
24939
24940 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
24941 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
24942 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
24943 supported:
24944
24945 @table @code
24946 @item search
24947 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
24948 expressions, sorted by relevance:
24949
24950 @example
24951 $ guix system search console font
24952 name: console-fonts
24953 location: gnu/services/base.scm:729:2
24954 extends: shepherd-root
24955 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are
24956 + per virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list
24957 + of tty/font pairs like:
24958 +
24959 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16"))
24960 relevance: 20
24961
24962 name: mingetty
24963 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1048:2
24964 extends: shepherd-root
24965 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
24966 relevance: 2
24967
24968 name: login
24969 location: gnu/services/base.scm:775:2
24970 extends: pam
24971 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
24972 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
24973 relevance: 2
24974
24975 @dots{}
24976 @end example
24977
24978 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
24979 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
24980 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
24981
24982 @item reconfigure
24983 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
24984 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
24985 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
24986 systems already running Guix System.}.
24987
24988 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
24989 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
24990 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
24991 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
24992 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
24993 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
24994
24995 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
24996 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
24997 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
24998 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
24999 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
25000
25001 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
25002 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
25003 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
25004 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
25005
25006 @quotation Note
25007 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
25008 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
25009 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
25010 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
25011 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
25012 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
25013 @end quotation
25014
25015 @item switch-generation
25016 @cindex generations
25017 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
25018 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
25019 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
25020 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
25021 and it moves the entries for the other generatiors to a submenu, if
25022 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
25023 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
25024
25025 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
25026 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
25027 configuration file.
25028
25029 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
25030 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
25031 generation 7:
25032
25033 @example
25034 guix system switch-generation 7
25035 @end example
25036
25037 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
25038 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
25039 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
25040 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
25041 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
25042 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
25043
25044 @example
25045 guix system switch-generation -- -1
25046 @end example
25047
25048 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
25049 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
25050 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
25051 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
25052 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
25053 like activating and deactivating services.
25054
25055 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
25056
25057 @item roll-back
25058 @cindex rolling back
25059 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
25060 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
25061 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
25062 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
25063
25064 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
25065 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
25066 generation.
25067
25068 @item delete-generations
25069 @cindex deleting system generations
25070 @cindex saving space
25071 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
25072 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
25073 collector'').
25074
25075 This works in the same way as @command{guix package --delete-generations}
25076 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{--delete-generations}}). With no
25077 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
25078
25079 @example
25080 guix system delete-generations
25081 @end example
25082
25083 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
25084 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
25085
25086 @example
25087 guix system delete-generations 2m
25088 @end example
25089
25090 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
25091 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
25092 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
25093
25094 @item build
25095 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
25096 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
25097 This action does not actually install anything.
25098
25099 @item init
25100 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
25101 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
25102 installations of Guix System. For instance:
25103
25104 @example
25105 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
25106 @end example
25107
25108 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
25109 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
25110 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
25111 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
25112 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
25113
25114 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
25115 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
25116 passed.
25117
25118 @item vm
25119 @cindex virtual machine
25120 @cindex VM
25121 @anchor{guix system vm}
25122 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
25123 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
25124
25125 @quotation Note
25126 The @code{vm} action and others below
25127 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
25128 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
25129 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
25130 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
25131 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
25132 @end quotation
25133
25134 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
25135 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
25136 emulated machine:
25137
25138 @example
25139 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -net user
25140 @end example
25141
25142 The VM shares its store with the host system.
25143
25144 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
25145 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
25146 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
25147 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
25148
25149 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
25150 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
25151 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
25152
25153 @example
25154 guix system vm my-config.scm \
25155 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
25156 @end example
25157
25158 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
25159 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
25160 store of the host can then be mounted.
25161
25162 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
25163 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
25164 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
25165 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
25166 size of the image.
25167
25168 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
25169 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
25170 @item vm-image
25171 @itemx disk-image
25172 @itemx docker-image
25173 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
25174 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
25175 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
25176 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
25177 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
25178 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
25179 @code{docker-image}.
25180
25181 You can specify the root file system type by using the
25182 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
25183
25184 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
25185 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM},
25186 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
25187
25188 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
25189 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
25190 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
25191 using the following command:
25192
25193 @example
25194 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
25195 @end example
25196
25197 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
25198 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
25199 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
25200 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
25201 Docker container using commands like the following:
25202
25203 @example
25204 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
25205 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
25206 docker start $container_id
25207 @end example
25208
25209 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
25210 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
25211 start any services you have defined in the operating system
25212 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
25213 using @command{docker exec}:
25214
25215 @example
25216 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
25217 @end example
25218
25219 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
25220 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
25221 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
25222 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
25223 @code{docker create}.
25224
25225 @item container
25226 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
25227 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
25228 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
25229 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
25230 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
25231 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
25232
25233 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
25234 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
25235 system.
25236
25237 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
25238 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
25239 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
25240
25241 @example
25242 guix system container my-config.scm \
25243 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
25244 @end example
25245
25246 @quotation Note
25247 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
25248 @end quotation
25249
25250 @end table
25251
25252 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
25253 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
25254 following:
25255
25256 @table @option
25257 @item --expression=@var{expr}
25258 @itemx -e @var{expr}
25259 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
25260 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
25261 operating system.
25262 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
25263 Installation Image}).
25264
25265 @item --system=@var{system}
25266 @itemx -s @var{system}
25267 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
25268 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
25269
25270 @item --derivation
25271 @itemx -d
25272 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
25273 building anything.
25274
25275 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
25276 @itemx -t @var{type}
25277 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
25278 @var{type} on the image.
25279
25280 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
25281
25282 @cindex ISO-9660 format
25283 @cindex CD image format
25284 @cindex DVD image format
25285 @code{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
25286 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
25287
25288 @item --image-size=@var{size}
25289 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
25290 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
25291 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
25292 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
25293
25294 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
25295 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
25296 @var{file}.
25297
25298 @item --network
25299 @itemx -N
25300 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
25301 that is, do not create a network namespace.
25302
25303 @item --root=@var{file}
25304 @itemx -r @var{file}
25305 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
25306 collector root.
25307
25308 @item --skip-checks
25309 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
25310
25311 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
25312 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
25313 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
25314 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
25315 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
25316 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
25317
25318 @cindex on-error
25319 @cindex on-error strategy
25320 @cindex error strategy
25321 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
25322 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
25323 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
25324
25325 @table @code
25326 @item nothing-special
25327 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
25328
25329 @item backtrace
25330 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
25331
25332 @item debug
25333 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
25334 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
25335 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
25336 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
25337 a list of available debugging commands.
25338 @end table
25339 @end table
25340
25341 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
25342 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
25343 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
25344 bootloader boot menu:
25345
25346 @table @code
25347
25348 @item list-generations
25349 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
25350 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
25351 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
25352 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
25353
25354 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
25355 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
25356 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
25357 generations that are up to 10 days old:
25358
25359 @example
25360 $ guix system list-generations 10d
25361 @end example
25362
25363 @end table
25364
25365 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
25366 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
25367 each other:
25368
25369 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
25370 @table @code
25371
25372 @item extension-graph
25373 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
25374 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
25375 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
25376 extensions.)
25377
25378 The command:
25379
25380 @example
25381 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
25382 @end example
25383
25384 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
25385
25386 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
25387 @item shepherd-graph
25388 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
25389 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
25390 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
25391 example graph.
25392
25393 @end table
25394
25395 @node Running Guix in a VM
25396 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
25397
25398 @cindex virtual machine
25399 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
25400 distributed at
25401 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
25402 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
25403 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
25404 as QEMU (see below for details).
25405
25406 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
25407 commonly-used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
25408 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
25409 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
25410 as @file{/etc/config.scm} (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
25411
25412 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
25413 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
25414 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
25415 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
25416
25417 @cindex QEMU
25418 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
25419 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
25420 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
25421 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
25422 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
25423 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
25424
25425 @example
25426 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
25427 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
25428 -enable-kvm -m 512 \
25429 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
25430 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
25431 @end example
25432
25433 Here is what each of these options means:
25434
25435 @table @code
25436 @item qemu-system-x86_64
25437 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
25438 host.
25439
25440 @item -net user
25441 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
25442 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
25443 guest OS online.
25444
25445 @item -net nic,model=virtio
25446 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
25447 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
25448 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
25449 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
25450
25451 @item -enable-kvm
25452 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
25453 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
25454 faster.
25455
25456 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
25457 @item -m 1024
25458 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
25459 which may be insufficient for some operations.
25460
25461 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
25462 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
25463 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
25464 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
25465 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
25466
25467 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
25468 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing store the
25469 the ``myhd'' drive.
25470 @end table
25471
25472 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
25473 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-net user} flag by default.
25474 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
25475 to your system definition and start the VM using
25476 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -net user}. An important caveat of using
25477 @command{-net user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
25478 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
25479 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
25480
25481 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
25482
25483 @cindex SSH
25484 @cindex SSH server
25485 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
25486 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
25487 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
25488 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
25489
25490 @example
25491 `guix system vm config.scm` -net user,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
25492 @end example
25493
25494 To connect to the VM you can run
25495
25496 @example
25497 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
25498 @end example
25499
25500 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
25501 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
25502 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
25503 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
25504 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
25505
25506 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
25507
25508 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
25509 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
25510 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
25511 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
25512
25513 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
25514 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
25515
25516 @example
25517 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
25518 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
25519 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
25520 name=com.redhat.spice.0
25521 @end example
25522
25523 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
25524
25525 @node Defining Services
25526 @section Defining Services
25527
25528 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
25529 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
25530 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
25531
25532 @menu
25533 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
25534 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
25535 * Service Reference:: API reference.
25536 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
25537 @end menu
25538
25539 @node Service Composition
25540 @subsection Service Composition
25541
25542 @cindex services
25543 @cindex daemons
25544 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
25545 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
25546 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
25547 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
25548 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
25549 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
25550 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
25551 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
25552 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
25553 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
25554 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
25555 of the system.
25556
25557 @cindex service extensions
25558 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
25559 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
25560 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
25561 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
25562 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
25563 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
25564 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
25565 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
25566 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
25567 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
25568 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
25569
25570 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
25571 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
25572 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
25573
25574 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
25575
25576 @cindex system service
25577 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
25578 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
25579 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
25580 to learn about the other service types shown here.
25581 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
25582 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
25583 particular operating system definition.
25584
25585 @cindex service types
25586 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
25587 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
25588 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
25589 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
25590 different parameters.
25591
25592 The following section describes the programming interface for service
25593 types and services.
25594
25595 @node Service Types and Services
25596 @subsection Service Types and Services
25597
25598 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
25599 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
25600 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
25601
25602 @example
25603 (define guix-service-type
25604 (service-type
25605 (name 'guix)
25606 (extensions
25607 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
25608 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
25609 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
25610 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
25611 @end example
25612
25613 @noindent
25614 It defines three things:
25615
25616 @enumerate
25617 @item
25618 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
25619
25620 @item
25621 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
25622 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
25623 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
25624
25625 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
25626 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
25627
25628 @item
25629 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
25630 @end enumerate
25631
25632 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
25633
25634 @table @code
25635 @item shepherd-root-service-type
25636 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
25637 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
25638 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
25639 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
25640
25641 @item account-service-type
25642 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
25643 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
25644 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
25645 guix-daemon}).
25646
25647 @item activation-service-type
25648 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
25649 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
25650 booted.
25651 @end table
25652
25653 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
25654
25655 @example
25656 (service guix-service-type
25657 (guix-configuration
25658 (build-accounts 5)
25659 (use-substitutes? #f)))
25660 @end example
25661
25662 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
25663 the parameters of this specific service instance.
25664 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
25665 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
25666 value is omitted, the default value specified by
25667 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
25668
25669 @example
25670 (service guix-service-type)
25671 @end example
25672
25673 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
25674 services but is not extensible itself.
25675
25676 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
25677
25678 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
25679
25680 @example
25681 (define udev-service-type
25682 (service-type (name 'udev)
25683 (extensions
25684 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
25685 udev-shepherd-service)))
25686
25687 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
25688 (extend (lambda (config rules)
25689 (match config
25690 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
25691 (udev-configuration
25692 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
25693 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
25694 @end example
25695
25696 This is the service type for the
25697 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
25698 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
25699 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
25700
25701 @table @code
25702 @item compose
25703 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
25704 services of this type.
25705
25706 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
25707 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
25708
25709 @item extend
25710 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
25711 the composition of the extensions.
25712
25713 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
25714 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
25715 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
25716 list of contributed rules.
25717
25718 @item description
25719 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
25720 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
25721 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
25722 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
25723 @end table
25724
25725 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
25726 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
25727 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
25728
25729 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
25730 interface for services.
25731
25732 @node Service Reference
25733 @subsection Service Reference
25734
25735 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
25736 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
25737 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
25738 @code{(gnu services)} module.
25739
25740 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
25741 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
25742 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
25743 this particular service instance.
25744
25745 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
25746 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
25747 raised.
25748
25749 For instance, this:
25750
25751 @example
25752 (service openssh-service-type)
25753 @end example
25754
25755 @noindent
25756 is equivalent to this:
25757
25758 @example
25759 (service openssh-service-type
25760 (openssh-configuration))
25761 @end example
25762
25763 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
25764 with the default configuration.
25765 @end deffn
25766
25767 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
25768 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
25769 @end deffn
25770
25771 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
25772 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
25773 @end deffn
25774
25775 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
25776 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
25777 parameters.
25778 @end deffn
25779
25780 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
25781
25782 @example
25783 (define s
25784 (service nginx-service-type
25785 (nginx-configuration
25786 (nginx nginx)
25787 (log-directory log-directory)
25788 (run-directory run-directory)
25789 (file config-file))))
25790
25791 (service? s)
25792 @result{} #t
25793
25794 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
25795 @result{} #t
25796 @end example
25797
25798 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
25799 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
25800 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
25801 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
25802 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
25803 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
25804 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
25805 common pattern.
25806
25807 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
25808 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
25809
25810 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
25811 clauses. Each clause has the form:
25812
25813 @example
25814 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
25815 @end example
25816
25817 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
25818 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
25819 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
25820 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
25821 @var{type}.
25822
25823 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
25824 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
25825 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
25826 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
25827 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
25828 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
25829
25830 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
25831
25832 @end deffn
25833
25834 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
25835 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
25836 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
25837 @code{operating-system} declaration.
25838
25839 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
25840 @cindex service type
25841 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
25842 and Services}).
25843
25844 @table @asis
25845 @item @code{name}
25846 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
25847
25848 @item @code{extensions}
25849 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
25850
25851 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
25852 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
25853 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
25854 services.
25855
25856 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
25857 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
25858 extensions. It may return any single value.
25859
25860 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
25861 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
25862
25863 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
25864 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
25865 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
25866 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
25867 parameter value for the service instance.
25868 @end table
25869
25870 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
25871 @end deftp
25872
25873 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
25874 @var{compute}
25875 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
25876 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
25877 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
25878 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
25879 @end deffn
25880
25881 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
25882 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
25883 @end deffn
25884
25885 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
25886 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
25887 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
25888 provides a shorthand for this.
25889
25890 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
25891 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
25892 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
25893 service is an instance.
25894
25895 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
25896 an additional job:
25897
25898 @example
25899 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
25900 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
25901 @end example
25902 @end deffn
25903
25904 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
25905 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
25906 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
25907 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
25908 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
25909 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
25910 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
25911
25912 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
25913 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
25914 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
25915 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
25916 @end deffn
25917
25918 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
25919 service types, some of which are listed below.
25920
25921 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
25922 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
25923 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
25924 @end defvr
25925
25926 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
25927 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
25928 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
25929 @end defvr
25930
25931 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
25932 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
25933 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
25934 passing it name/file tuples such as:
25935
25936 @example
25937 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
25938 @end example
25939
25940 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
25941 pointing to the given file.
25942 @end defvr
25943
25944 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
25945 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
25946 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
25947 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
25948 @end defvr
25949
25950 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
25951 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
25952 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
25953 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
25954 @end defvr
25955
25956
25957 @node Shepherd Services
25958 @subsection Shepherd Services
25959
25960 @cindex shepherd services
25961 @cindex PID 1
25962 @cindex init system
25963 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
25964 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
25965 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
25966 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
25967 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
25968
25969 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
25970 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
25971 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
25972 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
25973 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
25974
25975 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
25976
25977 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
25978 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
25979 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
25980
25981 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
25982 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
25983 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
25984
25985 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
25986 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
25987
25988 @table @asis
25989 @item @code{provision}
25990 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
25991
25992 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
25993 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
25994 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
25995 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
25996
25997 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
25998 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
25999
26000 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
26001 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
26002 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
26003 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
26004 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
26005
26006 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
26007 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
26008 underlying process dies.
26009
26010 @item @code{start}
26011 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
26012 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
26013 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
26014 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
26015 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
26016 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
26017
26018 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
26019 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
26020 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
26021 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
26022 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
26023 @command{herd} sub-commands:
26024
26025 @example
26026 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
26027 @end example
26028
26029 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
26030 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
26031 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
26032
26033 @item @code{documentation}
26034 A documentation string, as shown when running:
26035
26036 @example
26037 herd doc @var{service-name}
26038 @end example
26039
26040 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
26041 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
26042
26043 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
26044 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
26045 @code{stop} are evaluated.
26046
26047 @end table
26048 @end deftp
26049
26050 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
26051 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
26052 Shepherd service (see above).
26053
26054 @table @code
26055 @item name
26056 Symbol naming the action.
26057
26058 @item documentation
26059 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
26060
26061 @example
26062 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
26063 @end example
26064
26065 @item procedure
26066 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
26067 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
26068 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
26069 @end table
26070
26071 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
26072 greets the user:
26073
26074 @example
26075 (shepherd-action
26076 (name 'say-hello)
26077 (documentation "Say hi!")
26078 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
26079 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
26080 args)
26081 #t)))
26082 @end example
26083
26084 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
26085
26086 @example
26087 # herd say-hello example
26088 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
26089 # herd say-hello example a b c
26090 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
26091 @end example
26092
26093 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
26094 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
26095 info on actions.
26096 @end deftp
26097
26098 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
26099 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
26100
26101 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
26102 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
26103 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
26104 @end defvr
26105
26106 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
26107 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
26108 @end defvr
26109
26110
26111 @node Documentation
26112 @chapter Documentation
26113
26114 @cindex documentation, searching for
26115 @cindex searching for documentation
26116 @cindex Info, documentation format
26117 @cindex man pages
26118 @cindex manual pages
26119 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
26120 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
26121 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
26122 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
26123 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
26124 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
26125
26126 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
26127 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
26128 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
26129
26130 @example
26131 $ info -k TLS
26132 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
26133 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
26134 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
26135 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
26136 @dots{}
26137 @end example
26138
26139 @noindent
26140 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
26141
26142 @example
26143 $ man -k TLS
26144 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
26145 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
26146 @dots {}
26147 @end example
26148
26149 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
26150 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
26151 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
26152 respected.
26153
26154 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
26155 running, say:
26156
26157 @example
26158 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
26159 @end example
26160
26161 @noindent
26162 or:
26163
26164 @example
26165 $ man certtool
26166 @end example
26167
26168 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
26169 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
26170 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
26171 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
26172 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
26173 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
26174
26175 @node Installing Debugging Files
26176 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
26177
26178 @cindex debugging files
26179 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
26180 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
26181 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
26182 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
26183 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
26184
26185 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
26186 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
26187 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
26188 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
26189 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
26190 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
26191 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
26192
26193 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
26194 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
26195 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
26196 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
26197 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
26198 with GDB}).
26199
26200 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
26201 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
26202 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
26203 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
26204 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
26205 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
26206 Guile:
26207
26208 @example
26209 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
26210 @end example
26211
26212 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
26213 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
26214 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
26215 GDB}):
26216
26217 @example
26218 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
26219 @end example
26220
26221 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
26222 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
26223
26224 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
26225 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
26226 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
26227 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
26228 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
26229 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
26230
26231 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
26232 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
26233 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
26234 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
26235 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
26236 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
26237 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
26238 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26239
26240
26241 @node Security Updates
26242 @chapter Security Updates
26243
26244 @cindex security updates
26245 @cindex security vulnerabilities
26246 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
26247 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
26248 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
26249 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
26250 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
26251 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
26252 distribution:
26253
26254 @smallexample
26255 $ guix lint -c cve
26256 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
26257 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
26258 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
26259 @dots{}
26260 @end smallexample
26261
26262 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
26263
26264 @quotation Note
26265 As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described below is considered
26266 ``beta''.
26267 @end quotation
26268
26269 Guix follows a functional
26270 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
26271 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
26272 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
26273 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
26274 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
26275 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
26276 desired.
26277
26278 @cindex grafts
26279 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
26280 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
26281 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
26282 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
26283 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
26284 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
26285 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
26286
26287 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
26288 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
26289 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
26290 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
26291 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
26292 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
26293
26294 @example
26295 (define bash
26296 (package
26297 (name "bash")
26298 ;; @dots{}
26299 (replacement bash-fixed)))
26300 @end example
26301
26302 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
26303 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
26304 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
26305 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
26306 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
26307 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
26308 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
26309 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
26310
26311 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
26312 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
26313 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
26314 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
26315 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
26316 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
26317 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
26318
26319 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
26320 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
26321 Thus, the command:
26322
26323 @example
26324 guix build bash --no-grafts
26325 @end example
26326
26327 @noindent
26328 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
26329
26330 @example
26331 guix build bash
26332 @end example
26333
26334 @noindent
26335 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
26336 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
26337
26338 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
26339 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
26340
26341 @example
26342 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
26343 @end example
26344
26345 @noindent
26346 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
26347 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
26348
26349 @example
26350 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
26351 @end example
26352
26353 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
26354 @command{lsof} command:
26355
26356 @example
26357 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
26358 @end example
26359
26360
26361 @node Bootstrapping
26362 @chapter Bootstrapping
26363
26364 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
26365
26366 @cindex bootstrapping
26367
26368 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
26369 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
26370 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
26371 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
26372 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
26373 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
26374 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
26375 a ``regular user''.
26376
26377 @cindex bootstrap binaries
26378 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
26379 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
26380 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
26381 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
26382 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
26383 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
26384 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
26385 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
26386 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
26387
26388 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
26389 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
26390
26391 @unnumberedsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
26392
26393 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
26394 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
26395 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
26396
26397 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
26398 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
26399 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
26400 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
26401
26402 @example
26403 guix graph -t derivation \
26404 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
26405 | dot -Tps > t.ps
26406 @end example
26407
26408 At this level of detail, things are
26409 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
26410 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
26411 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
26412 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
26413 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
26414 (@pxref{The Store}).
26415
26416 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
26417 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
26418 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
26419 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
26420 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
26421 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
26422 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
26423 tarball to be unpacked.
26424
26425 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
26426 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
26427 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
26428 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
26429 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
26430 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
26431 in the store, using the original layout. The
26432 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
26433 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
26434 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
26435 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
26436
26437 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
26438 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
26439 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
26440
26441
26442 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
26443
26444 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
26445 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
26446 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
26447 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
26448 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
26449 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
26450 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
26451
26452 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
26453 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
26454 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
26455 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
26456 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
26457 package from source. The command:
26458
26459 @example
26460 guix graph -t bag \
26461 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
26462 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
26463 @end example
26464
26465 @noindent
26466 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
26467 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
26468 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
26469 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
26470
26471 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
26472
26473 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
26474 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
26475 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
26476 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
26477 built.
26478
26479 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
26480 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
26481 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
26482 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
26483
26484 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
26485 GCC uses @code{ld}
26486 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
26487 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
26488 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
26489
26490 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
26491 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
26492 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
26493 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
26494 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
26495
26496
26497 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
26498
26499 @cindex bootstrap binaries
26500 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
26501 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
26502 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
26503 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
26504
26505 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
26506 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
26507 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
26508
26509 @example
26510 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
26511 @end example
26512
26513 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
26514 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
26515 this section.
26516
26517 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
26518 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
26519 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
26520 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
26521 know.
26522
26523 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
26524
26525 Our bootstrap binaries currently include GCC, Guile, etc. That's a lot
26526 of binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these
26527 big chunks of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it
26528 hard to establish what source code produced them. Every unauditable
26529 binary also leaves us vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by
26530 Ken Thompson in the 1984 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
26531
26532 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
26533 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
26534 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
26535 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
26536 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
26537
26538 The @uref{http://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
26539 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
26540 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
26541 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
26542 a simple and auditable assembler. Your help is welcome!
26543
26544
26545 @node Porting
26546 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
26547
26548 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
26549 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
26550 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
26551 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
26552 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
26553 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
26554 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
26555
26556 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
26557 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
26558 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
26559 one:
26560
26561 @example
26562 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
26563 @end example
26564
26565 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
26566 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
26567 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
26568 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
26569 taught about the new platform.
26570
26571 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
26572 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
26573 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
26574 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
26575 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
26576 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
26577 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
26578 as well.
26579
26580 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
26581 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
26582 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
26583 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
26584 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
26585 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
26586 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
26587 reason.
26588
26589 @c *********************************************************************
26590 @include contributing.texi
26591
26592 @c *********************************************************************
26593 @node Acknowledgments
26594 @chapter Acknowledgments
26595
26596 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
26597 which was designed and
26598 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
26599 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
26600 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
26601 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
26602 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
26603
26604 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
26605 an inspiration for Guix.
26606
26607 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
26608 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
26609 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
26610 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
26611 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
26612
26613
26614 @c *********************************************************************
26615 @node GNU Free Documentation License
26616 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
26617 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
26618 @include fdl-1.3.texi
26619
26620 @c *********************************************************************
26621 @node Concept Index
26622 @unnumbered Concept Index
26623 @printindex cp
26624
26625 @node Programming Index
26626 @unnumbered Programming Index
26627 @syncodeindex tp fn
26628 @syncodeindex vr fn
26629 @printindex fn
26630
26631 @bye
26632
26633 @c Local Variables:
26634 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
26635 @c End: